This content was uploaded by our users and we assume good faith they have the permission to share this book. If you own the copyright to this book and it is wrongfully on our website, we offer a simple DMCA procedure to remove your content from our site. Start by pressing the button below!
, (*;£|mi|<£>, <j)-concordance <j)-concordance of of the the latter latter pair pair (|(| |*|*;t;.A(t)) is proved in a similar manner. manner. Observe now that if m\ > > m, m, by by the the (£\m\
k 0,>using formula (A.10)with with kA(t)inin placeof of£, £ ,one one can definethe theoperator operatoru(—kA(t)) u(—kA(t)) G (A.10) kA(t) place can define G B(X) forany any k (0,K] G (0,K] [0,T], t G with withsome some K >>00 sufficientlysmall. small. B(X) for kG and tand G [0,T], K sufficiently The same sameconclusion conclusion isin inforce forceif ifu(z) u(z)is is (
oo oouniformly uniformlywith with respect tozzG GE EV forany any fixed
respect to fixed Vll, for we showsome some estimates involving such operators. we show estimates involving such operators. For furtherneeds, needs, forany any rationalfunction function u(z),we we defineits itsintegerintegerfor rational u(z), define For further valued characteristic deg[u;] by valued characteristic deg[u;] by deg[ui] hm deg[ui] ——hm > 00 isissufficiently sufficientlysmall, small,we we have, £ (0, £ T), [0, T), Then, have, forforallall k £k (0, K] K] andand t £ t [0, M-kA{t))\\ —> oo regular and obeys obeysthe the condition conditionOJ{—Z) OJ{—Z) — u;(oo) u;(oo) ++ O^zl" O^zl"1 ) as regular and uniformly with respect respecttotoz z £ £E V1 E1, for for any any fixed fixed ipi ipi ££ (0,(p). (0,(p). Then Thenthethe uniformly with V operatoru{—kA{t)) u{—kA{t)) satisfies satisfiesthe theestimate estimate(5.17). (5.17). operator result can canbe beshown shownbybyusing usingthe thesame same techniques as those employed This result techniques as those employed the proof proof of ofLemma Lemma5.2. 5.2. in the (d/(2n ++Rk), +Rk), 2) for someR R >>00sufsufof + 2) for some by T > 0. 0. 22 >00 or K sufficiently small, forall allkk G G(0, (0,K] K]and and G[0, [0,T], T],the theoperators operators and matrix sufficiently small, for tG and matrix l operators a(-kA(t)),p{-kA{t)), p{-kA{t)), v(-kA(t)), w(-kA(t)), kaV(t))~ (i(i++ kaV(t))~ , operators a(-kA(t)), v(-kA(t)), w(-kA(t)), M 1 M (i++ka'D(t))ka'D(t))-a, kT)(t)(i (i++kaV^y^e kaV^y^e areare defined onXXor oron on kV(t) (i kV(t) a, kT)(t) defined on X X, with with \\a(-kA{t))\\+ +\\p(-kA(t))\\ \\p(-kA(t))\\+ +\H-kA(t))\\ \H-kA(t))\\ + +Hw(-fcA(t))|| Hw(-fcA(t))|| j] deg[u>j] < —1, —1, which whichclearly clearly leads usto to(5.37). (5.37). of type < leads us > £(ro £(ro++1)1) if£if£ = m-lorm>2 and £ and m -+ 1), l/(w /« + i1), < T = m-lorm>2 = m£ - = l/(w n\ otherwise, ?> > £(ro £(ro++1)1) otherwise, 5 >dd$ dd$l. Therefore, Therefore, do we allows us case we do 1 1 no more morethan than toconsider considerthe thesituation situationwhen when |A|< > 00 and andKK >>00such such that that with with any any Ci = 00 and fixed andmm 66NNsuch such that that £ < <m m and andany anyfixed fixed no no > > 00 sufficiently sufficiently fixed ££ > 00 and for all allkk €€ (0,K), (0,K), t G G [0,T], [0,T], and and A A££ Int Int (TUV{Sk)), (TUV{Sk)), large, for large, mw. Remark 6.3. [*] Let ||| |||n = \u(—kA(tn)) \tn. It is then seen that under the conditions of Theorem 6.5, the pair (||| | n ;2l(^n)) is hi^it^m)-concordant for q > £(t37 + 1) unless £ = m — 1 or m > 2 and £ = m — l/(w + 1) in which case the strict inequality q > £(m + 1) is required. In the particular case £ = 0 and m = 1 it is however allowed that q = 0 provided that (6.21) is satisfied. At the same time the pair (||| !„; 2l(£n)) is Arj^lm + 1)concordant for £ = m — \/{w + 1) and q — £(m + 1). As concerns Theorem 6.6, under its conditions the former stated estimate (6.33) actually actually shows shows that the pair (||(2l(*n) + fjLoI)^u(—kA(t n)) ||;2l(£n)) is A^)-concordant for q > ro£ while the latter estimate (6.34) yields that that the operator 2l(£n) satisfies the A|- condition. Remark 6.4. In some applications (M\(p,o~)-sectorial (M\(p,o~)-sectorial operators operators are of interest. More precisely, letting £ : Dom£ C X —* X be a closed linear operator, we write £ € S(M;ip,a) and call the operator £ (M;tp, a)-sectorial for some tp € (0, TT/2) and a 6 R if the sectorial estimate (1) holds with some M > 1 substituted for C. 13 Assuming, instead of the requirement 12 1, the assertions of the above Theorems 6.2, 6.4, and 6.6 remain valid with CM substituted for C in the corresponding stability estimates. estimates. In fact, this can be shown by using the same reasonings as above. tn = 0,1, *0, * 1 , are (j\ip,a)-, (ji\ tively, for some 7,71,7*,7*1 G [0,1). Then there exist m = 0, / , *0, *J, such that the pairs (||| |||m;ri; 2l(£ n)), m = 0, / , *0, */, are respectively Aj('yjl)-, Ai(7i|l)-, Ai(7i|l)-, Af(*;7*|l)-, Af(*;7*|l)-, and h\(*;ry*i\l)-concordant and there hold the following implications involving involving hoi hypotheses for the operator A{t) and HOL hypotheses for the operator 2t(t n ) substituted for 2l n , with any fixed i9, d\ G [0,1], i; 0 sufficiently small, the operators (kA(t) — 2;/)" defined on X and uniformly bounded with with respect respect to k G (0, K] and t G [0, T], and, clearly, the same is true for the operator P(kA(t)). representation for the difference 21 (t) — Below we need to get a suitable representation 2l(s). To that end, we put g(t) = p(-kA(t)) and ?(t) = P(kA(t)) and note that using (6.39) leads to the identity fixed 0 sufficiently fixed HO >> 00sufficiently sufficiently andany with K > 0 small, sufficiently small, we have, all kallG k(0,K], t,s G [0,T], £ X*, and X, that we have,forfor G (0,K], t,s Gx [0,T], x £u GX*, and u G X, that -QL(s))u)\ 0 be just the same as in the statement of Lemma A.I with A(t) substituted for £. Let also d > 0 be chosen such that u)(z) has no poles in V(d). Further, we set K > 0 subject to K < min{T,d/R}. Let next F be the contour coinciding with 9(2^! U V{d)). Since u;(oo) = 0 now, we can be based, as in the proof of Lemma 5.2, on formula (5.8) which clearly yields that cj(-kA(t)) -~uj{ 0>sufficiently largelarge and with (5.19), (5.20), (5.20), we wehave, have,with withany any fixed 0 sufficiently and any with any for all all kk ee (0, (0,K]K]and andt tn G GCl Clk, fixed ££ >> 00 ; for fixed > 0, 0,are aredefined defined on X X ififfii fii >>00isissufficiently sufficiently large large(cf. (cf. Appendix AppendixA.3). A.3). and and bounded boundedon 0. Then, if T < oo, we have, with K > 0 sufficiently small, for all k € (0,-fiT], t,s e [0,T], andue X, ||, 1, that \rf\-.z)\ < Ce-cnW~" for all n > 0 and z G E for any fixed cpi G (0, ip). Next, fixing arbitrarily ip\ ip\ G G (0, (0,?), ?), using using the the expansion r-f'y^71 _ rn(y\ > 00 sufficiently sufficiently small, small,for all allkk E E[0,K] [0,K]and andtnt G f2fc, holds, with |. ~pp(zy~puj(z), it follows from the above observations that the function uo(z) is (y)-regular and for any fixed tp\ G (Q,ip) t m s function is bounded in S ^ with LOO(Z) = UQ(OO) + Od^l" 1 ) as z\ —> oo, for z G E^j. In virtue of Lemma 5.4, the operator UIQ(—kA) is defined and uniformly bounded on X, that is, IIM-fcA)|| M - f c A ) | | < C for all k G {0,K}. 0), thatthat itit isisnow T < ifooa if a > 0), with with the the difference difference now assumed assumedthatthat (lj) (lj) 99 11 pp qq (0) GG D ~ f^(-) f^(-) GG Loo(0,i;£) / (0) Doomm^ -^ - "-- instead instead of ofthe the condition conditionA A ~ Loo(0,i;£) for for 16 te[0,T}. Let te[0,T}.16 Let furthermore furthermore deg[h qq ] << deg[p], deg[p], deg[h , 7*|y>, a)-concordant a)-concordant m = 0, an A(t) and andthat that A{t) A{t) itself itself satisfies satisfies the the hypotheses hypotheses holS.Ji?o; holS.Ji?o;I It] an pairs with with A(t) pairs d lip(_4.(t; , ;;|| | m; t,m = = 0, 0,*0), *0), with with some some 70,7,7* 70,7,7*G G [0,1) [0,1) and and e (0,1]. (0,1]. lip(_4.(t; m;t,m (9+2) (p+1) Then, A(-)y(9+2) (0)2/(p+1) Li(0,T;3£), the the error error of the the numerical numerical Then, if A(-)y (0)2/ (') ^ Li(0,T;3£), solution of(5.1) (5.1)by by(5.19), (5.19),(5.20) (5.20) satisfies estimate (7.42). Furthermore, solution of satisfies thethe estimate (7.42). Furthermore, the coefficient coefficientmatrix matrixa aisisnon-singular, non-singular, then estimate (7.51) holds if the then thethe estimate (7.51) holds as as well, with with the the same sameregularity regularity requirements as the in the conditions well, requirements on on y(t)y(t) as in conditions of of 19 Theorem 7.5. 7.5. Theorem proof isis similar similartotothose thoseofofTheorems Theorems aid of The proof 7.77.7 andand 7.8,7.8, withwith the the aid of Theorem 6.13. 6.13. Theorem Also, Also, we give give some some related relatedconvergence convergenceresults. results. WeWe firstfirst show show howhow the the error error can can be be estimated estimatedininstronger strongernorms. norms. 3 > 00 sufficiently sufficiently small, small,for for all allkk GG(0,iT| (0,iT| and and ttn G Qk> Qk> estimate, , a)-, (*; (*; 1/2|
> 0, 0, and andp,p,q q€ €N N such such that that qq < >00 sufficientlysmall small andd\d\> > sufficiently 0 large the thatfunction functionr(z) r(z) sufficiently and 0 sufficiently large such such that the 33 hasno nopoles polesin inV(d) V(d) andoutside outsideof ofInt£>(di), Int£>(di),and andthe the followinginequalities inequalities has and following hold hold (8.4) | rr((zz) )| <| < ee (8.4) forallzeX>(d), forallzeX>(d), e^11**11 e^ > Thenfor forany any non-decreasing finite sequence of positive positive (0,TT/2) and 0.0.Then non-decreasing finite sequence of 0 < 0. 0. Let Letalso also T T be bean anarbitrary arbitraryfamily familyof ofgrids grids and andlet letTT==oo. oo.Then, Then, for for a > all grids gridsUk Uk€€ 7,7,for forYnY the the extended extendedsolution solutionby bythe theRK RKmethod method on onUk, Uk,itit all holds holds \\Yn\\ < 0. Let also a seminorm }{-][t form a (£,\l\ip,a)-concordant pair pair with with A for some £ G [0,1] and let u(z) be beaa rational function which which is ((p)-regular and satisfies the condition deg[w] < —£. Then the estimate (8.27) holds with with ][Yn][tn substituted for \\Yn\\ if £ — 0 and if 7 is an arbitrary family of grids, 6 0, 71 G [0,1), and and 1? 1? G G (0,1]. Let further the RK method method exponentially balanced balancedfamily family of of grids grids with with be of type Vj ( 1 satisfying (8.28). (8.28). Then, Then, with with KK >> 00 sufficiently sufficiently small small and and with with any fixed £ G [0,1), for all all grids grids Uk Uk G G77 such such that that max.t max.tnevk kn < K and for all tn G Uk, the discrete solution solution YYn satisfies the estimate 9 n-l 0 0, 0, 7®, 7®,7,7i,7*,i9«,i?*« 7,7i,7*,i9«,i?*«£ £ < 1, + i9*. < 1?.< 1?. [0,1) [0,1) and and i9i9 e , i?, i? i?x e (0,1] (0,1] such suchthat that77++7*7*= =1, 1,7i7i+ +7*7* < i9. 1, i9. + i9*. Let further further 77 bebeananexponentially exponentially balanced balanced family family ofof grids gridswith withbasis basisQQ> >1 1 satisfying condition thatthat a seminorm }[-][t forms forms aa satisfying condition (8.28). (8.28).Finally, Finally,suppose suppose a seminorm }[-][t (£|1|(/?, £ ££ [0,1] andand thatthat u>(z) (£|1|(/?, a)-concordant a)-concordant pair pairwith withA(t) A(t)forforsome some £ [0,1] u>(z) is aa rarational function andand satisfies the the condition deg[w] < —£. tional function which whichisis(ip)-regular (ip)-regular satisfies condition deg[w] < —£. Then, if ££ << 11 — 7* ++ min{i?,i?i}, Then, min{i?,i?i},with withsome someK K> >0 sufficiently 0 sufficiently small, small, for for all grids grids 15^ 15^GGTTsuch suchthat thatmax max( £ g fc fcn < K, K, f/ie f/ie discrete discretesolution solutionY Yn satsatisfies the both as as it isit and withwith \u(—k isfies the stability stabilityestimate estimate(8-44) (8-44) both is and \u(—knA(tn)) Y n][tn substituted substituted for for ||2l£ ||2l£YYn \\. Furthermore, Furthermore, ififininaddition additionA(t) A(t)satisfies satisfies hypothesis hypothesis if 7if is7 an lip(.A(i; ,, ;;| | | |m;t,m = 0, lip(.A(i; 0, *0), *0), then then (8.44) (8.44)holds holdswith with£ =£ =0 even 0 even is an arbitrary family arbitrary family ofofgrids. grids. 0, and let 7 be a family family of of grids grids with with the the property: property: kkn < Ckn+\ when7. Then, Then, ifif f(t) f(t) isis strongly strongly continuously continuously ever tn,tn+i € 15k, for any 13k G 7. on [0,oo), forYn specified by (8.60) and for for y(t) y(t) the the extended extended V(/i))> |A| |A| >> R, R, 0 and h G IK, tmi/i tmi/i some some 66 >> 1/2, 1/2, ip ip G G (0,TT/2), and a G R. Xei a/so i/ie operator 9\ satisfy satisfy (6.4-8). (6.4-8). Then, Then, ifT< ifT< oo, oo, f/ie f/ie solution solution YYn of (9.1) satisfies the following stability stability estimate, estimate, with with KK >> 00 sufficiently sufficiently small, small, for for and t n G Qk, all k G (0,K\, heJi, \\Yn\\ 00 and andhhGG"K "K are concordant in in the thesense sense that that are concordant k> 9(k,h)>^h)>^0 - 9(k, 0 sufficiently small, for all k E (0, K) and hE"K, \\{I+{p-\)kAh)-l\\ >00sufficiently sufficiently small, small,with with any anyfixed fixed > 00 sufficiently sufficiently large, large,and andwith with any any fixed fixed £ £> > 0, 0,for forall all k k6 6 (0,(0, K) K) andand Ho Ho > Qk>that that tn €€ Qk> where where 21 21== 2lj 2lj++2l2l ~~ ~kfyflii, kfyflii, 2lj 2lj == k~ k~la{—kAj), a{—kAj), jj == 1,2, 1,2,and, and, asas above, above, 2~ = 11— — r(z). r(z). IfIfininaddition addition hypothesis hypothesiscom2[/j] com2[/j] is is satisfied, satisfied, then thenthe the a(z) a(z) = quantity ]>Zj=i||(2l?;n ||(2l?;n + Mo-O^i'nll Mo-O^i'nll admits admitsthe the same same estimate estimatefor for any anyfixed fixed quantity ]>Zj=i + >0.0. a (£|?, withwith A, Let also alsoui{z) ui{z) be beaa((p)-regular ((p)-regularrational rational function satisfying deg[w] < — — [_£_], [_£_], Let function satisfying deg[w] < the last last condition conditionis is replaced replacedby by deg[cj] deg[cj] < < — —££ if if ££ G GNNand andif ifthethe where the where pair (][-][t',A) (][-][t',A) is is (£|£| > 00sufficiently sufficiently small, small,for for all allkkGG(0, (0, and satisfies K]K] and G flk, flk, tn G >1/2,1/2, where where G(0,7r/2). Theorem 12.3. Let A(t) A(t) = = AA G G S(ip, S(ip, a) a) for for some some 0 sufficiently sufficiently large large and and some some ££ GG (0,1], the operator P(t,s) = (A + H\I)~ lP(t, s) satisfies the condition, condition, for for allt,ti,s allt,ti,s G G [0,T] [0,T] such that s < min{£,£i}, min{£,£i}, )\\ + \t-t1\-<\\(P(t,s)-P(t1,s))\\ Theorem A.2. and let 0 suc/i i/iai /or all A ^ ^ ( S ^ j U 0, and m G N N suc/i i/iai £ < m. T/ien i/iere exist a ip\ G (0, 0 suc/i i/iai for all A £ I n t ( 2 ^ U V{R)) and u G X, 0 be sufficiently large so that that the the spectrum spectrum oo//££ belongs belongsto to the the set set Ajr, Ajr, == Int Int ((SS^^nn T>(L)) U {0}, and let /(A) /(A) be be holomorphic holomorphic in in aa neighbourhood neighbourhood ofof A^. A^. Then Then it holds, with Hj, = dAi, dAi, for for any any fixed fixed ££ >> 0, 0,5
log\u(z)\ log\u(z)\ log \z\ \z\ log
L 5.2.Suppose Supposethat that A(t)GG S(ip,a) and and seminorms|| \t\tand and L eemmmm a a5.2. A(t) S(ip,a) seminorms \ \|*;;tt |* form respectively respectively (£\m\(p,a)and(*\£\m\(p,a)-concordant (*\£\m\(p,a)-concordant A(t) with form (£\m\(p,a)and pairs pairs with A(t) for someip ip GG (0,7r/2),IT IT 6 K, K,( (> > andm mG GN Nsuch suchthat thatm m >>max{^, max{^, 1}. for some (0,7r/2), 6 0,0, and 1}. Let further furtherUJ(Z) UJ(Z)be beaarational rationalfunction function which which is is(tp)-regular (tp)-regular and andsatisfies satisfiesthe the Let condition deg[w] <— —m. m. Then Thenthere there exists fixedK K >>00such such that that forall all condition deg[w] < exists aa fixed for /cG (0,K],te te [0,T], [0,T], ueX, ueX, /cG (0,K], u{-kA{t))u\
\{u(-kA(t))YxU,
(5.5) (5.5)
90 CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION BY RUNGE-KUTTA METHODS METHODS Proof. We will show only (5.5), (5.5), noting noting that that the latter estimate is proved in a similar way. 6 It follows from Lemma A.2 that with some
< C\z\t-m\\u\\.
(5.6)
Moreover, in the case a > 0, (5.6) holds with R = 0. Using (5.6), we find as well for z $ Int ( S ^ U V(kR)), since z/k £ Int (Ev,1 U V(R)), \{zl - kA(t))- mu\t
= k-m\{{z/k)I
A(t))- mu\t
m
\\u\\ = Ck-t\z\t- m\\u\\.
(5.7)
Next note that the function u(z) has no poles at least in some disk T>(d), d > 0. Further, we set K > 0 subject to K < d/R if a < 0, and andwe we take K — oo if a > 0 (in the last case we have R — 0). Let now F be the contour coinciding with the boundary of the set T,Vl l)V(d). Using now the operator calculus formula (A. 10) with with F in place of H# +£ and with kA(t) in place of £, we get, since u>(oo) = 0, = 7T- I uj(-z)(zI-kA(t))uj(-z)(zI-kA(t))-1dz. 2m JT
(5.8)
Integrating, if m > 2, by parts and multiplying further both sides sides from from the right by u £ X, we obtain
Lu{-kA{t)) u = ^-
f tfm(z) (2/ - kA{t))~ mu dz,
(5.9)
with /
\
rr
-1 -1
Z
J
(2 — Zi) m ~ 2 o;(—21) dzi
if m > 2,
where the path of integration from ooe~ l¥>1 to 2 lies on the contour F. For further success we need to estimate suitably the function \J/ m(z). In the case m — 1 it is evident that - \z\)~l 6
for z 6 F.
(5.10)
In fact, we then have to use the below representation (5.8) with both sides converted into the adjoint operators.
5.1. INTRODUCTORY LIGHT LIGHT
91
Turning next to the case m > 2, we find, since deg[w] < — m, \*m(z)\
< (m-1) [*
|z-zi| m-2|u;(-zi)||
i^—2rii" a-2
< c r
which implies, for all z € F with Qz < 0, o
|*m(z)|
(1 + x)- 2dx
(5.11)
J\z\
Observe that by Cauchy's Theorem, re =
-
/
Jz
and thus (5.11) remains valid valid for all z 6 Y. Using now (5.9) together together with with (5.10), (5.11), and (5.7) and since | |< is a seminorm, a simple estimation gives, for k e {0,K},
\u(-kA{t)) u\t < C f(l + \z\)-1\(zI-kA(t))-mu\ JT
\dz\
< Ck-t [(l + \z\)-l\z\t-™\dz\, JT
thus (5.5) follows at least in the case £ < m. Now let £ = m. It follows from Lemma 5.1 that that the pair (| | t ; A(t)) is, in fact, (£\m + 1|?, cr)-concordant. Therefore, Therefore, if a rational function LO\(Z) with deg[a;i] < — (m +1) is (y)-regular, applying the above argument shows that for all ke(Q,K] and u e X, (5.12)
\uj\(—kA{t))u\t ^ Next, let Ao £ C be subject to A(7m = lim ( |2|->oo
and furthermore let io\(z) be given by {l-Xoz)-m (—1 — \oz)~m
if |argA 0| < TT/2, otherwise.
(5.13)
92 CHAPTER CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATIONBY RUNGE-KUTTA RUNGE-KUTTAMETHODS METHODS It is easily easily seen seenthat thatdeg[u;i] deg[u;i]< <—(m —(m and u>i(z) is (ip)-regu\ax (ip)-regu\ax so that that UJI + +1)1) and u>i(z) satisfies (5.12). Since SinceA(t) A(t)£ £S(ip,a) S(ip,a)and andthethe pair ;A(i)) | (£|m|?,a)a)satisfies (5.12). pair (| (|| t ;A(i)) isis (£|m|?, concordant, wehave havefor forallallk k£ £(0,(0, and concordant, we K\K\and u £u £ X, X, kA(t))-mu\t |(7 + X XokA(t))-
< Ck-Z\\u\\ Ck-Z\\u\\ ifif | arg | argAA TT/2, < o| < TT/2,
(5.14) (5.14)
and
kA(t))-mu\t \(I - \okA(t))-
< CkS\\u\\ CkS\\u\\ <
|arg(-A0 )|
(5.15) (5.15)
kA(t) substituted substituted for forz,z,we weget getananoperator operator equality (5.13) with with — kA(t) equality By (5.13) kA(t))-m jargAol << TT/2, TT/2, (I + X kA(t))ifif jargAol u)(-kA(t)) =wi(-/cA(t))++^ ^ , , , ,, , .o ., ., , , ,, ,, „„,, u)(-kA(t)) =wi(-/cA(t)) ,,,, K v K vv (-1 ++XokA(t)) XokA(t)) m otherwise. " 11 (-1 otherwise. (5.16) (5.16) Therefore, using using (5.16) (5.16)together togetherwith with(5.12), (5.12), (5.14), (5.15), desired Therefore, (5.14), andand (5.15), the the desired estimate (5.5)ininthe thecase case££==mmfollows follows well, after a trivial estimation. estimate (5.5) asas well, after a trivial estimation. we pose pose separately separatelyananimportant importantcase case Lemma Now we of of Lemma 5.2.5.2. Lemma 5.3. 5.3. Let Let A(t) A(t) ££S(
(5.17) (5.17)
for some some mm ££N, N,then, then,for forallallk k£ £(0,K] (0,K]and and Furthermore, i/deg[cj]<<— m for Furthermore, i/deg[cj] R&nu(-kA(t)) C Domi Domim (i) and t £ [0,T], [0,T], R&nu(-kA(t))
MkA(t)r<s{-kA(t))\\
5.1. INTRODUCTORY LIGHT 5.1. INTRODUCTORY LIGHT
93
93
Leemmmm 5.5. A(t)G GS(ip, S(ip,a) a)and andletleta a(not (notnecessarily necessarily rational) L a a5.5. Let Let A(t) rational) functionfunction u!nn(z), U {0}, {0},be beholomorphic holomorphic (inz)z)inin neighbourhood a ofT.^, T.^,for for u! (z), nn GG NN U (in a neighbourhood of some tpGG(0, (0,TT/2) TT/2) and and Suppose further that forsome somedd >>0,0, the some tp a aG G R. R. Suppose further that for the function (z) obeys obeys theconditions, conditions, forall alln nG GNNUU {0}, function ujnnuj (z) the for {0}, 71 71 \ujnn(z)\
forallz£V(d), forallz£V(d), for allzze eE E V(d), n for all ^ n^ V(d),
and and l^l)"11 for forall allzz G GS Svv . l^l)" T/zen i£holds, holds,with with some K >>0 0 sufficiently small, forall all t [0,T], E [0,T],kk££ T/zen i£ some K sufficiently small, for t E (0,K], K], and and nG GNNUU {0} suc/i nk<< (0, n {0} suc/i that that nk C,C, \\unn(-kA)\\
(5.18) (5.18)
Furthermore, ifaa>> 0 in addition,then then the restriction nk<< is not needed. Furthermore, if 0 in addition, the restriction nk CC is not needed. Proof Note (see Appendix theuioperator {—kA{t))can uican bereprerepreProof Note thatthat (see Appendix A.2) the A.2) operator be nn{—kA{t)) byformula formula(5.8) (5.8) (-)cu substituted forw(-), w(-),where where Yisisreplaced replaced sentedby sented withwith cunn(-) substituted for Y by Tn theboundary boundary ofthe theset set12 12
theintegrals integrals over part ofthe the contourT Tnn Now,estimating estimating separately Now, separately the over eacheach part of contour with theaid aid acceptedconditions conditions onuu (z) and and takinginto into account with the of of thethe accepted on taking account n n(z) the reasonings employed inthe the proofof ofTheorem Theorem theclaim claimfollows follows as the reasonings employed in proof 2.1,2.1, the as in theproof proofof ofLemma Lemma5.2 5.2inin the casem m==1.1. in the the case L 5.6. Let A(t) S((p,a) G and rational a function (z), u>n nG G L eemmmm a a5.6. Let A(t) G S((p,a) and letlet a rational function u>nn(z), N UU{0}, {0},be be{ip)-regular {ip)-regular forany any fixedn, n,for for some?
Onecan can take R R==00 if if a> a 0. > 0. One take
for forall allzz G G V(d), V(d),
94 CHAPTER
5. DISCRETIZATION \un(-z)\
< Ce~cnW
Un{~z)\ < Ce" c n | z | ~ 9
BY RUNGE-KUTTA
METHODS METHODS
for all z G E V1 n 23(1),
for all z G S V 1 such that
\z\>l,
and
K ( z ) | < Ce cn|z|~* /or aZZ z g Int23(di).
Then, with some K > 0 sufficiently small, the operator operatoru(—kA(t)) u(—kA(t)) satisfies satisfies the estimate (5.18) for all t G [0,T], fc G (0,X], and n G N U {0} sucfr i/iat nA; < C. Furthermore, the condition condition nk < C is not needed if a > 0. Proof. Taking
rn = U5=ir^, where E V l }, £> = {z G C : \z\ = d/(2n + 2) + Rk,z<£ Int E z e C : d/(2n + 2) + Rk < \z\ < 1, z G S V l }, {* e C : 1 < |z| < di(n + I) 1 / 9 , z G E V1 }, and 4 4 ) = { z e C : |z| = di(n+ 1) 1/9 , z ^ IntE^J,
we use the Taylor operator operator calculus calculus (see, (see, e.g., e.g., Taylor Taylor [160]), [160]),so sothat that we wehave have the representation LJn(-kA(t)) = Un(00)I +^~
Now, with this equality in mind, the claim easily follows follows in a manner similar to that used in the proof of of Lemma Lemma 5.2 5.2 in in the the case case m — 1, taking the accepted condtions on to n(z) into account and estimating estimating separately separately the the integrals integrals over over r%\j = 1,2,3,4.
5.2
Discretization
In this section we consider consider the the application application of of the the Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta discretization discretization to the abstract linear Cauchy Cauchy problem problem (5.1). (5.1). For For subsequent subsequent reference, reference, we introduce the reader to a proper classification of the Runge-Kutta methods methods through a series of definitions. Apart from everything everything else, else, we we give give examples examples which go go into into the the theory. theory. of families of Runge-Kutta methods which
5.2. DISCRETIZATION
95 95
Let Qk — {t n : tn = nk for n — 0,..., N} be be aa uniform uniform grid grid in in the the interinterproblem (5.1) (5.1) be be discretized discretized in in val [0,T], with stepsize fc. 8 Furthermore, let problem time by means of a i/-stage i/-stage Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta method method9 with Butcher array
bT ) ' where10 b = (&i,... ,b u)T G C , c = (a,... ,c u)T 6 T , and a = (aji)uxu G Cyxu are given. The application application of of the the RK RK method method to to problem problem (5.1) (5.1) leads leads 11 B(X) generally generally to the following discrete problem, problem, with some given 9t G B(X) depending on k, 12
Yn+1 = Yn-kJ2bj
(A(tnj)Ynj - f(tnj))
for t n G Clk,
Yo =
3= 1
(5.19) where Y nj are calculated from the the system system of of equations equations V
Ynj = Yn-kJ2
a jt(A{tnl)Ynl
- f(tnl)),
j = l,...,v.
(5.20)
In (5.19), (5.20): t nj = tn + Cjk and Y n is the approximation to y(tn). The stability function of the the method method isis defined defined in in the the standard standard way wayby by r(z) = 1 + zb T(i - za)~ xe, where i stands for the identity identity {y {y xx i/)-matrix i/)-matrix and and ee == ( 1 , . . . , 1) . Next,
let gji(z), j,l = 1 , . . . ,u, ,u, be be the the entries entries of of the the matrix matrix (i(i — za)~l and let and v(z) = {vi{z),... w(z) = {w 1{z),,..,wl/{z))T {vi{z),... ,vu(z))T be given by
w T (z) = b T (i - zay 1 and v(z) = (i - za)' le. 8
(5.21)
As above, N and k are in in conformity conformity through through Nk Nk — —T, T, and and the the case case TT == oo oocan can be be trivially settled (cf. Section Section 1.1). 1.1). Also, Also,fifc fifcpossesses possesses the the same same meaning meaning as asininSection Section 1.1. 1.1. 9 In what follows we often use use RK RK method method instead instead of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta method, method, for for brevity. brevity. 10 For simplicity we assume assume that that 00 << Cj Cj < < 1, 1, jj; = 1,..., v, throughout. This This restriction restriction is by no means crucial. 11 These equations are a formal formal procedure procedure only. only. Sufficient Sufficient conditions conditions for for problem problem (5.19) (5.19) and (5.20) to be uniquely uniquely solvable solvable are are given given later later in in the the chapter. chapter. 12 It is not in general use to to construct construct Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta approximations approximations with with correction correctionofof the initial condition y°. In In the the sequel sequel itit isis shown, shown, however, however, that that sometimes sometimes involving involvingD\ D\isis essential.
96 CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION
BY RUNGE-KUTTA
METHODS METHODS
Thus for the function a(z) = 1 — r(z) we have the following representation representation a(z) = -zvsT(z)e = -zbT(i - zo)"^.
(5.22)
The function a(z) will play an important role in the theory below. Also, there are times when we employ the function
p(z) = -z^aiz)
= b T(i - za)~ le.
(5.23)
Clearly, all the functions a(z), p(z), Vj(z), Wj(z), and gji(z) are rational. Throughout this part of the book we will consider consider only only such such RK methods 13 that satisfy the additional condition r(0) = r'(0) = 1, which is therefore always assumed assumed in what follows without explicit explicit mention. mention. Definition 5.4. The RK method is said to be A{
Definition 5.5. We say that the RK method is of type C(ip) for some <^e (0,7r/2) if (i) it is A(ip)-stable; (ii) each of the functions Wj(—z), j — 1 , . . . , v is (ip)-regular and deg[wj] < 0,j = l,...,v. Assume in addition to (i) and (ii) that (in) The eigenvalues of the coefficient matrix a — [aji) vy.v are contained in the sector T.^^^; and (iv) Then we say that the method is o/type V((p) or o/type V*(ip) if it satisfies as well (v) deg[vj]<-l, j = l,...,v, 13
In principle, this condition condition is not needed for showing stability in itself. At the same methods. We We therefore therefore prefer prefer to assume time it is satisfied for all practical discretization methods. this condition throughout, throughout, which which slightly slightly facilitates facilitates our subsequent proofs.
5.2. DISCRETIZATION
97 97
or (vi)
deg[m,-] < - 1 , j = l , . . . , i / ,
respectively. 1^
It is worth noting that unlike unlike some some authors authors (cf., (cf., e.g., e.g., Gonzalez Gonzalez &; &;PalenPalencia [73, 74]), we do not suppose suppose that that the the /L(v?)-stability /L(v?)-stability implies implies (iii). (iii). Also, Also, observe that (iii) and (iv) together together imply imply (ii), (ii), in in view viewof of (5.21). (5.21). Furthermore, Furthermore, if the matrix a is non-singular, non-singular, we we have have <-l,
j , l = l,...,u,
(5.24) (5.24)
thus it immediately follows follows that that deg[i>j] < —1 and degfwj] degfwj] << —1 —1 for for jj — —1,... 1,... ,v. ,v.
(5.25) (5.25)
In particular, it is easily seen seen that that (ii) (ii) isis then then aa direct direct consequence consequence ofof (iii). (iii). Obviously, dealing with A(ip)-stab\e A(ip)-stab\e methods, methods, we we have have only only three three possipossibilities: (Si)
|r(oo)| |r(oo)| < 1,
(Sn)
r(oo) r(oo) == 1, 1,
and |r(oo)| = 1 and r(oo) ^ 1.
Definition 5.6. We say say that that the the RK RK method method belongs to the class Sj, J = I, II, III, if it satisfies the the respective respectivecondition condition (Sj).15 The method is called Aj((p)-stab\e (Aj-stab\e), JJ = = I,I, II, II, III, III, ifif itit isis A(
This terminology may be be justified justified by by noting noting that that the the use useof ofmethods methods ofoftype type C(
98 CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION BY BY RUNGE-KUTTA RUNGE-KUTTA METHODS METHODS Therefore, we have placed placed at at our our disposal disposal aa certain certain classification classification ofof the the Runge-Kutta methods. We We take take this this classification classification as as aa basis basis for for application application of our techniques in this this book. book. When When establishing establishing the the below below results, results, we we nonetheless distinguish between between the the classes classes and and types types introduced introduced by by DefiniDefinition 5.6. Next we recall some widely widely practised practised concepts concepts of of method's method's order, order, which which are needed for our investigation investigation in in Chapter Chapter 7. 7. The The first first definition definition isis rather rather general and may be employed employed for for any any single single step step discretization discretization methods methods but but not necessarily for Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta ones. ones. Definition 5.7. A single single step step discretization discretization method method isis said said toto have have order order pp if the local error of the method, after one step of length length kk of of its its application application to an ordinary differential differential equation equation dy/dt dy/dt == f(t,y) f(t,y) with with sufficiently sufficiently smooth smooth right-hand side, is O(k p+1) as k —> 0. Dealing with Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods, methods, the the notion notion of of stage stage order order isis useful useful in certain situations as well. well. Definition 5.8. An RK RK method method is is said said to to be be of of stage stage order order qq ifif the the error error of the method, when it is applied with with stepsize stepsize kk to to an an ordinary ordinary differential differential equation with sufficiently sufficiently smooth smooth right-hand right-hand side, side, isis O(k O(kQ+1) as k —> 0 at each separate internal stage. stage. In the case with a constant constant operator operator we we employ employ one one more more concept concept ofof order (cf. Brenner, Crouzeix, Crouzeix, and and Thomee Thomee [50] [50] or or Akrivis Akrivis &: &:Crouzeix Crouzeix [4]). [4]). Definition 5.9. A discretization discretization method method isis said said to to be beof of polynomial polynomial order order qq if, when it is applied to aa linear linear ordinary ordinary differential differential equation equation dy/dt dy/dt ++Xy Xy == f(t), A £ C, the truncation truncation error error vanishes vanishes whenever whenever the the solution solution y(t) y(t) isis aa polynomial in t of degree degree at at most most qq — 1. It is easily checked that that an an RK RK method method isis of of polynomial polynomial order order qq++11ifif itit is of order p and of stage stage order order qq < < p. p. In conclusion, we point point out out some some concrete concrete families families of of the the Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods which are classified classified in in due due course course according according to to the the above above definitions. definitions. We first recall, however, however, some some of of the the so-called so-called simplifying simplifying assumptions assumptions inintroduced in the theory of of the the Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods by by Butcher Butcher (see, (see, e.g., e.g., [53]). In fact, for subsequent subsequent use use we we need need the the following following only only three. three.
B(m)
Yl ^ci" 1 = j ~ l for 1 < j < m; s=l
5.2. DISCRETIZATION
C(m)
99 99
] P alsd>~1 = j " 1 ^ '
for 1 < j < m and 1 < I < u;
s=l
and V
T>{m)
Y^ bs4~1(lsi
= J^biO-
-4)
iorl
and 1 < j < m.
It is well known that the fact that the method is of order p implies !B(p) and the fact that the method is of stage order q is equivalent to Q(q) (see, e.g., Butcher [53, Chapter 3]). 3]). First of all we discuss the family of Gauss-Legendre methods methods (see, (see, e.g., Butcher [53], Dekker & Verwer [65] or Hairer & Wanner [81]). Given v>l, for the i^-stage Gauss-Legendre Gauss-Legendre method, method, the coefficients Cj, j — l,...,u, coincide with the zeros of Pu(2c—1), where Pv(x) is the Legendre polynomial polynomial of degree u, while bj, a^; j,l = 1 ,...,!>, are specified by the symplifying assumptions B(^) and C(z/). It is known (see, e.g., [53, 65, 81]) that all methods of this family are ^4-stable and, for any fixed v > 1, the i^-stage Gauss-Legendre method method is of order 2v and of stage order v.l& Also, it follows from Saff & Varga [137] that the eigenvalues of the coefficient matrix a are localized in the set IntS^/2- It is pointed out in Dekker & Verwer [65] that the matrix a is non-singular so that (5.24) and (5.25) hold. Apart from everything else, it is not hard to see that r(oo) = 1 if v is even and r(oo) = — 1 if v is odd. It is therefore clear from the above reasonings that Gauss-Legendre method method is of type Cjj(ip) for if v is even, the corresponding Gauss-Legendre any fixed
With the aid of this equality it follows that for odd u, l-a(oo)-1a(z)
=2 0<m
m\(u-m)\ v
'
which implies directly that that deg[a(.) deg[a(.) — a(oo)] = —1. Also, it is easily seen that a(oo) = 2 for odd u and, hence, r(oo) = —1. Therefore, if v is odd, the The last fact is a direct consequence of the simplifying assumption assumption C(v). C(v).
100 CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION BY RUNGE-KUTTA METHODS METHODS corresponding Gauss-Legendre Gauss-Legendre method method is both of type Vjjj((p) and of type V?n(
1 j This manner of discretization is often referred to as the Crank-Nicolson method. Next we consider the so-called Radau IA and IIA methods. Given ! / £ N , for the z^-stage Radau IA method, Cj, j = l , . . . , i / , are the roots of the equation
Pv-i(2c-l) + P v{2c-l) = 0, while bj and a^; j , I = 1 , . . . , v, are specified by the simplifying assumptions assumptions 'B(u) and T>{v). For the i^-stage Radau IIA method, Cj, j = 1 , . . . , u, are the roots of the equation Pv-i(l
- 2c) + Pu(l - 2c) = 0,
while the other coefficients are specified by the simplifying conditions S(z^) S(z^) and G(u). It is known (see, e.g., [53, 65, 81]) 81]) that the methods of both families are A-stable, all of which satisfy the condition r(oo) = 0 or, equivalently, a(oo) = 1, and, for any v > 1, the i/-stage Radau IA or IIA method is of order 2/^ — 1. At the same time the stage order is v — 1 for Radau IA methods and v for Radau IIA ones. Also, by Saff and Varga [137] the eigenvalues of the coefficient matrix a are localized in I n t S ^ - Moreover, the matrix a itself is non-singular (see, e.g., [65]) so that (5.24) and (5.25) hold. Therefore any Radau IA or IIA method is both of type Vi(ip) and of type Vj(tp) for any fixed if G (0,7r/2). In particular, the widely popular backward backward Euler Euler method method is nothing but the 1-stage Radau IIA method with the Butcher array
/ 1 1\ Further, we discuss the behaviour of the Lobatto IIIA, IIIB, and IIIC methods (see, e.g., [53, 65, 81]). For all these methods, c\ = 0, c v = 1 and Cj, j = 1 , . . . , v, are the roots of the equation
5.2. DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION
101
while the other coefficients coefficients are are specified specified by by the the simplifying simplifying assumptions assumptions rB(u) and Q{v) for Lobatto IIIA methods, by ®(i/) and V(v) for Lobatto IIIB methods, and by 'B(^) and and Q(v Q(v — 1) and the additional condition condition
81]) that that all all these these for Lobatto IIIC methods. methods. It is known (see, e.g., [53, 65, 81]) methods are A-stable and and the the order order of a f-stage method is always 2u — 2. For the ^-stage Lobatto IIIA IIIA and and IIIB IIIB methods methods the the stage stage order order is v and v — 2, respectively, and the stability stability function function r(z) r(z) — —11 — a (z) coincides with matrix a is the (v — l,v — 1)-Pade approximation to e2 but the coefficient matrix singular. Nevertheless, it follows from [65] that deg[ det (i — a)] = v - 1,
which shows that deg[<7j/] deg[<7j/] < 0 and, thus, deg[u;j] < 0. Therefore, for any fixed ip G (0,7r/2), the ^-stage Lobatto IIIA or IIIB method is of type Cniif) if v is even and of type Cu(ip) if v is odd. Next, for the i^-stage Lobatto Lobatto IIIC IIIC method, method, the the stage stage order order is v — 1, and for all methods of this family, the matrix a is non-singular (see, e.g., [65]) [65]) so that (5.24) and (5.25) hold. hold. Also, Also, since since a(oo) a(oo) = 1, it is easily seen that - deg[l
- -2.
The above reasonings show show that that any any Lobatto Lobatto IIIC IIIC method method is both of type Vi(ip) and of type Vf(ip) for any fixed (p (p e (0,TT/2). Finally, we look at the family of 3-stage RK methods for which the Butcher array is given by ( Cl
Cl
C2-7 C3-C-V bi
C2 C3
0 7
C
0 0 V
(5.26)
b2 b3
r i , 3riT 2T3 + Ti + T2 + T3 = 0 , Cj = (1 + Tj) where T\ ¥" T2 ¥"T3 ¥"' j = l,2, 3, and 1
1+3T2T3
°^
3(n-T2) (TI-T3) ' f
7
1+3^iTl 3(r 2 -r 3 ) ( T2-n
T3-T1+3T1T3
2(l+3riT 3 ) '
c=
3
(T1-T3)
2
Clearly, this family is actually described by two two parameters. parameters.
1 + 3TTT2 3(r3-ri)(T3-r2)'
(l+2n) 0(T2
~Tl)'
102 CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION BY BY RUNGE-KUTTA RUNGE-KUTTA METHODS METHODS It follows from [64] that that the the methods methods of of this this family family are are of of order order 44 and and ofof stage order 1; and moreover, moreover, under under the the additional additional condition condition ri > 0 and 1 + 3T!T3 < 0,
(5.27) (5.27)
they are A-stable, and itit then then holds holds that that |r(oo)| |r(oo)| << 1.1. Also, Also, itit isis easily easily seen seen that if (5.27) is fulfilled, fulfilled, the the coefficient coefficient matrix matrix isis non-singular. non-singular. Therefore Therefore all all methods of this family that that satisfy satisfy (5.27) (5.27) are are both both of of type type Vj(ip) Vj(ip) and and ofof type type Vj*(tp) for any fixed tp €€ (0,TT/2). Many further examples of of applicable applicable methods methods can can be be found found within within other other families of RK methods methods (see, (see, e.g., e.g., [53, [53, 65, 65, 81]). 81]). The The interested interested reader reader might carry out the corresponding corresponding analysis analysis by by himself/herself himself/herself similarly similarly toto the above.
5.3
Connection with discrete discrete evolution evolution equations equations
Now we discuss the question question in in which which manner manner the the discrete discrete problem problem (5.19) (5.19) and (5.20) reduces to the the discrete discrete Cauchy Cauchy problem problem (1.1) (1.1) examined examined inin Part Part I.I. In fact, we show that the the reducibility reducibility isis truly truly performed performed ifif the the restrictions restrictions on the operator A(t) and and on on the the RK RK method method suitably suitably conform conform to to each each other. other. Below in some intermediate intermediate estimations, estimations, we we deal deal with with matrices matrices whose whose entries are members of XX or or of of B(X).18 If u = (uji)pxr is such a matrix, we use the notation max \\uu\\, Hull = \\uu\\,
where \\UJI\\ is the vector norm of Uji Uji ifif Uji Uji EE XX and and the the operator operator norm norm ofof 1Q In particular, working Uji if Uji £ B(X). working with with the the product product space space X^ X^ == Xx x 3£ which consists of all z/-dimensional z/-dimensional vectors vectors uu == (u\,... (u\,... ,uj) ,uj) with Uj G X, 1 < j < u, u, for for the the sake sake of of being being consistent, consistent, we we assume assume that that 20 X^ is endowed with the the norm norm ||ul| = max ||tt,-||. 18
In the sequel we also meet meet the the situation situation when when the the entries entries of ofthe the matrix matrix are areunbounded unbounded operators, however such matrices matrices are are involved involved with with no no estimations. estimations. 19 It is always clear from the the context context what what uu isis and, and, thus, thus, inin which which sense sense ||u|| ||u|| isis underunderstood. 20 X^"' may may be be endowed endowed with with any any suitable suitable norm norm composed composed ofof the the Note that the space X^"' norms of the components components in in X. X. All All such such norms norms are are equivalent equivalent to to each each other. other.
5.3. CONNECTION WITH WITH DISCRETE DISCRETE EVOLUTION EVOLUTION EQUATIONS EQUATIONS 103 103 We are confident that using using the the same same symbol symbol |||| |||| differently differently gives gives rise rise to to no no confusion. Also, in any subsequent calculations calculations involving involving operators, operators, aa matrix matrix mmGG C p x r will be identified with with the the operator operator 21 m
In the operator case A A G G S(tp,a), S(tp,a), dealing dealing with with (5.19), (5.19), (5.20), (5.20), one one should should ,^, from (5.19) and (5.20), (5.20), that that is, is, solve solve (5.20) (5.20) for for eliminate Y nj, J' — lj Ynj and insert them into into (5.19). (5.19). This This procedure procedure certainly certainly isis realized realized ifif the the system of equations (5.20) (5.20) is is uniquely uniquely solvable. solvable. ItIt may may however however happen happen that that (5.20) is not uniquely solvable solvable while while the the operators operators r(—kA) r(—kA) and and Wj(-kA), Wj(-kA), j — 1 , . . . , v, are nevertheless nevertheless defined defined and and bounded bounded on on X. X. In In particular, particular, itit follows from Lemma 5.3 5.3 that that the the definedness definedness and and boundedness boundedness ofof r(—kA) r(—kA) and of Wj(-kA), j = 11,,......,, v, v, are are observed observed for for all all kk GG (0, (0,K], K], with with KK >> 00 sufficiently small, if A G G S(ip, S(ip, a) a) and and the the RK RK method method isis of of type type C(?) C(?)22 for 23 conditions, problem problem (1.1) (1.1) some ip G (0,TT/2) and a G M. Thus, under these conditions, with 2ln = 21 = fe- 1a(-fci4), O n = / , and F n = wT(-kA)$n,
(5.28)
where
-,/yf^M.
(5-29)
may be thought of as a generalized generalized form form of of problem problem (5.19), (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) ininthe the case case with constant operator. operator. On On the the other other hand, hand, problem problem (1.1), (1.1), (5.28), (5.28), (5.29) (5.29) isis 21
The symbol ® denotes Kronecker's Kronecker's product. product. In the homogeneous case /(£) /(£) == 00 itit suffices suffices to to assume assumethat that the the method method isis^4(
104 CHAPTER CHAPTER 5.5. DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION BY BY RUNGE-KUTTA RUNGE-KUTTA METHODS METHODS follows equivalently represented as follows equivalently represented
Yn+1 = (I-a( (I-a( r(-kA)Yn + k^2wj(-kA)f(t k^2wj(-kA)f(tnj = r(-kA)Y nj)
forttn £ Clk, for
9ty°Yo = 9ty°-
(5.30) (5.30)
form (5.30) (5.30) are arecalled calledrational. rational.In principle principle In the the literature literature methods methodsof the form rational methods for autonomous autonomous equations equations may maybe introduced introduced and and examexamrational methods RKmethod method (5.19) (5.19)and independently, without without connection connectionwith withthe RK ined independently, (5.20). However in this book book we we deal dealwith withthe thenon-autonomous non-autonomouscase caseasas well (5.20). However well common starting starting point pointfor forour ourconsideration, consideration,which which we prefer prefer to keep a common and we problem (5.19), (5.19), (5.20), (5.20),whether whetherthe thedependence dependenceof A(t) on tt is is present present is problem not. Moreover, Moreover, we westrive strivefor creating creating a unified unified terminology terminology within withinthe or not. book which which means means that that we wewant wantrelated relatedterms termsfor different different objects objects to be be in conformity conformity with with each each other. other. In view of these reasons reasons we we introduce introducethe following. following. —>>3t specified specified by the rereDefinition 5.10. The The discrete discretefunction functionYn : Q/- — Definition 5.10. currence (5.30) (5.30) is called called the the extended extended solution solution of the Runge-Kutta Runge-Kuttaprocedure procedure currence autonomous case. case. (5.19) and and (5.20) (5.20) in the autonomous (5.19) Further, we weturn turn to tothe thegeneral generalcase casewhere wherethe theoperator operator A(t)may may depend Further, A(t) depend convenience we weuse use on t. For convenience diag (A(tm),.. (A(tm),.. .,A(t .,A(tni/)), = diag 1
V(t)= =diag V(t)
= {9jl(-kA(t)) (-kA(t))vxv,
and a{-kA(t)). &(t) = k~la{-kA(t)).
(5.31) (5.31)
what follows follows we weconsider consideroperator operatorequations equationsof the form, form, given given u = In what
(«i,..,«,felM, («i,..,«,fel (i + kaDn)z = ou,
(5.32) (5.32)
(i + kaT)n)z = e 0 0 u,
(5.33) (5.33)
form, given given u E X, or of the form,
5.3. CONNECTION CONNECTION WITH DISCRETE EVOLUTION EQUATIONS 105 5.3. WITH DISCRETE EVOLUTION EQUATIONS 105 which aresolved solved for for zz == {z\,...,zj) {z\,...,zj) which are
Vom Vorn. x equation GGVom x x x Vorn. IfIf equation V V
(5.32) (equation (5.33)) isuniquely uniquelysolvable solvable forany any GX^ X^ (for (for any u G (5.32) (equation (5.33)) is for u uG any u G X), we wedenote denotethe thecorresponding corresponding solution operator by(i(i++ka karD Dn)~ )~1a (by (by X), solution operator by -1 (i + + ka1) ka1)n)~ e) so sothat that zz==(i(i++ka ka(D Dn)~ )~lau. au. (z (z==(t(t++fcaD fcaDn)-1 u). (i )~le) e << gg >>u). Now we wepresent presentsufficient sufficient conditions forproblem problem(5.19), (5.19), (5.20) tobe be Now conditions for (5.20) to equivalently representable inthe theform form (1.1). (1.1).In Inwhat whatfollows follows different equivalently representable in wewe useuse different formsof ofHolder-continuity Holder-continuity ofA(t) A(t)and and this main mainidea idea separates thebelow below forms of this separates the assertions from each other. We start, however, bygiving givingan anauxiliary auxiliaryresult result by assertions from each other. We start, however, bein incommon commonuse usefor forthe the corresponding proofs. whichwill willbe which corresponding proofs. Lemma5.7. 5.7.Let Let A(t) S(ip, G a) a) and andlet let the methodbe beof oftype type V(
a\\
(5.35) (5.35)
Furthermore, forall all (0,K] K] and and [0,T], T], k kGG (0, t tGG [0, Furthermore, for (5.36) (5.36)
or or \\kT>(t)w(-kA(t))\\
(5.37) (5.37)
themethod methodis is of oftype type V((p) V((p)or orof oftype typeV*{ip), V*{ip),respectively. respectively. if the Proof. Sincethe theRunge-Kutta Runge-Kutta method isof oftype type V{
106 CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION
BY BY RUNGE-KUTTA RUNGE-KUTTA
METHODS METHODS
Now we are in a position position to to state state our our results results on on representability. representability. T h e o r e m 5.1. Suppose Suppose that that A(t) A(t) G G S(ip,a) S(ip,a) and and the the RK RK method method isis ofof type type V(ip), for some ip G (0,TT/2) and a G R. Let further further aa seminorm seminorm || \\t form A(t) and and let let A(t) A(t) itself itself satisfy satisfy hypothesis hypothesis a (711V, cr) -concordant pair with A(t) h61$Ji?;| |t], for some 71 71 G G [0,1) [0,1) and and G (0,1]. Then, with K > 0 sufficiently small, for all all kk G G (0, (0, K], K], the the entries entries of of the the operator operator matrices matrices {T>n-lD{tn)){\ + ka rDn)-le and ( D n - D ( t n ) ) (i + ka'D n)-1 a are defined and bounded on X and problem problem (5.19), (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) can can be be equivalently equivalently represented represented inin the form (1.1) with (5-38) Sin = 2l(*n) + ®n, (5-38)
),
(5.39) (5.39)
Qn = /,
(5-40) (5-40)
and Fn = w T (-fcA(i n )) (i - fc(D n - D(t n )) (i + fcoDn)" 1^ $ n ,
(5.41)
where $ n is ^iuen 6y (5.29). The proof of the theorem theorem is is based based on on the the following following Lemma 5.8. Under the the conditions conditions of of Theorem Theorem 5.1, 5.1, with with KK >> 00 suffisufficiently small, for all k G G (0, (0, K] K] and and ttn G Clk, the entries of the the operator operator kaV(t n))-le, matrices k(V n - !>(*„)) (i + A;aD(£ n ))-y k(T>n - £>(*„)) (i +
(i + fcaD n)-y (i + ka1) n)-le, k(D n - D(t n )) (i + kaV n)-la,
and k(l) n -
with 1>(tn)) (i + fcaB n)-1e fteZon^ to B(X), with n
- V(tn)) (i ^ C ^ + fc 1"71) (5.42)
and \\k{Vn ^ + k1-^1).
(5.43)
Furthermore, for all k G G (0, (0, iC] iC] and and ttn G fifc; ^ e entries of the operator operator r 1 matrices kT>n(\ + ka Dn)~ a and kT) n(i + kaT) n)~le are defined and bounded bounded on X, and the following following representations representations hold hold
(5.44)
5.3. CONNECTIONWITH WITH DISCRETE EVOLUTION EQUATIONS 107 5.3. CONNECTION DISCRETE EVOLUTION EQUATIONS 107 and and = kV(t (i = kV(t n) (i (i --fc(!D fc(!Dn - £(t £(tn )) )) (i (i ++ x (i V(tn))v(-kA(t ))v(-kA(t )). xfc(Dn -- V(t xfc(D n)).
(5.45) (5.45)
Proof. First of of all, all,since sincethe theseminorm seminorm| | t forms formsaa (-fi\(p, (-fi\(p,cr)-concordant cr)-concordantpair pair Proof. First with A(t), similarly similarlyto to (5.7) (5.7)ititholds, holds,for for all allkkGG (0,K] and with A(t), (0,K] and u Gul G , l,
\(I+ +kA^^ult kA^^ult <
D(tn ))z ))z + + (i(i++kaV(t kaV(tn))))-lau. au. -- D(t
(5.46) (5.46)
24 Now weput put24 3n = = fc(D fc(Dn - D(t D(tn )) )) (i (i+ +kaT)(t kaT)(tn))~ ))~la and andmultiply multiplyboth bothsides sides 3 Now we theleft left by by k(T> k(T>n - T)(t T)(tn)) to to obtain obtain of (5.46) (5.46)from fromthe of
k(Vn -- V(t V(tn))z ))z = = -S -SnkCD kCDn -- 2)(t 2)(tn))z ))z + + ggn u. u. k(V Applying further(5.42), (5.42), wetherefore thereforefind, find,if if K K >>00isis sufficientlysmall, small, that Applying further we sufficiently that for all all kk€€(0, (0, K] and G Q, Q,k, for K] and tn tG
IKi+ +S Snnrr' 'l l l^^CC IKi
(5.47)(5.47)
D(*n))z ))z = = (i(i++Sn^SnU. Sn^SnU. kCDn - D(* kCD
(5.48) (5.48)
and and Insertedinto into(5.46), (5.46), yields Inserted thisthis yields = --((ii++ka'D{t ka'D{tn))))-1a(i a(i + + ggn)"" )""1Snu + + (i(i++ z= 24 24
It follows thatthat followsfrom from(5.35) (5.35) the theentries entriesof of $$n are arebounded boundedon onX. X.
1 1
108 CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION BY BY RUNGE-KUTTA RUNGE-KUTTA METHODS METHODS Observe that, as already already shown, shown, the the entries entries of of the the operator operator matrix matrix (i(i ++ into T>om, hence the above argument argument is is ka'D(tn))~1a are mappings of X into correct. Further, by (5.35), (5.35), (5.42), (5.42), and and (5.47) (5.47) itit follows follows that that the the entries entriesofof the operator matrix (i ++ kaT> bounded on on X. X. Now Now kaT>n)~1a are defined and bounded a simple estimation of the the expression expression (i(i ++ Sn)~ Sn)~1SnU leads, with the aid of of (5.42), (5.47), and (5.48), to the the desired desired estimate estimate for for the the first first term term on on the the left-hand side of (5.43), and and the the same same for for the the second second term term follows follows by byusing usingaa similar argument. It is also also seen seen from from the the above abovereasonings reasoningsthat that the theentries entriesofof the operator matrices kT)n{\ + kaT> n)~la and kT) n(i + kaT) n)~1e are defined and bounded on X. It remains to show (5.44) and and (5.45). (5.45). We We denote denote 55n = k(T> n-T>(tn)) (i+ l ka'Dn)- a. It follows from (5.46) that that (i + kaVn)-^
= -(i + ka'D{t ka'D{tn))-1aBn + (i +
fcoD^n))-^.
(5.49) (5.49)
Multiplying now both sides sides of of this this equality equality from from the the left left by by kT>(t kT>(tn) and using the identity kDitn) (i + kaT){t n))-la = i - (i + / c a D ^ ) ) " 1 ^ which can easily be verified verified due due to to the the fact fact that that aa and and (i(i++ ka.T)(t ka.T)(tn))~l are permutable, we find that
Inserting this result into the the right-hand right-hand side side of of the the identity identity
kVn{i + fcoDn)-^ - kV(t n) (i + kaV n)-1a+
S n,
leads immediately to (5.44). (5.44). Further, acting similarly to to the the manner manner leading leading to to (5.50) (5.50) and and (5.44), (5.44),we we get kVnii + kaDn)-^
= kV(t kV(tn) (i + kaV(t n))-1e + (i + fccd)^))" 1 xfc(D n -D(t n ))(i + fca2) n)-1e (5.50)
and (5.51) Thus we see that (5.45) follows follows when when inserting inserting (5.51) (5.51) into into the the right-hand right-hand side of (5.50) and using (5.48) (5.48) and and the the trivial trivial identity identity Now the proof of the lemma lemma isis complete. complete.
5.3. CONNECTION
WITH WITH DISCRETE DISCRETE EVOLUTION EVOLUTION EQUATIONS EQUATIONS 109 109
Y n G X{u) be denned by Proof of Theorem 5.1. Letting Y )
I n—
we rewrite problem (5.19), (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) as as follows follows Yn+l =Yn- kbTT>nYn + kbT$n
for tn G Clk,
Yo = 9fy°
(5.52)
fca$ n.
(5.53)
and Yn = e®y n-fcaD nYn +
Since, by Lemma 5.8, the the entries entries of of the the operator operator matrices matrices (i(i++ ka karDn)~1a and 1 (i + feoDn)~ e are defined on X for /c G (0,-ftT] and t n G fifc, it follows from (5.53) that Y n = (i + kaVn)-^
® y n +fc(i+
fcaD,,)-^^.
(5.54) (5.54)
Inserting further (5.54) (5.54) into into (5.52), (5.52), we we find find that that problem problem (5.19), (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) can can be rewritten in the equivalent form
Yn+l = (l-kbTVn{i
1
)
T
+kb (i - kVn(i °
(5.55) (5.55)
the above above Therefore, to show the claim, it suffices to combine (5.55) with the representations (5.44) and and (5.45), (5.45), noting noting that that bbT'D(t)(i + ka'D(t))' 1e = 2l(t) D D and b T (i + kaV{t))- 1 = w T ( - i t ^ ( t ) ) . 2 5
R e m a r k 5.1. In particular, the assertion of Theorem 5.1 remains valid valid if, instead of holfLfi?; | \t], it is based on either of the more restrictive hypotheses hol®[i9; | | t ] or hol[i?]. So we have shown that under under some some reasonable reasonable conditions conditions problem problem (5.19), (5.19), (5.20) can be equivalently represented represented in the form (1.1), that is, as the Cauchy problem for an evolution equation in discrete time. In particular, this result yields that the then the unique unique solvability solvability of problem (5.19), (5.20) then convergence only. only. We We conconfollows and it remains to examine stability and convergence centrate on these questions questions in subsequent chapters of the the book. book. 25
Note that, as follows from from Lemma Lemma 5.8, 5.8, the the operators operators 2l(£ 2l(£n), 58n, 2ln are bounded on on X for k € (0,K] and tn 6 Clk.
110 CHAPTER CHAPTER 5. DISCRETIZATION BYRUNGE-KUTTA RUNGE-KUTTA METHODS 110 5. DISCRETIZATION BY METHODS
5.4 Comments bibliographical 5.4 Comments and and bibliographical remarks remarks Section The proofof ofLemma Lemma5.2 5.2follows followsthat that ofLemma Lemma2.2 2.2ininour our Section 55..11: :The proof of paper[37]. [37]. paper Section5.2: 5.2:For For generalbooks books inthe the field of ofRK RK methods,we werefer referthe the Section general in field methods, reader toButcher Butcher[53], [53], Dekker &Verwer Verwer[65], [65], Hairer, N0rsett, andWanWanreader to Dekker & Hairer, N0rsett, and ner [80], [80], Hairer& &Wanner Wanner[81], [81], and Stetter[155]. [155]. Although Althoughwritten written in ner Hairer and Stetter in the context ofordinary ordinarydifferential differential equations, these manuals wide present the context of equations, these manuals present aa wide rangeof ofideas, ideas,notions, notions, terminology. Moreover, in[53, [53,65, 65,81, 81, 155], range terminology. Moreover, in 155], theythey pay pay attention tothe the analysisof ofdiscretizations discretizations ofstiff stiffproblems. problems. mention analysis of We We also also mention attention to recentbook book ofHundsdorfer Hundsdorfer &Verwer Verwer[86] [86] which discretizations a recent of & which dealsdeals with with discretizations of both bothODEs ODEs andPDEs. PDEs. The The bookscited cited above aretherefore thereforerelated related to of and books above are to the present present which isintended, intended,in inparticular, particular, forapplications applications inorder orderto to the oneone which is for in examine discrete versions ofpartial partialdifferential differential equations. of Most the modmodexamine discrete versions of equations. Most of the ern approaches approaches tothe the studyof ofdiscretization discretization methods deal abstract with abstract to study methods deal with ern andthe the situationof ofpartial partialdifferential differential equations can differentialequations, equations, differential and situation equations can thenbe besettled settledas asaaparticular particular case. Inthe the abstract abstract case however, then case. In case theythey meet,meet, however, new features features ofwhich whichthe thecentral centralone oneisisthe the problemof ofinfinite infinitedimension. dimension. new of problem As concerns concerns different aspects ofgeneral generalRK RKmethods methodsconsidered considered inHilbert Hilbert As different aspects of in and Banach Banach space settings andapplied appliedto tolinear, linear,quasilinear, quasilinear, andfully fully nonnonand and and space settings linearproblems, problems, wemention mentionour ourwork work[16, [16, 19,20, 20, 22, 27, 30,36] 35, 36] linear we 19, 22, 25,25, 26,26, 27, 30, 35, and the thework workof ofBeyn Beyn& &Garay Garay[47], [47], Gonzalez &Ostermann Ostermann[71], [71], Gonzalez and Gonzalez & Gonzalez et al.[72], [72],Gonzalez Gonzalez& &Palencia Palencia[73, [73, 74,75], 75], Gudovich& &Terteryan Terteryan [78], et al. 74, Gudovich [78], Karakashian [90], Keeling [92], Lubich &Ostermann Ostermann[105, [105, 106,107], 107], NakNakKarakashian [90], Keeling [92], Lubich & 106, aguchi& &Yagi Yagi [115], [115],Ostermann Ostermann &Roche Roche[123], [123],and andOstermann Ostermann &ThaiThaiaguchi & & hammer[125]. [125]. hammer Section5.3: 5.3: Ourpresentation presentation is,in infact, fact, an animproved improvedversion version ofour our Section Our herehere is, of earlier work (These arealso alsoannounced announced in[16, [16,22, 22, 26].) 26].) earlier work [19,[19, 35]. 35]. (These results results are in
Chapter 6
Analysis of Stability In this chapter we further investigate the Runge-Kutta discretizations discretizations discussed previously in Chapter 5. We concentrate here on examining stability for discrete problems of the form (5.19), (5.20) by using seminorms | \t that form concordant pairs pairs with with A(t) in the sense of Definition 5.2 above. It has already been pointed out before that our techniques are based on reducing the starting problem (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) to the discrete Cauchy problem (1.1). In fact, under the assumption that A(t) is (<£>, u)-sectorial with some
6.1
Some resolvent estimates estimates
Our main aim in this section is to show certain weighted resolvent resolvent estimates estimates properties of the operator &2l(£) = a(—kA(t)) by using seminorms with properties regulated by Definition 5.2. In fact, such estimates are related related to the Aj(.. .)concordance of certain new seminorms derived from the original ones. 1
lt is seen from our below investigation that the operator 2l(i n) can be thought of as the principal part of 2ln in some sense.
Ill
112
CHAPTER CHAPTER 6. 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY
Perhaps, it will not be a good style if it is often used to state, one after the other, even two assertions which are formally different but the latter of which is obvious as soon as the former is stated and proved. We therefore accept the following.
Convention. In what follows there often often occur occur different different assertions assertions which which involve seminorms and operators in the space X and possess, at the same time, dual versions in X* in which all objects in X are replaced by their doubles in X*. For example, the former estimate in Definition 5.2 possesses a dual version which is just the latter estimate involving involving the corresponding objects in X*. In such situations we will not state very often the dual version explicitly, marking marking by [*] the corresponding assertion. assertion.2 Furthermore, if we need to refer to the dual version subsequently, subsequently, we refer to the explicit result (in X) marked by *. For example, Theorem 6.1 below possesses a dual version which may be referred to in the sequel, although not stated explicitly, as Theorem 6.1*. Now we present a series of helpful resolvent estimates. estimates. Theorem 6 . 1 . [*] Suppose that A(t) G S(ip,a) and a seminorm \ \t forms a (£\m\tp, a)-concordant pair pair with with A(t), for some ip G (0,TT/2), a G K, £ > 0, andrn G N such thatm—l < £ < m. Let also the RK method be A j (if)-stable and let a rational function u(z) be ((p)-regular and subject to deg[cj) < —m. Then there exist a set T of Ai-configuration and numbers 5 > 0 and K > 0 such that for all k G (0,K), t G [0,T], A £ Int (TUV(8k)), andu£X, \u(-kA(t)) (XI - k%{t))k%{t))-mu\t < C|A|*- m|M|.
(6.1)
In the case £ = m — 1, under the extra requirement that the pair (| \t;A(t)) is (£|£|>,
^^ '' ''
it is enough to suppose that deg[o;] < —£ instead of < —m. If a > 0 in in addition, then the above still holds for 5 = 0 and K = oo. Proof. Assuming first that (6.2) is not generally satisfied, we then act under the condition deg[u;] < —m. Let
This symbol appears just just before before the statement. We recall that the function p(z) is defined by (5.23).
3
6.1. SOMERESOLVENT RESOLVENT ESTIMATES 6.1. SOME ESTIMATES
113
>00be bechosen chosensufficiently sufficiently small sothat that p(z), p(z),a(z), a(z),and and ui{z)have haveno nopoles poles d> small so ui{z) V(d). Also, Also,we wechoose chooseK K<
for X>(d). e for allall z ez X>(d).
(6.3) (6.3)
Let nowF\ F\bebethe the contourcoinciding coinciding the boundary boundaryof of the theset set Let now contour withwith the V(min{do\X\, d})US^. We Wethen then apply applythe theoperator operatorcalculus calculus formula (A.10) V(min{do\X\, d})US^. formula (A.10) 1 with kA(t) kA(t)ininplace placeof of££ and andwith withT\ T\ in inplace placeof ofH# H#+e toget, get,with with5 5 ==dQ dQ R, with R, +e to for all allkkGG(0, (0, K], 0 Int U (T V(6k)), and anduu€€X,X, for K], A 0AInt (T U V(6k)), m m m m G :=u(-kA(t)) u(-kA(t))((XI ((XI - a(-kA(t)))(A- -a(oo))a(oo))J) u G := - a(-kA(t)))-- (A J) 1 = 7r^ 7r^ [ [ am a(X;z)u:(-z)(zI-kA(t))(X;z)u:(-z)(zI-kA(t))udz, = udz, m
(6.4) (6.4)
where where m m (A; z) z) == (A (A- -aa((--zz) ) — ) —-- (A (A- - a(oo))" a(oo))" . 5m m(A;
Integratingby byparts partson onthe theright-hand right-handside side of (6.4), (6.4),we weget getinstead instead Integrating of G G
m m yym (X;z)(zI-kA(t))udz, udz, m(X;z)(zI-kA(t))-
(6.5) (6.5)
where where
{
am (X;z)uj(-z) m(X;z)uj(-z)
if mif= 1, m = 1,
m 2 m (A;z1 )a;(-zi)^ )a;(-zi)^ (m m--11) ) / / (z-2i) (z-2i) - 5m ifif mm>>2,2, m(A;z 1 tv>1 tv>1 while thepath path of of integration integrationfrom from ooe~ to zz lies lies on on Y\. Y\. while the ooe~ to Assumefor for aamoment momentthat thatwe wehave have shown shownthe theestimate, estimate,for for A A^^Int Int Assume TT and GT\, T\, and zz G
IAMzl)IAMzl)-1
ifif mm= =l , l ,
((
..
( tt66))
Sincethe Since thepair pair (| (| \t;A(t)) ;A(t)) is is (^|m|?, (^|m|?,cr)-concordant, cr)-concordant, as asin in(5.7) (5.7) wewe find findthat that T\and and € X, for for zz 66T\ it it € X, m m \(zl -- kA(t))\(zl kA(t))u\ u\t
m m <
(6.7) (6.7)
113
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY
114
If A £ Int T, 6k < |A| < CMQ \ noting that £ < m, it follows follows from from (6.5), (6.5), (6.6), (6.6), and (6.7) that
\G\t < CAT* f \z\t- m-1\dz\ \\u\\ < Ck-*\\\*
u .
(6.8)
(6.5), In the case where m > > 22 and and A A ££ IntT, IntT, |A| |A| >> dd dd0 1 , we derive, using (6.5), (6.6), (6.7), and the fact that that 11 << (( < < m, m, \G\t
1
""1 / Iz^dAI + lzD^ldzHHI
<
f\z\t-m-1\dz\
(6.9)
Finally, if m = 1, since since ££ G G [0,1), [0,1), by by (6.5), (6.5), (6.6), (6.6), and and (6.7) (6.7) we we have, have, for for all all
A i IntT, |A| >dd^\ 1
\G\t<
/
u .
(6.10)
Observe furthermore that that a(oo) a(oo) // 0, 0, since since the the RK RK method method isis ofof class class Sj. Sj. Also, it necessarily holds a(oo) a(oo) G G T'. T'. Therefore, Therefore, |A - aioo)^ 1
< C ( 1 + |A|)- 1
for all A g Int T.
(6.11) (6.11)
By Lemma 5.2 and (6.11) (6.11) we we then then obtain, obtain, for for A A^^ IInnttTT and and uu GGX, X,
n
\\u\\.
(6.12)
The claim thus follows by by combining combining (6.4), (6.4), (6.8), (6.8), (6.9), (6.9), (6.10), (6.10), and and (6.12). (6.12). It remains to show (6.6). (6.6). Since Since a(—z) a(—z) G GT' T' whenever whenever zz GGSS^^,, we we have, have, for all A ^ Int T and z G GH HV1,
Next, by the i4(y>)-stability i4(y>)-stability of of the the method, method, the the zeros zeros of of a(—z) a(—z) lie lie outside outsideofof the set S^j \ {0}. Also, Also, 00 is is aa simple simple zero zero of of a(—z).4 These observations yield that cx(—z) admits admits the the two-sided two-sided estimate estimate
(1 + N T 1 < \a(-z)\ < ClzHl + lzl)'1 4
for all z G E Vl .
We recall that r(0) = r'(0) r'(0) == 11 for for all all RK RK methods methods under under consideration. consideration.
(6.14)
z
6.1. SOME RESOLVENT ESTIMATES
115
GT Thus, since deg[a(oo) ] < - 1 , with the aid of (6.11), (6.13), a(-z and (6.14) a simple estimation gives, for all A ^ IntT and G £>(min{d 115 6.1. SOME RESOLVENT1, ESTIMATES (6.6) immediately follows by (6.15), (6.16), and
= |a(oo)z - a(-z)\ |A - c^ \~ Thus, since deg[a(oo) ] < - 1 , with the aid of (6.11),- (6.13), and (6.14) l a(-z)]- gives, 2|Ar a simple estimation for all A ^ IntTz and z G E ^ , (6.15) m— for (6.3) that Furthermore, it follows from l - a(-z = |a(oo) - a(-z)\ |A - c^ |A|the +\~|zi|, identity dd^ In view of |A < for all |A|,d}). (6.16) 0 only. Assuming therefore the last J (6.15) It is now seen that 1if o (6.11), since \u(-z)\
(z)
2 { z - z 1 ) m --(m a m {-\ ; z i ) u ( - z 1 ) d z 1
< C J
= ~
... + (A - a(
t to examine andsuffices the above estimates (6.13), it the(6.11), case Qz < 0 (6.15), only.
T n S E ^ and sinceusing deg[w] < the identity restriction next
/
,
and (6.16),therefore we find, the for last Assuming dV(d
(A - into a( account the con= 5i(z)((A - a ( - we also have...to+take lies on <9D(do|A|), and the above estimates (6.11), (6.13), (6.15),Dand (6.16), we find, for z G 2 + + (1 TA n S E ^ since deg[w] < -(m (1 + + |A|) (1 + \zi\) > |A|G+ |zi|, x ((|A| + - 1) and = t(z)
A
< C J 2
z
< C J z
z)\ < C^ x ((|A| +\z\)-\
\z\
z
T\ z
+ (1 +
+
(6.17)
Clearly, if dT>{do\\\). It is easily seen tribution coming from the integration over then that |* (A; so that (6.17) is still valid for \X\) since do\\\. These reasonings (6.17) 1 \z\)-\ show (6.6) for |A| <
< C J
m
1
o
Clearly, if z lies on <9D(do|A|), we also have to take into account the contribution coming from the integration over T\ D dT>{do\\\). It is easily seen so that (6.17) is still valid for z G dV(do\X\) then that |*m(A; z)\ < C^1 1 since \z\ = do\\\. These reasonings show (6.6) for |A| <
116 116
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSISOFOFSTABILITY STABILITY CHAPTER 6.
1 thecase case |A| |A|>>dd^ dd^ similarargument argument leads tothe thefollowing followingestimate. estimate. In In the , aasimilar leads to 5 For zz G GF\, F\, since since \z\\ \z\\>>\z\ \z\>> For d,d,
z
C < C
j
This result resultagain again implies This implies (6.6).(6.6). wediscuss discussseparately separately thecase case£ £ == m m— — 1. 1. Note Notethat thatall allthe theabove above Finally,we the Finally, for the theestimate estimate(6.12), (6.12), arein inforce force even evenif if deg[a>] deg[a>]< < conclusions,except except conclusions, for are —(m (m — —1) 1) == —£. —£. However, However, using thelast last restriction restriction onuu and and assumingin in — using the on assuming additioncondition condition (6.2), byLemma Lemma5.2 5.2ititfollows followsthat that(6.12) (6.12) holds aswell, well, addition (6.2), by holds as whichshows showsthe theauxiliary auxiliaryassertion assertion inthe theconsidered consideredcase. case. in which theproof. proof. This completes This completes the The following followingresult result is aaconsequence consequenceof ofTheorem Theorem 6.1. The is 6.1. Theorem6.2. 6.2.[*] [*]Let Let A(t) S(tp,a) G andlet letthe the method be be Ai(ip)Ai(ip)Theorem A(t) G S(tp,a) and RKRK method tp G G(0, (0,TT/2) TT/2) and andaaGGM.M.Then Then there thereexist exist setTTofof stable, withsome some stable, with tp aa set A\-configurationand andnumbers numbers6 6> >00and and such 0 that thatfor for all allk kEE (0,K], K], A\-configuration KK> > 0 such (0, te [0,T], [0,T],and andA A <£lnt <£lnt(T (T UV(8Jc)), UV(8Jc)), te 1 l ||(A7- fcaft))fcaft))!! < < C\\\~ C\\\~ ||(A7 !! .
(6.18) (6.18)
>00ininaddition, addition, then then(6.18) (6.18) for88==00and and = oo. still still holdsholds for KK = oo. If cc > The resultimmediately immediately follows if one one takes takes£ £ == 0,0,mm— —1, 1, and and| | \t = = |||| |||| The result follows if in theconditions conditionsof of Theorem Theorem 6.1. in the 6.1. Further, Further,we weconsider considermethods methods of ofclass classSJJ. SJJ. Theorem 6.3.[*] [*]Let Let A(t) <S(>, G a), a), let letthe the RK method be be Au{ip)-stable, Au{ip)-stable, Theorem 6.3. A(t) G <S(>, RK method and let let aaseminorm seminorm || \t\tform form aa (£\m\tp, (£\m\tp,a)-concordant a)-concordant pairpair with with A(t), A(t),for for and some (pG G(0,vr/2), (0,vr/2),aa G GM, M,£ £> >0, 0, and mNGsuch such N that thatm m— —1 1 << ££<<m. m. some (p and m G Suppose also alsothat that rationalfunction functionLO(Z) LO(Z)is is (
As above, above,without without ofgenerality generalityit it can canbe beassumed assumedthat thatQz Qz<<0.0. of As lossloss
/« i n\
6.1. SOMERESOLVENT RESOLVENT ESTIMATES 6.1. SOME ESTIMATES
117 117
where w == — —deg[a]. deg[a]. Then Then setTTof of Ai-configuration and where w therethere exist exist aa set Ai-configuration and numbers and such 0 that thatfor forall all (0,K], tt GG[0,T], [0,T], A A££ numbers 88 >>00and K K > 0>such k kG G (0,K], Int (TU UV(5k)), V(5k)), and and Int (T uue e X,X, m m \to(-kA(t)) (XI- -k%(t))k%(t))u\t \to(-kA(t)) (XI u\
m
(6.20) (6.20)
In the theparticular particularcase case £==00and andm m==1,1,(6.20) (6.20)still still holds i/deg[cj] <0, 0, In £ holds eveneven i/deg[cj] < instead of<<— —1, 1, provided providedthatthat instead of \u\t <
(6.21) (6.21)
cr> >00in inaddition, addition,then then theabove aboveis isin inforce forcefor for66== andK K ==oo. oo. If cr the 00 and If Proof. Wefirst first prove prove themain mainassertion assertion ofthe the theoremwithout without assuming Proof. We the of theorem assuming (6.21).The Theparticular particular 1, and (6.21)holds holds isdiscussed discussed (6.21). casecase wherewhere ff ==0,0, mm == 1, and (6.21) is separatelyin inthe the final part partof ofthe the proof. separately final proof. Sincethe theRK RK methodis isof ofclass classSJI, SJI,we we havea(oo) a(oo) = 0, 0,which whichis isequivequivSince method have = alent tothe the inequality w >>1.1.This Thiscircumstance circumstance toextra extra difficulties difficulties inequality w leadsleads to alent to whendealing dealing with methods ofclass classSu Su for for the reasonthat that a(z)vanishes vanishes when with methods of the reason a(z) both at at00and and at at oo.oo. both Let T, T,T\, T\,d,d, 8, and
= —. —.I I =
m 1 m 1 (zI-kA(t))udz. u(-z)(X-a(-z))u(-z)(X-a(-z))(zI-kA(t))udz.
(6.22) (6.22) byparts, parts,we weget get well Integrating by asas well Integrating G= = G where where
(
uumm(z) (z) m 2 2 m um (zl)dz )dzl (m-1) (m-1) / / (z-z(z-z m(z l) - u
if m if =m 1, = 1,
m>2, ifif m>2,
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY
118
with um(z) = u)(—z) (A — a(—z)) m, while the path of integration integration from from 1 ^ to z lies on T\. Let m — 1. Then noting that that for for zz ££ T\, T\, (6.23)
and (6.24)
by (6.7), (6.13), and (6.16) (6.16)6 we have, since 0 < £ < 11 and and <<;; >> 1, 1, for for all all
\(£Int(ruT>(6k)), -l\dz
|G|t < C
-1 + cfi
dx
log(2
C
which shows (6.20) for m m= = 1, 1, due due to to the the fact fact that that qq>> £(zu £(zu++ 1)1) and, and, thus, thus, the last two terms of the the expression expression in in parentheses parentheses are, are, in in fact, fact, dominated dominated by the first one. Now we study the case m m >> 22 ,, m m -- ll << ££ << m m — l/(tu + 1). For short we put £{h) = log(2 + 1/h)
for for hh > > 0. 0.
(6.25) (6.25)
We first show a suitable estimate estimate for for |0 |0 m (A;z)|. By (6.13) and (6.23) (6.23) itit follows that for z e T ^ f l dd EE^^,,
-H-z)\rm C(\X\ + \z\)-m C\z\'wm C|A|-m
if if
\<\z\<
if
>
Using this estimate and (6.24), (6.24), since since m{w m{w ++ 1) 1) — 1 > ? > £(ZJ + 1) > m, we 6
Clearly, (6.13) and (6.16) (6.16) hold hold for for methods methods of of class class SII SII as as well. well.
6.1. SOME RESOLVENT ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
119
have, 7 for z € V\ n dT,(pi, \z\ < min {l,
, Qz < 0,
|6m(A;z)| < C J"
< c?u
,m-2
Jz
r,wm+m—2—<;
dx
o
+C|A|- m /
dx
-l + ci(\x\) 6
L—mj/zu—m
(6.26)
where (5^ is the Kronecker Kronecker delta. delta. Clearly, Clearly, the the last last estimate estimate remains remains valid valid as as 1 well for z eV x such that z € &D(d Q\X\) or z € S S ^ and 1 << |z| |z| << llA A))-- ^ . (The first integral in the the second second line line does does not not enter enter ifif \z\ \z\ >> 1.) 1.) Besides, Besides, as as in the proof of Theorem Theorem 6.1, 6.1, the the restriction restriction $sz $sz << 00 isis not not needed. needed. AA similar similar argument also yields since since m m< < ?? ++ 1, 1, for for zz €€ T\ T\ such such that that \z\ \z\ >> |A|~ |A|~1//ro, c
< c\x\~
m
(x-\z\)
m-2
dx
J\z\
o
\
x
dx
l
-\
(6.27)
With the aid of (6.26) and and (6.27) (6.27) we we then then obtain, obtain, for for all all AA££ Int Int (TuV(6k)), (TuV(6k)),
\G\t < C\\u\\
which leads to (6.20), since since the the second second term term of of the the sum sum on on the the right-hand right-hand 8 side is dominated by the first first one, one, in in view view of of (6.19). (6.19). Let now m > 2 and m — l/{w + 1) < £ < m so that that ?? — {w + l)m. It is then not hard to see that for for zz G GT\, T\, \z\ \z\ < < min min {l, {l, , the second term 7 8
The second integral in the the second second line line does does not not enter enter ifif |A| |A| >> 1.1. It is easily seen that \G\t \G\t is is bounded bounded as as stated stated for for |A| |A| >> d^n7^^tD
as well.
120
CHAPTER6.6.ANALYSIS ANALYSISOFOFSTABILITY STABILITY CHAPTER
in the the second second line line and and the theterm termininthe thethird thirdline lineof of(6.26) (6.26) bounded areare bounded by by C and and C|A| C|A|x/ro, respectively, respectively, and, and, thus, thus,both bothadmit admita acommon commonupper upperbound bound C^l"1 . Therefore, Therefore, instead instead ofof (6.26) (6.26)we wehave have|6|6 (A;z)| << Cl^l"" Cl^l""1 for all all m (A;z)| 1//ro T\ with with \z\ \z\ <<min min{l, {l,|A|~ |A|~ } since since the the first firstintegral integralininthe thesecond secondline line z G T\ ofof z)\ is is is under under the the same samebound boundasasabove. above.Clearly, Clearly, quantity (6.26) is thethe quantity |©m|© (A; z)\ 1 estimated in in the the same sameway wayfor forallallz zGG with1 < 1 <\z\\z\ jAl"" too. Noting Noting estimated T\T\with << jAl"" ^ too. m further that that (6.27) (6.27) remains remainsunchanged unchangedasaswell, well,wewe that\G\t \G\t C|A|^~ further seesee that < < C|A|^~ Int (T (T U UV(Sk)), V(Sk)), which whichimplies impliesagain again(6.20). (6.20). for A ££ Int remains to to show show that that ifif££==0,0,mm= =1,1,and and(6.21) (6.21)hold, hold, estimate It remains thethe estimate is still still valid valid under underthe theweaker weakerrestriction restrictiondeg[o;] deg[o;] Since case (6.20) is << 0. 0.Since thethe case actually settled settled ininthe thepreceding precedingpart partofofthe theproof, proof, without without deg[u;] << — 1 is actually deg[u;] of generality generality itit isisassumed assumedthat thatu>(z) u>(z) = 1. Also, Also, from from now nowon onwe weaccept accept loss of (6.21) holds. holds. Let Let further furthera*a*GGCCbebedefined definedbyby that (6.21)
lim a* = lim
(zpa(z)),
given by and let FFA and FFA be given F A = cA U lA+) U [A-) and FFA = cA U lA+1 U lA~] U? A ,
where where r
ii
cA = }{ zz G GC C :: \z\ \z\ == - | A / aa**||
[f = jz ee C : \z
,, /p
] ]
,
(
GC C :: \z\< \z\< ddo |A|, | a r g ( -- zz))|| < ir -?A = {z G and
\zeC: lf] = \zeC:
do\X\<<\z\ \z\<<-|A/a*| -|A/a*|1 / p , arg^ arg^ == do\X\
x
suppose that that lAl and and ((A are oriented oriented downwards, downwards,which whichfurther furtherspecifies specifies We suppose orientation of ofthe thecontours contoursFF FA . Using Using next next the the operator operatorcalculus calculus the orientation A and F formula (6.4) (6.4) with with mm — —11and andnoting notingthat thata(oo) a(oo)= =0 now, 0 now, formula wewe get,get, for for all all (T U UV(8k)) V(8k)) and uu G G X, X, A (f: Int (T G
:= :=
-
\~1u+—
2-KI
[ ((X-a(-z))((X-a(-z))-1 -A"1) (zI-kA(t))(zI-kA(t))-ludz.
JTx
2 the norm norm of of the theintegrand integrandisisO(|z|~ O(|z|~ follows from from Cauchy's Cauchy'sTheoTheoSince the ), it follows that after after aa suitable suitabledeformation deformationofofthe thecontour contourT\,T\,thethe formula rem that lastlast formula is is
6.1. SOME RESOLVENT ESTIMATES 6.1. SOME RESOLVENT ESTIMATES
121
121
in force with +/ /rr2 2 in inplace place of Observe that the resolin force with JJrrii + of JJ ..Observe alsoalso that the resolrr l (zl— —kA{t))~ kA{t))~ is is holomorphic inaa neighbourhood ofthe theset setsurrounded surrounded vent(zl vent holomorphic in neighbourhood of by Y\.Hence, Hence, by Cauchy's Theorem, by Cauchy's Theorem, by Y\. 1 1 1 1 {zI-kA(t))udz = = O. !! \-\{zI-kA(t))udz O.
M M Wetherefore therefore obtain We obtain 1 1 ll G = = (2m)(2m)( ( A - a ( - z11)-A" ) -A" - 11)) (zl (zl- -kA{t))~ kA{t))~ udz G [[ ((A-a(-z))udz
H H
f
1 1 ll (X-a(-z))(zI-kA(t))udz (X-a(-z))(zI-kA(t))udz
u ++ X-xxXu
11
1 1
u. u.
(6.28)
(6.28)
Sincethe the pair(| (|\\tt;;A(i)) A(i)) is(0|l|
(6.29) (6.29)
Also, itisis easilyseen seen for A^ ^IInnt T t Tand and F\, Also, it easily that that for A zz 66F\, m 2 11 11 2 m (A" (A-- aa((- z- )z) )- xx)| -<
theaid aid of(6.29) (6.29)gives, gives, for A£ £Int Int(T (T UV(6k)) V(6k))and and ueeX, X, whichwith with the of for A U u which
HGiH^CIAr^HI. HGiH^CIAr^HI.
(6.30)
(6.30)
Next,to toestimate estimate Gion on theright-hand right-hand of(6.28), (6.28), observe that inside Gi the side side of observe that inside Next, of the theset set(of (of points) z ofwhich whichY\ Y\isis theboundary, boundary, theoperator operator function of z points) of the the function l 11 —kA(t))" kA(t))" is is holomorphic thefunction function — (Aa(—z))~ a(—z))~has has finitely (zl — holomorphic whilewhile the (A — finitely (zl manypoles. poles. One One pole poleis islocalized localized in inan an annulus annulus many eC: di\X\ di\X\ < \z\< < \z\ <^2!Aj}, <^2!Aj}, < di,d di,d =const const>>0,0, {z {z eC: 2 = 2
and the otherones ones lieoutside outside ofa adisk diskV(ds), V(ds), d%= = const const>>0.0. Thenorm norm of and the other lie of d% The of thecontribution contribution ofthe thefirst firstpole pole tothe the totalsum sum ofresidues residues ofthe theintegrand integrand the of to total of of does notexceed exceed CjA| 1|tt||-while while the otherpoles poles contribution whose does not CjA| -111|tt|| the other give give aacontribution whose not exceedC\\u\\. C\\u\\.It Itthus thusfollows follows for A^ ^ Int Int(T (TU U V(6k)) V(6k)) normdoes does not exceed that that for A norm and uG GX, X, ^ ^ and u
HGall^ClArVH. HGall^ClArVH.
(6-31)
Finally, using and and (6.31) (6.31)as aswell wellas as(6.21) (6.21)for for an an estimation estimation of ofthe the Finally, using (6.30)(6.30) right-hand right-hand sideside of of(6.28) (6.28)readily readily leadsleads to to(6.20) (6.20)in inthe thecase case£ £==0 0 and andm—1. m—1. The proof The proof is isnow now complete. complete.
(6-31)
122 122
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF STABILITY CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF STABILITY
The followingis, is, in infact, fact, aa consequence consequenceof of Theorem Theorem6.3. 6.3. The following Theorem 6.4. 6.4. [*] [*]Let LetA(t) A(t)G G S((f,a) and andlet letthe theRK RKmethod method be be Au(tp)Au(tp)Theorem S((f,a) cpG G (0,w/2) (0,w/2) and andaa GGR.R. Then Then there thereexist existaa set set TTofof stable, with with some somecp stable, Ai-configuration andnumbers numbers 5 5> >00 and andKK>> such that thatfor for all allkkGG(0, (0, K], Ai-configuration and 00 such K], te[0,T}, and\£ and\£ Int Int(T (TUU V(6k)), V(6k)), te[0,T},
o~ > > 00 in inaddition, addition, then thenthe the last last estimate estimatestill stillholds holds for 66==00and and If o~ for KK= = oo.oo. This result is is easily easily seen seenif if one onetakes takes ££ == 0, 0, mm ==1,1,w(^) w(^) 1, and This result = = 1, and the conditionsof of the thepreceding precedingtheorem. theorem. | |t|t == |||| || ||ininthe conditions Remark 6.1. 6.1. [*] [*] The Theresults results of of Theorems Theorems 6.1 6.1 and and6.3 6.3actually actually show showthat that Remark 9 the accepted acceptedconditions conditions theseminorm seminorm |||||| |||n = = \u(—kA(t \u(—kA(tn)) \t \tnn forms forms under the under the A{(£|m)-concordantpair pair As concerns concerns Theorems Theorems6.2 6.2 and and6.4, 6.4, a A{(£|m)-concordant withwith 2l(i n2l(i )- As their assertions actually actually yield for Aj(tp)Aj(tp)- and andAu(tp)-stable Au(tp)-stable methods, methods, their assertions yield thatthat for the operator operator2l(t 2l(t the A\-condition, in particular, the A\-condition satisfies ) satisfies the A\-condition, in particular, the A\-condition the n ifo> 0. 0. ifo- > Remark 6.2. 6.2. [*] [*] Under Under the the conditions conditions of of Theorem Theorem 6.3, 6.3, in in the thecase case £ £ == Remark —l/(w l/(w ++1) 1)and andq q £(m + 1), resolvent estimate estimate(6.20) (6.20) holds m — = =£(m + 1), the the resolvent holds withwith + 11 in inplace place of of m. m. m + This fact fact can canbe beshown shown by by using using the thesame same reasonings reasoningsas as those those leading leadingto to This (6.20). (6.20). In conclusion, conclusion,we wediscuss discuss methods methodsof of class class5 //////.. Theorem 6.5. [*] [*]Let LetA(t) A(t)G G S(tp,o~),let let the theRK RKmethod method be be Auj(ip)-stable, Auj(ip)-stable, Theorem 6.5. S(tp,o~), let aa seminorm seminorm || ||t form, form, aa (£\m\(p,cr)-concordant (£\m\(p,cr)-concordant pair A(t), for for and and let pair withwith A(t), some (p (pG G(0,TT/2), (0,TT/2), a aG GR, R,££>>0,0,and and G such such N that thatm m— —1 < < ££ << m. m. some mm GN Also, suppose that thataa rational rational function functionOJ{Z) OJ{Z) is is (ip)-regular (ip)-regularand and satisfies satisfies the the Also, suppose condition deg[w] deg[w]< < — —<< for some some <; <; > > m. m. Then Then there thereexist existaa set set TT ofof A2condition rrfor A2configuration, with withsingular singular points £1 == 00 and and£2£2= =a(oo), a(oo), and and numbers numbers configuration, points £1 5>0 andK andK >0 >0 such such that thatfor for all allkkGG(0,K], (0,K], t£ t£ [0,T], [0,T], A Agg Int Int(TUX>(<JA:)), (TUX>(<JA:)), 5>0 and uG GX, X, and u
\to(-kA{t)) (XI (XI -\to(-kA{t)) a(oo)|)*|A- a(oo)r a(oo)ri n {{00' ( c -« / r oo- m }}|M|, |M|, (6.32) (6.32) - a(oo)|)*|A The main mainrestriction restriction is that that the the RK RKmethod method is is of ofclass class Si Si or orof ofclass class5//. 5//. The is
6.1. SOME RESOLVENT RESOLVENT ESTIMATES ESTIMATES 6.1. SOME
123 123
wherezu deg[a(-)-a(oo)],K = = (<5 (<5?,(^+i)m ,(^+i)m wherezu = -- deg[a(-)-a(oo)], and £(fo) £(fo) is is defined defined by by (6.25). (6.25). In In the the case case £ = = m m— —l/(w l/(w ++1)1)and and<; — — and m{w 1) — 1, the the last last estimate estimate holds holdswith withK = 00 and andTO£/I TO£/I m + + 11 substituted substituted m{w + 1) m. Also, Also, for for ££ == 00 and andmm==1,1,(6.32) (6.32) is still still valid valid even evenwhen when
m
|A-- a ((oooo))| |m i nn ^ / r o - m > ) , (6.33) (6.33) + |A
where —— deg[a(-) deg[a(-) — a(oo)]. a(oo)]. In particular, particular,11 for for all allkk ££ (0, (0,K\, K\,t t6 6[0,[0, T], where zu — T], and Int (TuV{8k)), (TuV{8k)), and A ££ Int
a^))"1 !! < C C (lAl"" (lAl""1 + |A A-- a(oo)r a(oo)rx ) . \\{XI- a^))" \\{XI
(6.34) (6.34)
o~ > 00 in in addition, addition, the the above above holds holdsfor for 55 == 00 and andKK==00. 00. If o~ Proof. First First of all all note note that that the the latter latter stated statedestimate estimate(6.34) (6.34) consequence Proof. is aa consequence Theorem 6.5 6.5 in in the theparticular particular case casewhere where£ = = 0, 0, m m == 1,1,| | \t\t==|| || ||, ||, and of Theorem and L0(z) 1. L0(z) = 1.
Further, Further, for for A's A's bounded bounded away awayfrom froma(oo), a(oo),(6.33) (6.33) follows follows by by (1.2) (1.2)and and the convexity convexity inequality inequality(A. (A. with = ££ and and(3 (3— —mmsince since the the operator operator 18)18) with a = u)(—kA(t)) is uniformly uniformly bounded boundedwith withrespect respect (0,K] K]and andt tGG[0,T], [0,T], u)(—kA(t)) to kk €€ (0, 10
It is therefore therefore allowed allowedthat thatit would would hold holddeg[w] deg[w]= 0. 0. "When u{z) "When u{z) = = 1,1,££==0,0,mm==1 1
124
CHAPTER CHAPTER 6. 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY
by Lemma 5.3. For A's bounded away from 0, (6.33) is a direct consequence of the estimates and ||(AJ - k%(t))-mLo{-kA(t))\\
< C\X - a(oo)| m i n { ( W r o - m } ,
(6.35)
of which the former one follows from (1.43) with 2l(£) substituted for £. 12 As concerns the latter inequality (6.35), for q < mw it is obtained by applying directly the representation (6.22) and next using the argument employed in the proof of Theorem 6.3. At the same time, if ? > mm, it is seen that as in the proof of Lemma 1.12,
||(AJ - m{t))-m{a{-kA(t))
- a(oo)I)m\\ < C,
while using Lemma 5.3 gives, with ip(z) = (a(z) — a(oo))~~mui(z), {-kA(t))\\
since deg[^] < 0 and ij){z) is (
The estimate (1.43) can be applied due to the fact that 5l(t n) satisfies the A^-condition. As in Section 2.2, we denote by M a constant whose size, unlike that of C, is essential for our analysis and should be under control. 13
6.2. HOLDER-CONTINUITY HOLDER-CONTINUITY TYPE TYPE RESULTS RESULTS
125 125
A(t) G S(ip,a), that for some ipi G (0,
6.2
Holder-continuity Holder-continuity type type results results
Here we show that if the operator A(t) satisfies one of the Holder-continuity then the operator type conditions introduced introduced in the preceding chapter, then 1 2l(£n) = k~ a(—kA(tn)) also satisfies a certain Holder-continuity Holder-continuity condition, condition, with the classes 5/ 5/ among those posed in Part I. The below assertions deal with and Theorem 6.7. Let A(t) G S(
Ait- .,.);|- k t , m = 0,1,*0) 6 M ( t f , i ? i ; 1 | m ; n ,m = 0,/,*0), (6.36)
)
(#,#i;.4(t;-,-);Hm ; t,m = 0,*0,*i) \
'
J - ' II
III n T j / l j
*-')'-')
/1 /1
\\ ""
//
and hol(i?; A(t; , ; I |m;t, m = 0, *0) =
HOL(tf; ||| |||m;n (6.38) m;n, m = 0, *0).
Proof. We will show the implication (6.36) only, only, noting noting that that (6.37) (6.37) and (6.38) can be proved with the aid of the same reasoning.
126
CHAPTER CHAPTER 6. 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY
First of all observe that deg[p] = — 1 since the RK method is of class Sj. We therefore have, with with some some b\, bo, by G C, Jo
p(-z)-
1
mi
= bxz + b0 + Y, J2 M * - zi)~j 1=1
b z
i + bo + P(z),
(6-39)
3=1
where zi, I — 1 , . . . , lo, are the poles of p{—z)~ l and mi is the multiplicity of a pole z\. Next, using the fact that A(t) G S(ip, a), it follows from Lemma A.I that ||(A7 - Ait))-1]] < C|A|- X for all A £ Int (E V1 UV(R)), with some R > 0 and if i G (0,
which gives - 2l(s) =
(bik2i(s) + bQg{s) boQ(t) + 7(t)g(t))
=:
Q1 + Q2.
(6.40) (6.40)
Further, for convenience' sake we put (j>i{t) = (kA(t) — zrf)'1, gij(t) — (
s)xUs (\t - sf\g(t)u\ $.t + \t- s\^\g(t)«| 1;t)
. (6.41)
6.2. HOLDER-CONTINUITY HOLDER-CONTINUITY TYPE TYPE RESULTS RESULTS
127 127
Arguing as above and applying applying the the identity, identity, for for all all xx GG3t* 3t* and and uu €€X, X, m
'o
i
j
bl
, Q2U) = E E (0
iE
A 4 t s; a
" ('
th
m;
EE
+ E E kjAA(t, s; Qij(s) x, g(t) u), i=\
j=i
we have as well l0
mi
1=1
j=l
IQ
mi
\(x,Q2u)\
X 2_\ /_. (I* ~" S^lQljit)
\%;t + I* ~ s l
\Ql,j{t) u\l;t)-
(6-42)
1=1 j=0
Now, putting III ' l*0;n
=
/ . / . {\au(tn)
' l*0;tn + \Ql,j(t n)
|*0;tn) + \Q*(tn)
|*0;tn,
1=1 j=0
and ;0
mj
it follows from (6.40), (6.41), (6.41), and and (6.42) (6.42) that that the the implication implication (6.36) (6.36) holds. holds. cr)-concordant, Note that since 7, < 1, the the pair pair (|(| \^t; A(t)) is (*; 7*|l|>, cr)-concordant, thanks to Lemma 5.1. Using Using then then Theorem Theorem 6.1 6.1 and and taking taking into into account account that deg[p] = —1, it is readily readily seen seen that that the the pair pair (\g*(tn) |*0;tn;2l(£n)) is A?(*i 7*|l)-concordant. Acting Acting after after the the same same pattern, pattern, itit can can be be shown shown that that the pairs (la^-^n) |*0 ;tn ;2l(t n )) and (|^*j(i n ) I*0;tn;2t(*n)), I = I, j — 1 , . . . ,mi, are A^(*; 7*|1)-concordant. 7*|1)-concordant. Therefore Therefore the the pair pair (|H|*0 (|H|*0;n;2l(^n)) that form form is Aj(*;7»|l)-concordant Aj(*;7»|l)-concordant since since |||||| |||*0;n is the sum of seminorms that Aj(*;7*|l)-concordant pairs pairs with with 2l(i 2l(i n ). Similarly, we find that the the pairs pairs (||| (||| |||m;n;2l(*n))) |||m;n;2l(*n))) tn tn == 00,,//,, are are A^('yjl)A^('yjl)and Aj(7i|l)-concordant, Aj(7i|l)-concordant, respectively. respectively. This completes the proof.
128 128
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF STABILITY CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF
STABILITY
The result is helpful when dealing methods of class Thefollowing following result is helpful whenwith dealing with methods of class SJJJ SJJJ .. Theorem 6.8.6.8. Suppose that A(t) the a) RK and method Theorem Suppose thatG S(tp, A(t) a)Gand S(tp, theisRKAiu(tp)method is Aiu(tp)stable, forforsome tp G tp G (0,TT/2) M..M.. Let Let further A(t; , A(t; ) be a , testing stable, some (0,TT/2) and anda aG G further ) be a testing functional forfor A(t)A(t) with Dom.A(£; , ) = V* x, V. that there also are that there are functional with Dom.A(£; ) =Suppose V* x V.alsoSuppose *0,*0, *1, firstfirst two are on given seminorms | | | | m;t m==0,1, 0,1, *1, of ofwhich whichthethe twodefined are defined on given seminorms m;t , m V and other two on so V* that so the that pairs the (\ | pairs (\ | m; A(t)), m = 0,1, *0, *1, V andthethe other twoV*on t; A(t)), m = 0,1, *0, *1, m; are (l/2\tp,cr)-, ji\(p,a)-, (*;l/2\ip,a)-, and (*;and 7*i|<£>,(*;a)-concordant, reare (l/2\tp,cr)-,( (/ ji\(p,a)-, (*;l/2\ip,a)-, 7*i|<£>, a)-concordant, respectively, withwith somesome 71,7*171,7*1 G the the condition deg[a(-)deg[a(-) — [0,1/2]. Then, Then,under under condition — spectively, G [0,1/2]. m m a(oo)] = =—1, therethere exist exist seminorms | | || n> = 0,/, *0,*I, that form rea(oo)] —1, seminorms ||| ||m; n> = 0,/, *0,*I, that form rem; spectively and A2(*;7*i)-concordant pairs spectivelyA2(l/2)A2(l/2)- ; AK71)-, AK71)-,A2(*;l/2)-, A2(*;l/2)-, and A2(*;7*i)-concordant pairs with 2l(£ ), and holdhold the following implications involving hoi hypothe- hoi hypothewith 2l(£n), andthere there the following implications involving ses for A(t) A(t) and HOL for the operator ses forthetheoperator operator and hypotheses HOL hypotheses for 2l(i the operator 2l(i n ) subsubstituted forfor %n,%n, with with any fixed $1 G 1?, $1 G [0,1], stituted any1?,fixed [0,1],
H6L HH V,tfi;IHIL;n,m V,tfi;IHIL;n,m = 0,I,*0), H6L = 0,I,*0),
and and hol(tf;.4(t;-,-);| | | mm;t; t ,m ,m ==0,*0) = >= > HOL(tf; ,m ==0,0,*0). HOL(tf; ||||| |||| mm;n; n ,m *0). hol(tf;.4(t;-,-);| 0,*0) The proof to that Theorem 6.7, using 6.7, as well Theorems 6.5 Theorems 6.5 The proofis similar is similar to ofthat of Theorem using as well and 6.3 and the and fact that = —1. deg[p] = —1. and 6.5*, 6.5*,Remarks Remarks 6.36.3*, andand 6.3*, the deg[p] fact that We a more concreteconcrete assertion assertion which will be neededwill in be needed in We state stateseparately separately a more which the the sequel. sequel. Theorem Let A(t) G S(
(6.43) (6.43)
6.2. HOLDER-CONTINUITY HOLDER-CONTINUITY TYPE TYPE RESULTS RESULTS
129 129
If in addition A{t) satisfies hypothesis hol[i9], hol[i9], then then the term \(I+kA(t))~ lu\t does not enter.
Proof. The result can be shown following the proof Theorem 6.7 and noting, with the aid of Lemmas 5.3 and 1.5, that with no > 0 sufficiently large, for all t G [0,T] andu G X, \\A{t)g{t)u\\ + \\g{t)u\\ < C(||2t(i)n|| + ||n||) < C||(2l(t) + ^I)u\\ and \\{I + kA{t))u{-kA{t))\\ < C, for any rational function u(z) which is ((^)-regular and satisfies the condition D deg[w] < - 1 . D In the remainder of the section we give two auxiliary results which show show the Holder-continuity of a bounded rational function function of the operator A{t) under the assumption that A(t) itself satisfies a Holder-continuity type condition among those stated stated before. before. Lemma 6.1. Suppose that A(t) G S(
rational function which is (ip)-regular and satisfies the condition deg[u;] < 0. Then, with K > 0 sufficiently small, for all k G (0, K] and t,s G [0,T], \\u(-kA(t)) - u{-kA(s))\\ < C\t - sf. Proof. We can assume without loss of generality that deg[a;] < — 1, otherwise we might deal with the function w(z) — w(oo). Having therefore accepted accepted the last inequality, we let ip\ G (0,
= — [
LU(-Z)
((zl - kA{t)Y l - (zl - kA(s))- 1) dz. (6.44)
Using the fact that the domain of A(t) is independent of t, we have as well {zl - kA{t)Y l - {zl - kA{s))~ l = {zl - kA{t))~ lk{A{t) - A{s)) {zl - kA{s))~ 1.
(6.45)
130 130
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSISOF OF STABILITY STABILITY CHAPTER 6.
A(t)G G S((f,a), S((f,a), similarly similarly to(5.7) (5.7) followsthat that Since to it it follows Since A(t)
ffoor ar al llz lEE TT. .
(6.46) (6.46)
Also, usingthis thisestimate estimate andthe the fact that thatA(t) A(t)satisfies satisfieshol[i?], hol[i?], it isisnot not Also, using and fact it hard tosee see that with withsome some fi\ > >0,0,for for z ET, hard to that fi\ allall z ET, 1 1 \\k(A(t)-A(s))(zI-kA(s))\\ \\k(A(t)-A(s))(zI-kA(s))\\ l < Ck\t Ck\t sf\\(A(s) + ml) - kA(s))~ || < - -sf\\(A(s) + ml) (zl - (zl kA(s))~
1 1 < C\t C\t- -s\° s\° + ||(z + (zl fc/ii) (zl -- kA(s))kA(s))\\) \\) < (1(1 + ||(z + fc/ii)
< C\t C\t-- sf. sf. <
(6.47) (6.47)
Combiningtherefore therefore (6.44), and(6.47) (6.47)gives, gives, after simpleestimaestimaCombining (6.44), (6.46),(6.46), and after aa simple tion, tion, l \\u{-kA{t)) -- u(-kA(s))\\ u(-kA(s))\\ <
which shows theclaim claimin inview viewof ofthe theevident evidentestimate estimate which shows the
w(-^)|<
L mmma a6.2. 6.2.Let Let A(t) S(, (*;7*|>,a)-concordant, a)-concordant, respectively, andA(t) A(t)satisfies satisfieshypothhypoth(j\ip,cr)- and respectively, and esis hol($; A(t;, , ;;|| ||m;t m= = 0, 0,*0), *0),for forsome some7,7* 7,7*ee [0,1) [0,1)and and ee (0,1]. (0,1]. esis hol($; A(t; m ; t,,m Finally, letu)(z) u)(z)be bea a rational rationalfunction function which is((p)-regular ((p)-regular andsatisfies satisfiesthe the Finally, let which is and conditiondeg[w] deg[w] < 0. 0.Then, Then,with with K> >00sufficiently sufficientlysmall, small, forall allk kE E(0, (0, K] K] condition < K for andt,s G G[0,T], [0,T], andt,s 111?? 1 \\u{-kA(t)) Lo(-kA(s))\\
Proof. Theresult result is is proved provedin inaamanner mannersimilar similar tothat that used usedin inthe theproof proof Proof. The to 6.1,with with the thedifference differencethat that instead of (6.45) (6.45)we wenow now applythe the of Lemma Lemma6.1, instead of apply of identity, for identity, forall allxxS S X* X*and anduuEX, EX, l kA(s)Y kA(s)Y ) u) u) 1 1 1 1 =kAA(t; =kAA(t; (z*I (z*I--fcA^t))fcA^t))*, *, {zl {zl~~ kA(s))kA(s))u). u).
6.3. 6.3. STABILITY STABILITY ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
131
131
Next, estimating on on the the rightright by analogy with with the proof of Next, estimatingthe theexpression expression by analogy the proof of Theorem 6.7, all all z 6z F,6 F, Theorem 6.7,we wefind findthat thatforfor \\(zl -- kAit))' \\(zl kAit))'1
-- (zl (zl -- ^^( s( s) ))-) - 1 ! ! << C\t C\t --
ll+lf 2 s\°\z\' s\°\z\'ll+lf '- .
Using next for for an an estimation on the of (6.44) leads leads Using next the thelast lastinequality inequality estimation on basis the basis of (6.44) thethe proof of the preceding lemma. to the the desired desiredresult resultasasin in proof of the preceding lemma.
6.3
Stability Stabilityestimates estimates
central partpart of the whole chapter, we examine In this this section, section,which whichis isthethe central of the whole chapter, we examine the stability problem (5.19), (5.20). To prove the problem, the stability ofofthe thediscrete discrete problem (5.19), (5.20). To prove the problem, in Part I as Iwell as the resultsresults we use use here herethe thetheory theorydeveloped developed in Part as well as preparatory the preparatory found sections. found inin the thepreceding precedingtwo two sections. We begin in in thethe casecase withwith a time-independent operator, We beginwith witha adiscussion discussion a time-independent operator, settled trivially, afterafter the above preparations. for which which the thequestion questionis is settled trivially, the above preparations. Theorem 6.10. A(t)A(t) be independent o/t o/t 1 4 and and let let Theorem 6.10. Let Letthetheoperator operator be independent C
(0,K}. (0,K}.
for for alike alike
(6.48) (6.48)
Suppose is ofis type Cj(ip)Cj(ip) or ofortype Suppose further further that thatthetheRKRKmethod method of type of C//(?) type C//(?) (Ai(ip)- or 0) 0) andand thatthat A eAS(ip,a), for some (Ai(ip)or Ajj(ip)-stable Ajj(ip)-stable if iff(t)f(t)= = e S(ip,a), for some
L
max max ||/(ty)ll) ||/(ty)ll)
(6-49) (6-49)
Moreover, 0 and /^o /^o = 0, valid Moreover, ififininaddition additiona a> > 0 and 0, then then the thelast lastestimate estimateis is valid 15 and KK ==oo ooasaswell. well. for TT == oo oo and Proof. itit follows t h atth a t Proof. Since Since deg[tOj] deg[tOj] < < 0,0,j j= = l,...,v, l,...,v, follows from fromLemma Lemma5.35.3 ||U;J(—fc.A)|| by by (5.28), ||U;J(—fc.A)|| < C, C, which whichfurther furthergives, gives, (5.28),
\\w \\w T(-kA)$ (-kA)$ n\\
for for ttn e
titik-
(6-50) (6-50)
j=l,...,v j=l,...,v
Clearly, valid for for Ai(ip)or AJJ methods Clearly, the thelast lastestimate estimateremains remains valid Ai(ip)or (
We can 21 instead of A(t) and and 2l(£),2l(£), respectively. We can therefore thereforewrite writeA Aandand 21 instead of A(t) respectively. That is, That is, for for all alln n= = 0 ,,11,,..... .
15
132
CHAPTER6.6.ANALYSIS ANALYSISOFOFSTABILITY STABILITY CHAPTER
satisfies the the Aj-condition, Aj-condition, ininparticular, particular,the theAi-condition Ai-condition case satisfies in in thethe case a >a 0.> 0. conclude the the proof, proof, it remains remains to to apply apply Theorem Theorem2.17, 2.17,noting notingthat thatthethe To conclude (||(2l+/zo-O^ 'Ih^l) 'Ih^l)isisAf Af(^)-concordant, (^)-concordant,inin particular, Ai(£)-concordant pair (||(2l+/zo-O^ particular, Ai(£)-concordant Lemma 1.12. 1.12. if a > > 00 and and /J,Q — 0, by Lemma Theorem 6.11. 6.11. Let Letthe theoperator operator A(t)==A Asatisfy satisfythethe conditions of Theorem Theorem A(t) conditions of Theorem 6.10 and and let let the the RK RK method methodbebeofoftype typeCui(
(6.51) (6.51)
where u>(z) u>(z) is a rational rationalfunction function which whichisis((p)-regular ((p)-regularand and under requireunder thethe requirewhere with some some ??eeNN, , ment, with deg[w] -<;, deg[w] < -<;,
(6.52) (6.52) 16
then, assuming assuming that that the RK RK method method itself itself satisfies satisfies the condition condition deg[wj]<-q, deg[wj]<-q,
= l,...,u, l,...,u, jj =
(6.53) (6.53)
holds for any any fixed £ € [0,q/w], [0,q/w], where where w — — — deg[o;(-) deg[o;(-) — —a(oo)]. a(oo)]. (6.49) holds Moreover, if a > > 00 and and /io /io== 0,0, the theabove above is valid for T — —K K == 00 00 as aswell. Moreover, Proof. follows from from Theorem Theorem 6.6 6.6that thatthe theoperator operator2121 satisfies Proof. It follows satisfies thethe A|-A|condition, in particular, particular, the theA2-condition A2-conditionif ifa a> >0. 0.Note Note also that (6.50) condition, in also that (6.50) holds for for methods methods ofoftype typeCjjj(ip) Cjjj(ip)asaswell. well.Therefore, Therefore, even if (6.51) —(6.53) even if (6.51) —(6.53) are not not necessarily necessarilysatisfied, satisfied,(6.49) (6.49)with with£ £—— follows Theorem 2.17 since 00 follows byby Theorem 2.17 since the pair pair (|| (|| ||;2l) ||;2l) isisthen, then,obviously, obviously,A2(O)-concordant A2(O)-concordant(A2(0)-concordant (A2(0)-concordant if if a > 00 and and fio fio== 0). 0). Now we we turn turn to to the the case casewhere where(6.51) (6.51)and and(6.53) (6.53)hold, hold, under above under thethe above OJ(Z), including including (6.52). (6.52). By By (6.53) (6.53)ititthen thenfollows followsfrom fromLemma Lemma conditions on OJ(Z), conditions on 5.3 that that the the operators operators (/(/++kAywj(-kA), kAywj(-kA), j j= =1,... 1,...,u,,u,areare defined X for defined on on X for k
with Q = (I (I + +kA)-* kA)-* and andFFn = (I + +kAyv/T'(-kA)$ '(-kA)$n, (6.54), (6.54), ||Fn||
This condition condition is not not needed needed if f(t) == 0. 0.
where, by (5.28) (5.28) and where, (6-55) (6-55)
6.3. STABILITY ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
133 133
Now, by Theorem 6.6 (see (see also also Remark Remark 6.3) 6.3) we we conclude conclude that that the the pairs pairs (||(2l + / x o J ) M - * ^ ) -II;21) a n d ( | | ( * + / x o / ) € ( / + fcA)-< - I I ; » ) a r e A § ( 0 concordant if £ <
134
CHAPTER CHAPTER 6. 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY
hol®[i?; | |t], for some 71 G G [0,1) [0,1) and and $$ G G (0,1]. Apart from everything else, else, let (6.48) hold. Then, with any fixed ££ €€ [0,1) [0,1) and and with with any any fixed fixed /io /io >> 00 sufficiently large, we have, have, for for all all kk G G (0, (0,K] K] and and tn,ti G fifc with ti < t n, ||(2l(tn) + iJorfUn-ijW < Ct~i Ct~il+V
(6.56)
problem (5.19), (5.19), (5.20), (5.20), and for Y n the solution of problem
||(2l(tn) + Mo I)^n|| ^ C K I J ^ H + fc^Xii fc^Xii max max ||/(ty)ll) ||/(ty)ll) .. (6.57) (6.57) fixed Furthermore, with any fixed fixed 00 << £* £* << min{i9,1 min{i9,1 — 71} and with any fixed pbQ > 0 sufficiently large, for for all all kk G G (0, (0, K] K] and and tn,ti G flk such that t\
< Ct~i].
(6.58) (6.58)
remains valid valid ifif one one adds adds In the case £* = min{i9,1 min{i9,1 — 71} the last estimate remains log(£n_/_|_i/fc) to the factor t~_ t~_t. If in addition the operator operator A(t) A(t) satisfies satisfies hypothesis hol[#], then (6.56) (6.56) and and (6.57) (6.57) are are valid validfor for any any fixed fixed££ GG[0, [0, Moreover, they retain their their shapes shapes even even for for ££ == 11++ $$ provided provided that that t~ t~ isis 1 log(t j+i/k). replaced by tj* + tj Proof. First of all it follows from from (5.41), (5.41), (5.34), (5.34), and and (5.43) (5.43) that that | | F n | | < C max ||/(i n j )||.
(6.59) (6.59)
Also, observe that the operator operator 2l(i 2l(i n ) satisfies the A^-condition, A^-condition, by by Theorem Theorem 6.2. Further, consider the general general case case where where the the operator operator A(t) A(t) satisfies satisfies hyhypothesis h61®[$; I |t]. Observing Observing then then that that for for methods methods of of type type Vj((p), Vj((p), deg[vj]
< - 1 = deg[p],
j =
l,...,v,
and noting that the function function p(z)"1 is (?)-regular, it is seen seen that that the the operator operator 1 ( ^ ( - ^ ( i ) ) ) " " is defined on RanVj(—kA(t)). RanVj(—kA(t)). Thus Thus by by Lemmas Lemmas 5.3 5.3 and and 1.5 1.5 we have, with fi\ coming coming from from the the statement statement of of hypothesis hypothesis hol®[#; hol®[#;| | |t]|t] and and for jj == 11,,......,, vv and and for for all all ttii££ll,, with some /J,Q > 0 sufficiently large, for
< C\\(p(-kA(t))r\(-kA(t))\\ C\\(p(-kA(t))r\(-kA(t))\\
\\A(t)p(-kA(t))u\\ \\A(t)p(-kA(t))u\\ ++ C\\u\\ |. (6.60)
6.3. STABILITY
ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
135 135
Using now (5.39) and taking taking into into account account the the estimates estimates (5.34), (5.34), (5.43), (5.43), and the accepted Holder-continuity Holder-continuity type type condition, condition, with with the aid of (6.60) we obtain, for all u £ X, V
||2M! <
cY/\\('Dn-'D(tn))vj(-kA(tn))u\\ (
n) + lilI)Vj(-kA(t n))u\\ + \Vj(-kA{t n)) u\tn
J=l v
^
.
(6.61) (6.61)
Since 2l(t n ) satisfies the Aj-condition, Aj-condition, by by Lemma Lemma 1.1 1.1 we we have have ||fc2l(i ||fc2l(in)|| < C, which further implies
+ MO/) U\\ < C||(2l(tn) + MI/) uW1-*\\uf. Using the last estimate estimate and and applying applying Lemma Lemma 1.7, 1.7, it easily follows that the seminorm fc^||(2l(i n) + Mo/) II forms a Aj(l — $|l)-concordant pair with Also, applying Lemma 5.1 shows shows that that the the seminorm seminorm | \t is, in fact, with , cr)-concordant with A(t) since 71 < 1, which therefore yields, with v \tn forms the aid of Theorem 6.1, that the seminorm X^=i \ j(~kA(tn)) a Aj(7i|l)-concordant pair l,...,u. pair with with 2t(i 2t(i n ) since deg[uj] < —1, j = Further, by Lemma 1.8 we we conclude conclude that that the the seminorms seminorms A; A;1'||(2l(tn) + MO/) II and X]^=i l v j ( ~ ^ ( * n ) ) '\tn both form A^(7o|l)-concordant A^(7o|l)-concordant pairs pairs with with 2l(i 2l(i n ), where 70 — max{l — i9,7i}. These observations clearly clearly yield yield that that the pair (||!Bn-1|; 2l(t n )) is Aj(7o|l)-concordant. Also, Also, using using Theorem Theorem 6.9 6.9 gives gives that that 1 8 2l(t n ) satisfies hypothesis HOL HOL (->) (i9,0; ||| | m ; n , m = 0,/,*0) with ||| ||0.n = ||(2t(t n) + Mo/) || and ||| \\^.n = || ||* while the seminorm ||| | / ;; nn = |(/+fcA(i n ))~ 1 \tn forms a Aj(7i|l)-concordant pair with with 2l(i 2l(i n ), by Theorem 6.1. By the above reasonings, reasonings, applying applying Theorems Theorems 2.10, 2.10, 2.16, 2.16, and and 2.11, 2.11,all allofof them with 2l(i n ) substituted for Qln, and taking (6.59) into account, account, we we see see that the estimates (6.56) (6.56) and and (6.57) (6.57) hold hold for for ££ G G [0,1) [0,1) and and the theestimate estimate (6.58) (6.58) holds for £* e [0, min{i9,1 — 71}] since the seminorms seminorms ||||(2l(t (2l(t n ) + Mo/)^ II and ||(2t*(t n) + Mo/)^* ||* are respectively Aj(£|l)- and Ai(*;£»|l)-concordant with 52l(tn) for any fixed £ € [0,1], by Lemma 1.12. 18
One has to take into account account that that \\(p{-kA(t)))* \\(p{-kA(t)))* ||» ||» < C for all k G (0, K] and t G [0, T], by Lemma 5.3 and duality. duality.
136 136
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY CHAPTER 6.
the case case where whereA(t) A(t) satisfies satisfies hypothesis hypothesishol®[#], hol®[#], instead of (6.61) (6.61) we we In the instead of have, for for all all uu GGX, X, have,
so tthhaatt (6.56) (6.56) a nndd (6.57) (6.57) hold hold for for ££ ee [1,1 [1,1++tf]tf]asaswell, well, by by T hheeoorreemmss2.10, 2.10, 2.16, a nndd 6.9, 6.9,m oorree precisely, precisely, by by tthhee latter l a t t e r ppaar rt t of of tthhee s t aatteem meennt t of of each each 2.16,
one. one. Theorem 6.13. 6.13. Suppose Suppose that thatA(t) A(t) G GS{ip,a) S{ip,a) and and the the RK RK method method is is both both Theorem type Vi((p) Vi((p) and and of of type type Vf(ip), Vf(ip), for for some some ip ip G G (0,TT/2) (0,TT/2) and and aa GGM. M. Also, Also, of type seminorms \ |® |®;t and and \\ | m | ;;tt, m m == 0,1, 0,1,*0, *0, form form respectively respectively(7®|y, (7®|y, cr)-, let seminorms cr)-, m (j\ip,a)-, (71 (71
some ix-y ix-y> 00 and and some
I(A(t) ++miy^u^.t miy^u^.t < < C\\u\\ k^' I(A(t) C\\u\\
(6.62) (6.62)
and and *
I)-TyXU,t ttt1I)-Ty
< C\\x\\*C\\x\\*<
(6.63) (6.63)
Next, letting letting A(t;-,-) A(t;-,-) be be aa testing testing functional functional for for A(t), A(t), suppose suppose that that A{t) A{t) Next, satisfies the hypotheses hypotheses hoi®. hoi®.Ji9@; Ji9@; |-|© |-|©;t] andh.or'('d,'d\\A(t\ andh.or'('d,'d\\A(t\ ;|-|m;t)'Ti 'Ti = = satisfies the , , ; |-|m;t *0) for for some some i9©,i9 i9©,i9G (0,1] (0,1] and andd\d\ GG[0,1], [0,1], where where > i?. i?.++ 1?*.. 1?*.. Apart Apart 0 , 11,, *0) >
from everything everything else, else,suppose suppose (6.48) holds. the stability stability estimate estimate from thatthat (6.48) holds. ThenThen the (6.58) holds holdsfor for any any fixed fixed fj,o fj,o> > 00 sufficiently sufficiently large largeand and for for any anyfixed fixed £* £*G G (6.58) [0, £o)> £o)> where where£0 £0 == 11++min{i9 min{i9 — — 7, i?i i?i — — 71}, 71}, and and itit remains remains valid validin in the the case case — £0 £0 ifif one oneadds adds t~2.}log(t t~2.}log(t i/k) to the thefactor factor t~_ t~_t. Furthermore, Furthermore, if £* — to n^i+i/k) in addition, addition, the the stability stability estimates estimates (6.56) (6.56)and and (6.57) (6.57) hold holdfor for any any $1 > 00 in fixed no no > 00 sufficiently sufficiently large largeand and for for any anyfixed fixed £ G G [0,£i), [0,£i), where where£1 £1 == fixed 1— — 7* 7* ++ min{$,T9i}. min{$,T9i}. In In the the case case £ = = £1, £1,both both estimates estimates retain retaintheir theirshapes shapes with tq tq replaced replacedby by tq tq ++ tq~ tq~12 log(t log(tq+i/k), +i/k), where where72 72 is is given given by by (2.57). (2.57). with Proof. First Proof. First of of all, all, to to make make our our below below argument argumentcorrect, correct,we we assume assume that that is extrapolated extrapolated by by A(t) A(t) ==A(T) A(T)for fort > t >T.T. A(t) A(t) is Further, notethat thatthe the estimate estimate (6.59) (6.59)is unchanged unchanged in in the the considered considered Further, note case. At the thesame same time timehypothesis hypothesishor~^($, h o r ~ ^ ( $$1; , $1; A(t; ,, ;;| | | m; |m;t, t,tn tn == 0,1, 0,1,*0) *0) case. At A(t; >)) (—> for A(t) A(t) implies, implies, by by T hheeoorreemm 6.7, 6.7,t h aatt hypothesis hypothesisH O O LL (#, ( # $, 1 ;; ||| | m ;; nn , m m == *0)is isfulfilled fulfilled for for 2l(i 2l(in ) s uubbssttiittuut teeddfor for 22lln , where w h e r e t hhee seminorms s e m i n o r m s ||| | m ;; nn, 0, / , *0) 19
Since Since A(t) A(t) €€ S(
6.3. STABILITY ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
137 137
m = 0,7, *0, form respectively respectively A* (7)-, Af(7i)-, and Af(*;7*)-concordant Af(*;7*)-concordant pairs with 2l(£ n), due to the conditions imposed imposed on on || || m;t , m = 0,1, *0. Next, since degf^j] < —1 —1 and and deg[i«j] deg[i«j] << —1 —1for for jj — —1,... 1,... ,u, ,u, applying applying Theorems 6.1 and 6.1* yields yields that that the the seminorms seminorms .0;n
and 3=1
form respectively A* (7)- and A^(7i)-concordant A^(7i)-concordant pairs pairs with with the the operator operator 2l(t n). Moreover, recalling that the the pair pair (|(| l^; l^; A(t)) A(t)) isis strictly strictly (*;7*|y>, (*;7*|y>, cr)concordant, it is readily seen seen that that the the seminorm seminorm n))y
U-tn+Cjk
forms a Aj(*; 7*)-concordant 7*)-concordant pair pair with with 2l(t 2l(tn). Apart from everything everything else, else, assuming that we have shown shown the the estimate, estimate, with with the the operator operator 25 25n given by (5.39), for all t n G ftk, x G X*, and u e X, (6.64)
it holds, with i9o = min{$,$i}, min{$,$i}, 70 70 == i?o i?o++ max{7 max{7—i9,7i —i9,7i — ^1}, and ||| |.. n =
Therefore, noting that by by Lemma Lemma 1.2, 1.2, the the seminorm seminorm |||||| |.|. ; n forms a A^ concordant pair with 2l(£ 2l(£n) and taking the above reasonings reasonings into into account, account, the claim follows by applying applying Theorems Theorems 2.12 2.12 and and 2.17 2.17with with2l(i 2l(in) substituted for 2ln, with 23 n given by (5.39) and with with 7*0 7*0 == 7*7*It thus remains to show (6.64). (6.64). To To that that end, end, note note that that as as itit follows follows from from (5.39), the operator 25 n can be represented as Q3 Q3n = ©i ;n + 232;m where
and
k(V n - ©(*„)) (i + x (D n - !D(t n))v(-fcA(tn)).
(6.65) (6.65)
138 138
CHAPTER6. 6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY CHAPTER
It is obvious, obvious, since sinceA(t) A(t) is isunder under hypothesis hypothesish ho ol ^l (^i(9i,9$1; , $1; A(t; ,, ;;| | | mm;;tt, m m == A(t; 0,1, *0),that that (6.64) (6.64) holds holdswith withQ3i Q3i substituted for *B therefore suffices 0,1, *0), substituted for *B . It therefore suffices ;n n place of 5B 5Bn, which which is clearly clearly achieved, achieved, with with to show show (6.64) (6.64) with withQ52 Q52 ;n in place aid of of (6.65) (6.65) and and hypothesis hypothesis hhool ^l ^( i(?i ,?i,?ii?; i^;(^t (; t ;,, ;;|| | m; t,m = = 0,1, 0,1,*0), *0), the aid m ;t,m if we we prove prove that that with withe, — —{Sji,..., {Sji,..., —11,,......,, v, for for all allt tn G G fifc fifc ) ) , jj — (u\,..., Uu) Uu) G GVom Vom xx xxVorn, Vorn, u = (u\,..., V
V(tn))u\. ))u\.]tn < cY,\ cY,\ui\'-,tn, i\'-,tn, n - V(t j = ll
(6-66) (6-66)
3=13=1
&1 where is denoted denoted | |.|.; t = = k^\ k^\ \^\^t + + k' k'&1 |x;t- For Forshowing showing (6.66), (6.66),we weuse use where it is \ |x;tformula (5.49),with withboth bothsides sides multiplied from the right right by by k(D k(Dn — D(£ D(£n ))u, ))u, formula (5.49), multiplied from the to obtain obtain l n
D(tn ))u = (i (i ++ kaV(t kaV(tn))-1ak{'D ak{'Dn -- D(t
T>{tn))u -- T>{t
mind, it is is not not hard hard to see, see,applying applying the the kicking-back kicking-back With this this equality equalityin mind, With verified if we we show show instead instead that thatfor for all all ttn G &k &kand and trick, that (6.66) (6.66)will willbe verified trick, that u = ( uu jj ,,......, , uu)
G G Vom Vom xx
x xT>om, T>om,
V
n
0)(tn))u|. ))u|.;tn < -- ]]££ |^|. | ^ | .; t n . - 0)(t
(6.67) (6.67)
Since the Since the entries entries of the the matrix matrix (i -- zaj^a zaj^a vanish vanishas \z\ \z\ —>>oo, oo, (6.67) (6.67) is, is, in in fact, consequence of the the following following fact. fact. For For any any fixed fixed rational rational function function fact, a consequence ijj(z) which which is (?)-regular (?)-regular and and satisfies satisfies the the condition condition deg[u;] deg[u;]< —1, —1, it holds, holds, ijj(z) > 0, 0, for for all allkkGG(0, (0, K],t G t G [0,T], and and uu G G Vom, Vom, with with some some e > K], [0,T],
Cke\u\,, \u\,,u \u(-kA(t))k{A(t ++ck) ck)- -A(t))u\., A(t))u\., \u(-kA(t))k{A(t t < Ck
(6.68) (6.68)
so that that the the factor factor Ck Cke on on the the right right can can be be taken taken arbitrarily arbitrarilysmall smallat the the expense choosingsuitably suitablyK > > 0. 0. Observe Observenow nowthat that if K K> > 00isissufficiently sufficiently expense of choosing the negative negative fractional fractionalpowers powers(/ ++ kA(t))~ kA(t))~T, r >> 0, 0, of ofthe theoperator operator small, small, the I + kA(t) kA(t) are aredefined defined and and bounded bounded on on 3£ 3£for for kk GG(0, (0,K] K](cf. (cf.Appendix AppendixA.3). A.3). Furthermore, since7 7 1 7+*7 *< 1, 1, there there exist exist 7J >> 71 71and and7^ 7^>>7*7*such such that that Furthermore, since 1+ 7i + 7* 7* == 1.1. Using Using the the fact fact that that the the seminorms seminorms | |i|i;t and and || \^. \^.t form form respectively (71 (71|y, a)a)- and and strictly strictly (*;7*|v, (*;7*|v,cr)-concordant cr)-concordantpairs pairs with with A(t), A(t), respectively
6.3. STABILITY STABILITY ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
139 139
similarly to Lemma Lemma 1.9 1.9 itit can can be beshown shown that that for for all all kk GG{0,K], {0,K], t G G [0,T], [0,T], similarly X, and and xx GG£*; £*; u e X, sup | ( // ++ ^ ( tt )) )) ^^nn| |0 ; tt + FF** sup sup fc» sup IMI=i llxll.=i IMI=i llxll.=i
i i
(6.69) (6.69)
Also, follows from from Lemma Lemma5.3 5.3 that that Also, it follows ||wi(-fcA(t))|| < C C for for aUfce aUfce {0,K} {0,K} and andii GG[0,T], [0,T], ||wi(-fcA(t))||
(6.70) (6.70)
where 0)1(2) = (1 (1 — z)a>(,z). z)a>(,z). where 0)1(2) Now, with with the the aid aid of ofthe theidentity identity20 Now, u(-kA(t)) == (I(I u(-kA(t)) applying the estimates estimates (6.62), (6.62),(6.63), (6.63),and and (6.70), (6.70), we therefore therefore obtain, obtain,for all all applying the (0,K], £ G G [0,T], [0,T], and and itit G GPom, Pom, k G (0,K],
cfc) cfc) -- A(t))u\\ A(t))u\\ yl(t + cfc) A(t))u\\ ck) - A(t))u\\ (6.71) | 1 ; t ) . (6.71) similar manner manner since since7^ + + 7^ 7^ — 1, applying applying the the identity identity In a similar
using (6.69) (6.69) and and (6.70) (6.70) and and the the above above argument, argument, we we get, get, for for all allkkGG and using (0,K], G [0,T], [0,T], and and uu G G Vom, Vom, (0,K], t G to(-kA(t)) k(A(t k(A(t ++ck) ck)- - A(t))u\i A(t))u\iitit to(-kA(t)) tf
) (6.72) (6.72)
—min{i9 min{i9 —19. —19.— ?9*., ?9*.,1 — 71 — 7*} 7*} by by combining combining Finally, (6.68) (6.68) follows followswith withe — Finally, (6.71) and and (6.72), (6.72), noting noting that thate > > 00 since since d, -f-1?*. -f-1?*. < i9 i9 and and 71 71++7* 7*<<1.1. (6.71) Theorem 6.14. Theorem 6.14. Suppose Suppose that that A(t) A(t) G GS((p, S((p,a) a) and andthe theRK RKmethod method is both bothof Vj(ip) and and of of type type Vf(
recall that that 7 + + 7. 7. == 1.1. We recall
140 140
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF STABILITY CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF STABILITY
(*;7*|y>, &)-,(*;7*i|y, (*;7*i|y, andstrictly strictly (^(p, (^(p,a)-concordant a)-concordant pairs pairswith with A(t) (*;7*|y>, &)-, cr)-cr)A(t) t and for some7®, 7®, 7*, 7*1,7 G[0,1) [0,1)such such that that7 7 ++ 7* 7*==11and and 7 7*1 + 7*1 < < 1, 1, and andlet let for some 7*, 7*1,7 G 7+ the inequalities(6.62) (6.62) and(6.63) (6.63) hold holdfor for some some JJL\ JJL\ > > 00 and and G[0>l)[0>l)the inequalities and . .G Also, letting A(t; A(t;-,-, ) )6e6ea atesting testing functional functionalfor for A(t), A(t), suppose suppose that thatA(t) A(t) Also, letting satisfies the thehypotheses hypotheses hol^Ji?©; hol^Ji?©; |-|mm;t>m ;t>m = = satisfies |-|®|-|® 11^ ^( i(?i,?i ?, ii ?; >i ;l > ( tl; ( t,,; ;;|-| ;t] aannddhh66 0, *0, *0,*1) *1)for for some some tftfffi ,i9 G (0,1] and t? [0,1], w/iere i9 > 1?. 1?*.. ylpart ,i9 G (0,1] and t? € [0,1], w/iere i9 > 1?. + 1?*.. ylpart ffi x from everything everythingelse, else, suppose (6.4.8) Then thestability stability estimates estimates from suppose thatthat (6.4.8) holds.holds. Then the (6.56) and (6.57) (6.57) hold holdfor for any anyfixed fixed /J,Q /J,Q> > 00 sufficiently sufficiently large large andfor forany any (6.56) and and fixed G[0, [0,£o)> £o)>where where £0 £0== 11++min{i9 min{i9— — 7*,i?i 7*,i?i — — 7*1}, 7*1}, and andthey they remain remain valid valid fixed ££ G 7 in the thecase case £ £ == £0 £0ififone one adds £<J~ £<J~log(t log(tg ++i /k) /k) to tothe thefactor factor tq. tq. Furthermore, adds Furthermore, in addition addition $1 $1>> 0,0,the thestability stability estimate estimate (6.58) (6.58) holds for any anyfixed fixed /J,Q /J,Q> > 00 if in holds for sufficiently largeand andfor forany anyfixed£* fixed£* G G[0,£i), [0,£i), where where£1 £1 = = 1— 1—7+min{'#,'#i}. 7+min{'#,'#i}. sufficiently large In the the case case £* £* == £i; £i;£/ws £/ws estimate retains retains its its shape shape with with t~_ t~_t replaced replaced by by estimate t~l*i + t~Zf t~Zf log(t log(tn-i+i/k), -i+i/k), where7*2 7*2«s «s#wen #wen by by (2.74). (2.74). t~l*i + where The proofis is similar similar to to that that of of Theorem Theorem6.13. 6.13. The proof In principle, principle,in in the thestatement statement of of Theorem Theorem 6.13 6.13we wemay maywithdraw withdrawthe the In assumptions (6.62)and and (6.63) (6.63) since sinceusing usingthe the argument argument employed employed in the the assumptions (6.62) in proof of Theorem Theorem6.12 6.12as aswell well as as hypothesis hypothesishol^Ji?©; hol^Ji?©; \t]leads leadsto to the thefact fact proof of | \t] that (2.54) (2.54)holds holdswith with #0 == 7*0 7*0==0 0and and = — — {1i?©,7©}. i?©,7©}. Therefore, Therefore, #0 7070 = {1 that applyingagain againTheorem Theorem 2.12,one onecan can state an an analogue analogueof of Theorem Theorem6.13 6.13 in in applying 2.12, state which theconditions conditions(6.62) (6.62) and(6.63) (6.63) are areremoved removedbut butititisisrequired requiredinstead instead which the and that 70 << 11— — 7* 7*++ min{i9,i?i}, min{i9,i?i},£* £* << 11— — 70, 70,and and££<<1 1 additionto to what what that 70 inin addition is already alreadyaccepted, accepted, where in the thelimiting limitingcases cases£» £» == 11— —70 70 and and££==1,1, the in the where stability estimatesare are accordingly accordinglycorrected. corrected.In In aa similar similar manner mannerone onecan can stability estimates show aa modification modificationof of Theorem Theorem6.14 6.14by byapplying applyingTheorem Theorem 2.13. show 2.13. We do not notintend intend to to examine examinemethods methodsof of class class SJJ SJJ in inthe thecase case with withaa We do variable operatorfor for the thereason reason that thatsuch suchaa consideration considerationwould would contain variable operator contain the results results do do not notseem seem to to be be many additionaltechnical technical difficulties the many additional difficulties whilewhile widely applicable.Now Nowwe weturn turn to to the thestudy study of of methods methodsof of class class SS1///. ///. widely applicable. Theorem 6.15. 6.15.Suppose Suppose that thatA(t) A(t) GGS(tp,a) S(tp,a) and andthat that the the RK RK method method is is Theorem both of of type type Vjn((p) Vjn((p) and andof oftype type Vf VfH{}p) {}p) and andsatisfies satisfies the thecondition conditiondeg[a(-) deg[a(-) — both — a(oo)] = = —1, —1,for for some some ip ip G G(0,TT/2) (0,TT/2) and andaa GGR.R. Suppose Supposefurther furtherthat that a a(oo)] a seminorm forms aa (71 (71|y, |y,a)-concordant a)-concordantpair pair with the operator operatorA(t) A(t)and and seminorm \\ \\t forms with the A{t) itself A{t) itselfsatisfies satisfieshypothesis hypothesis hol®[i9; hol®[i9; \-\t), \-\t), for for some some 71 71G G[0,1) [0,1)andd andd G G (0,1]. (0,1]. Finally, Finally, let letLO(Z) LO(Z) be beaa rational rationalfunction functionwhich which is is (ip)-regular (ip)-regularand andsubject subject to to deg[a;] deg[a;] < < —1. —1. Then Thenit it holds, holds, with with2J 2Jn = = uj{—kA(t uj{—kA(tn)) and andQ3_i Q3_i==2Jo, 2Jo, with with sufficiently large, large,and and with with any any fixed fixed £ £G G [0,1), [0,1), for for all all any any fixed fixed [IQ [IQ > 00 sufficiently
6.3. STABILITY ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
141 141
k G (0, K] and t n,ti G fife such that ti < tn,
|| < Ct~il+V
(6.73)
i/ i/ie operator 91 in (5.19) is given by DK = u>(—kA(0)), then the solution Yn of (5.19), (5.20) satisfies the stability estimate (6.57). (6.57).
Proof. First of all note that by Lemma 5.3, it suffices to show the claim in the particular case u(z) = (1 — z)~l which is equivalent to the fact that QJn — {I + kA(tn))~l for t n G (lk- From now on we therefore accept the last assumption. Further, by Theorem 6.6 the operator 2l(t n ) satisfies the A^-condition, while using Theorem 6.9 yields that 2l(i n ) substituted for Qln satisfies hypothesis HOL ~* ($, 0; 1 | m ; n , m = 0, / , *0), where with some no > 0,
||m;n
\\((I + kAitn))" 1)*
if m = 0, if m = / , ||* if m = *0,
since the seminorm \\(p(—kA(t n)))* ||* appearing in (6.43) is replaced by ||((/ + kA(tn))~1)* ||*, by Lemma 5.3 and duality. Observe that the triplet (||(2l(i n ) + / V ) ||;2l(^n); {I + kAitn))-1) is A|(l)-concordant, by Theorem |t n ;2l(^); (/ + kA(tn))~l) is A^( 7 i)6.6, while the triplet (|(/ + kA^))-1 concordant, by Theorem 6.5. Also, a slightly more delicate calculation calculation than than with the aid of (5.39) and (5.43), for the one leading to (6.61) gives, again with all tn <E Clk, X G £*, and u e X,
3= 1
where the seminorms Y!j=i W(.wj(-kA(tn)))* ||* and Y!j=\ \vj(~kA(tn)) \tn may be replaced, by Lemma 5.3, respectively by ||((I + kAftn))^ 1)* ||* and by !(/ + kA{tn))~l \tn, preserving the needed properties since deg[u;j] deg[u;j] < —1 and deg[«j] < — 1 for j = 1 , . . . , v. Furthermore, it is easily checked, using the assumed Holder-continuity Holder-continuity
142 142
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF STABILITY CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF STABILITY
hypothesis for A(t) A(t) and andarguing arguing as as above, above, that thatfor for all alltn,ti G G Cl^, Cl^, hypothesis for
=
||I++k(A(ti) k(A(ti) -- A(t A(tn)) (I (I ++ ||I
<
Ck\\{A(ti) + + fill) fill) (I (I + + 11++ Ck\\{A(ti) 11 +Ck sup sup KZ KZ +Ck
<
C. C.
(6.74)(6.74)
Therefore, using usingthe the above above reasonings, reasonings,the the stability stability estimate estimate(6.73) (6.73) follows Therefore, follows 2.15since since the thetriplet triplet (||(2l(i (||(2l(i + /i 0 -0 C ll;2l(*n)". ll;2l(*n)".(I (I + + kA(t kA(tn))))-1) by Theorem Theorem2.15 by n) + A2(^|l)-concordant, in view view of of Theorem Theorem6.6. 6.6. is A2(^|l)-concordant, in To completethe the proof, proof, F Fn and andYQ YQ are are represented representedby by To complete = 2J 2Jn F n and andyy0 = = 9J-ig°, 9J-ig°, Fn = andy° y°==(I(I+ +kA(0))9iy kA(0))9iy0. and
Fn = = (I (I ++kA(t kA(tn))F ))Fn with F with (5.43) gives gives (5.43)
||Fn || <
Usingnow now(5.41) (5.41)and and Using (6.75) (6.75)
3=l,...,v 3=l,...,v
by (6.74), (6.74), we we have have while, by while, I I 55°°IIII<
(6.76) (6.76)
With the the aid aidofof(6.75) (6.75) and and (6.76), (6.76), and andthe theabove above observations, observations, it is is readily readily With it nowthat that (6.57) (6.57)follows followsby by Theorem Theorem2.19. 2.19. seen seen now 6.16.Suppose Suppose that thatA(t) A(t) 66 S(ip,a) S(ip,a) and andthat that the the RK RK method method is is T hheeoorreemm 6.16. both of of type type Vju(ip) Vju(ip) and andof oftype type Vjjj((p) Vjjj((p) and andsatisfies satisfies the thecondition condition deg[a(-) deg[a(-) both — a(oo)] = —1, —1,for for some some ip ip G G(0,TT/2) (0,TT/2) and andaa 66M. M.Let Let further A(t; A(t; , , ) )be be a(oo)] = further aa testing functional functionalfor for A(t), A(t), let letseminorms seminorms || |© |©;t and and \\ | m; | t, t, m m == 0,1, 0,1,*0, *0, testing m; form respectively respectively(/y®\(p, y®\(p,a)-, a)-, (l/2\ip, (l/2\ip, a)-, a)-, (yi\(p,cr)-, (yi\(p,cr)-,and andstrictly strictly (*;l/2\ip,a)(*;l/2\ip,a)form concordant pairs pairswith with A(t), and andlet letthe the operatorA(t) A(t) itself itself satisfy satisfy the thehyhyconcordant A(t), operator potheses h61®fc) ; |©;t] and ho\^\-d,^;A(t; , ; \m-t,m = 0,1, *0), for potheses h61® [tf I |©;t] and ho\^\-d,^;A(t; , ; I \m-t,m = 0,1, *0), for fc) e some some ^^,,ii99e G G (0,1], (0,1], i?i i?i €€ [0,1], [0,1], 7 7 e €€ [0,1), [0,1), and and71 71ee [0,1/2). [0,1/2). Also, Also,supsuppose that that the the conditions conditions (6.62) (6.62)and and (6.63) (6.63) hold holdwith with7 7 == 7* 7*==1/2 1/2and and with pose with G [0,1) [0,1)such such that that"d, "d,+ .. < < -d. -d. Apart Apart from from everything everythingelse, else, some i?,,!?*, i?,,!?*,G some let u{z) u{z) be beaa(tp)-regular (tp)-regularrational rational function.Then, Then, 2Jn = = uj(—kA(t uj(—kA(t let function. with with 2J n)), any fixed fixed /xo /xo >> 00sufficiently sufficiently large largeand andfor for any anyfixed fixed £* £* G G[0,£o), [0,£o), where where for any for = 11++min{'i9 min{'i9- 1/2, 1/2,i?i i?i- -71}, 71}, if if deg[u] deg[u]< < -£*, -£*, we wehave, have, for for all allkkGG (0,K] (0,K] ^0 = and Gflk flk such such that thatti ti < < ttn, and tn,ti G
6.3. STABILITY ESTIMATES
143
6.3. STABILITY ESTIMATES
In the case £* = £o, the last estimate is still in force with t~_t replaced £
143
-| Icy
t -| Icy In the£ ; case by £~_* + t n _j log(i n _j+i/fc). Furthermore, if in addition i9i > 0 replaced and the (5.19) satisfies condition (6.4.8), then we have, for any fixed operator ; 9Kn in n £* log(i = £o,_j+i/fc). by + t _j Ho > 0 sufficiently large and for any fixed £ € [0, l/2 + min{#,i9i}) such that 9K in (5.19) satisfies (6.4.8), then we have, for any fixed operator the last condition estimate is still in force with t~_ £~_* Furthermore, if in addition deg[cj] Ho > < —£, /or aZZ k £ (0,K] and tn,ti 6 fife suc/i i/iai tj < tn, that i9i > 0 tn,ti 6 fife suc/i i/iai tj < n, that deg[cj]0 < —£, /or aZZ and the t k £ and (0,K] sufficiently large for and any fixed and £ € [0, l/2 + min{#,i9i}) n-l and such that n-l max
max where Yn is the solution of (5.19), (5.20). In the case £ = both estimates if one (5.20). adds tq'12 g+i/fc) to tq for q = n + 1 where Y n is the remain solutionvalid of (5.19), In log(£ the case 12 and q = n — I, where both estimates remain valid if one adds tq' log(£g+i/fc) £ = and to tq for q f 1/2 t/ tf
D and The interested .reader can state without difficulty an analogue of Theorem 6.16 in the situation when hypothesis hol'~^(...) replacedofbyThehy(XI - k&itn))The interested reader can state without difficulty an isanalogue pothesis hor*~)(...). orem 6.16 in the situation when hypothesis hol'~^(...) is replaced by hypothesis Remark hor*~)(...). 6.6. In our considerations carried out within an abstract framework, we are forced to accept from time to time some differently stated hyRemark potheses as independent ones,from although they not differently really suchstated in actual work, we are forced to accept time to timearesome hy6.6. practical applications. example, if A(t)they is thought as ansuch approximation potheses as independentForones, although are not ofreally in actual In our elliptic considerations carried out operator, within antheabstract frameto a multidimensional partialif differential above inequalpractical applications. For example, A(t) is thought of as an approximation ities (6.62) and (6.63) elliptic are akin, in fact, to assuming hypothesis h oinequall^(...). to a multidimensional partial differential operator, the above ities (6.62)6.7. andApplying (6.63) are akin, in fact, to assuming hypothesis of Theorems Remark Lemma 1.11 shows that the assertions 6.12 — 6 . 1 6 remain valid if instead of the seminorms ||(2l(t n ) h+o l ^ ( . ^ Remark 6.7. and ||(21*(i n ) + Horf* .\\mWe use ||(2l n + M o /)C . || and n ..). 6.12 ) +Theorems Applying Lemma 1.11 shows that the assertions of n and — ) + Horf* .\\mWe use ||(2l n + M o /)C . || and ||(21*(i 6 . 1 6 remain valid if instead of the seminorms
^ ||(2l(t
144
CHAPTER 6.6. ANALYSIS ANALYSIS OF OF STABILITY STABILITY CHAPTER
respectively, under under slightly slightly stronger strongerrestrictions restrictions on on££and and£*, £*,except exceptTheorem Theorem respectively, needs no no additional additional assumptions. assumptions. More Moreprecisely, precisely,one onethen thenhas hastoto 6.15 which needs addition that that £* £* << £o> £o>££<< £i£i inin the thestatements statements ofofTheorems Theorems6.13 6.13 require in addition that ££ << £o> £o> £* £* << £i £i in in the the statement statement ofof Theorem Theorem6.14, 6.14,and andthat that and 6.16, that min{$, 11 — 71} in the statement statement of of Theorem Theorem 6.12. 6.12. Also, Also, asasconcerns concerns £* < min{$, statement of of Theorem Theorem 6.12 6.12 in in the the particular particular case casewhere whereA(t) A(t) satisfies satisfies the statement hol[i?], itit should should in in addition addition be berequired requiredthat that££<<11++ hypothesis hol[i?], 6.8. The The results results of of Section Section 6.1 6.1 allow allowusus totoobtain obtainstability stabilityestiestiR e m a r k 6.8. ||, involving some some different different seminorms seminorms ininplace placeofof||(2l(£ ||(2l(£ mates involving ||, n) + jtxol)^
||2Jn(2l(*n)+Mo/)Hl, ||(2l*(i,)+Mo/)Hl*, and||3J?(a*(t,)+/xo/)HU. and||3J?(a*(t,)+/xo/)HU.More More ||2Jn(2l(*n)+Mo/)Hl, ||(2l*(i,)+Mo/)Hl*, 21 as concerns, concerns, for for instance, instance, the thefirst firsttwo twomentioned mentionedseminorms,' seminorms,' precisely, as ' let (£|?,a)-concordant a)-concordant pair pair with withA(t). A(t). Define Definethe thesemisemia seminorm ][-}{t form a (£|?, norm l-}ln=M-kA(t (6.77) l-}ln=M-kA(tn))itn, (6.77)
is aa {(p)-regular {(p)-regularrational rational function function that that isis under under the the condition condition where ip(z) is replaced by by the the condition condition deg[ip] < — £ if £ £ N degf^] < — [£J — 1, which is replaced a)-concordant pair pair with with A(t). A(t). Then, Then, seminorm $$forms forms aa(£\£\
substituted „ substituted
for || ( » ( * „ ) + M o / ) €
for | | 5 3 n ( 2 l ( t n ) + Mo-O ? || or for
II,
assertions of of Theorems Theorems 6.10, 6.10, 6.11, 6.11, 6.12, 6.12, 6.13, 6.13, 6.14, 6.14, and and6.16 6.16remain remain the assertions in addition, addition, ifif the the RK RK method method isis ofof class classSu Su ororofofclass class valid, assuming in deg[^] << —((w —((w ++ 1), 1), where whereww == — deg[a(-) — a(oo)] and the the Sin, that deg[^] last nonstrict nonstrict inequality inequality isis replaced replacedby by the the corresponding correspondingstrict strict one oneif if£ £isis an integer. Moreover, Moreover, ifif (6.21) (6.21) holds, holds, then thenfor for ££== 00ititisisenough enoughtotoaccept accept that deg^] << 00 instead instead of of all all the the above aboverestrictions restrictions on ondegfV']. degfV']. With Withthe the same substitution, substitution, the the assertion assertion ofof Theorem Theorem 6.15 6.15 remains remains valid validprovided provided that deg[^] << 00 ifif ££ == 00 and and deg[-i/>] deg[-i/>]<< 11— 2£ otherwise. otherwise. assertion is, is, in in fact, fact, aa consequence consequenceofofTheorems Theorems6.1, 6.1,6.3, 6.3,and and The above assertion 6.5.
in virtue virtue of of the the above above analysis analysis ofof concrete concrete families families ofofRK RK Note that in (see Section Section 5.2), 5.2), Theorems Theorems6.10, 6.10,6.12, 6.12,6.13, 6.13,and and6.14 6.14are areapplicable applicable methods (see Radau IA, IA, IIA IIA and and Lobatto Lobatto IIIC IIIC methods methods asas well wellasasfor forallallRK RK for all Radau whose Butcher Butcher array array isisspecified specified by by(5.26), (5.26),provided providedthat thatcondition condition methods whose holds. At At the the same same time time all all Gauss-Legendre Gauss-Legendre methods methodsofofodd oddorder order (5.27) holds. can serve as as examples examples of of application application ofofTheorems Theorems6.11, 6.11,6.15, 6.15,and and6.16. 6.16.Also, Also, Gauss-Legendre methods of of even even order order and and Lobatto LobattoIIIA, IIIA,IIIB IIIBmethods methodsofof Gauss-Legendre methods odd order lead lead to to rational rational approximations approximations which whichare areappropriate appropriatefor fordealing dealing with the assertion assertion of of Theorem Theorem 6.10 6.10 and and rational rational schemes schemesononthe thebasis basisofof 21
seminormscan can be be replaced replacedininaasimilar similarmanner. manner. The other two seminorms
6.4. COMMENTS AND AND BIBLIOGRAPHICAL BIBLIOGRAPHICAL
REMARKS REMARKS
145 145
Lobatto IIIA, IIIB methods methods of of even even order order can can be be used used in in the the format format ofof Theorem 6.11.
6.4
Comments and bibliographical bibliographical remarks remarks
Section 6.1: As concerns concerns Theorems Theorems 6.1, 6.1, 6.3, 6.3, and and 6.5, 6.5, what what the the reader reader meets meets here is their maiden presentation, presentation, while while their their particular particular versions, versions, that that is, is, Theorems 6.2, 6.4, and 6.6 6.6 are are actually actually present present in in our our old old work work [16, [16, 18, 18,22]. 22]. The proof of Theorem 6.1 6.1 combines combines some some ideas ideas from from [37] [37] with with those those ememployed in [18] (see also [35]). [35]). Section 6.2: Apparently, Apparently, Theorems Theorems 6.7 6.7 and and 6.8 6.8 are are new. new. At At the the same same time time our earlier work [16, 19, 19, 25, 25, 26] 26] contains contains assertions assertions that that are are quite quite close close toto Theorem 6.9. This group group of of results results is, is, however, however, essentially essentially based based on on applyapplying the hypotheses like hoi® hoi® [i9; | \t], which is of limited use in practice. practice. (See (See also the comment to Section Section 6.3.) 6.3.) Section 6.3: In the situation situation when when A(t) A(t) == AA isis independent independent ofof tt22 under the assumption of >l(c^)-stability >l(c^)-stability and and under under the the condition condition |r(oo)| |r(oo)| << 1,1, aa stability estimate which which is is equivalent equivalent to to (6.49) (6.49) with with ££ — — 0,0, isis first first stated, stated, apapwe also also mention mention parently, in Brenner &: Thomee Thomee [52].23 (For later references, we Larsson, Thomee, and Wahlbin Wahlbin [100] [100] and and Lubich Lubich & & Nevanlinna Nevanlinna [104].) [104].) ItIt is worth noting, for fairness' fairness' sake, sake, that that the the same same achievement achievement (with (with ££== 0)0) is presented in a Hilbert Hilbert space space framework framework by by Le Le Roux Roux [102] [102] whose whose techtechniques are, nevertheless, nevertheless, extended extended to to the the Banach Banach case. case. ItIt turns turns out out that that the restriction |r(oo)| << 11 is is not not crucial, crucial, and and itit isis avoided avoided inin our our work work [10, 11, 12, 16, 18, 22], where where the the corresponding corresponding non-strict non-strict inequality inequality isis alallowed as well. Later, a similar similar result, result, for for ££ == 00 only, only, isis shown shown inin Crouzeix Crouzeix etet straightforward techniques. techniques. The The al. [61] and Palencia [127], by using more straightforward general case £ > 0 has been been examined examined by by the the author author in in [10, [10, 11, 11,12, 12, 16, 16,18, 18,22], 22], and Theorems 6.10 and and 6.11 6.11 arise arise from from there. there. Also, Also, we we mention mention two two recent recent papers of Hansbo [82, 83] 83] who who in in particular particular presents presents certain certain strong strong stabilstability type estimates. As As concerns concerns her her results results for for single single step step methods, methods, itit isis easy, however, to deduce deduce them them directly directly from from [16, [16, 18, 18, 22]. 22]. In In the the matter matter ofof the assertions collected collected in in the the present present chapter, chapter, itit isis seen seen that that ifif ££ >> 0,0, we we have to distinguish between between the the classes classes Si, Si, 5// 5 / / on on the the one one hand hand and and Sm Sm since for for the the last last class class of of methods methods additional additional damping damping on the other hand since same time, time, when when using using general general seminorms seminorms ofof the the form form is required. At the same 22
One actually handles then then the the rational rational method method (5.30). (5.30). [52] deals deals with with rational rational approximations approximations ofof general general (not (not necesnecesIn principle, the paper [52] sarily holomorphic) Co semigroups. semigroups. 23
146
CHAPTER 6. ANALYSIS OF STABILITY
(6.77), the role of a damping factor played by the operator ip(—kA(tn)) is distinguishable in a different manner for these classes (see Remark 6.8). Turning now to the history of the question in the situation with a variable operator, we mention, first of all, certain early results in Gudovich & Terteryan [78], Sobolevskii [149, 152], and Thomee & Wahlbin [163], which deal with concrete problems or concrete narrow families of discretization methods. For results of general character, we refer to our work [16, 19, 25, 26] and to Gonzalez & Palencia [73, 74]. We remark that the papers [73, 74] which have appeared later contain no improvements in the properly Holder case in comparison with our results.24 The assertions of the present Theorems 6.12 and 6.15 follow in essence our investigation in [16, 19, 25, 26] while Theorems 6.13, 6.14, and 6.16 are presented for the first time here. We remark that the assertions of Theorems 6.12 and 6.15 are of limited use in practice and the same can be said regarding all results of Gonzalez & Palencia [73, 74]. The point is that those results are based on putting to use Holder-continuity type hypotheses which cannot be verified for partial differential operators and their discrete approximations in some useful function spaces, for instance, in those with maximum norm, unless we are dealing with the one-dimensional case. At the same time the assertions of Theorems 6.13, 6.14, and 6.16 are free of that disadvantage.
24
In fact, the situation considered in [73, 74] is even restricted to the case where £ = 0 and the condition |r(oo)| < 1 is assumed.
Chapter 7
Convergence Estimates Estimates Since stability estimates estimates have have been been shown, shown, the question of convergence is easily settled if the input data of the starting differential problem problem (5.1) are sufficiently smooth. In applications connected with with PDE PDE problems, problems, we meet, however, the phenomenon of order reduction when the order of convergence certain compatibility compatibility conobserved is smaller than the classical one, unless certain ditions are imposed on the input data. Apparently, Apparently, Crouzeix Crouzeix [59] is the first to examine this phenomenon phenomenon in detail in the context of Hilbert spaces. possibilities, depending depending on the smoothness of the Below we study different possibilities, input data, for showing error estimates estimates by using Banach space techniques. techniques. data not In what follows we are particularly interested in dealing with input data being smooth enough, that that is, when the classical order of consistancy is not achieved. In this chapter, given numbers numbers 0 < T\ < TI and K G [1,OO], we denote by L K(ri,T2;3£) the Banach space of strongly measurable functions functions ip(s) : \T\ > T2] —> £ with the norm
esssup s e [ r i ) T 2 ] ||^(s)||
if
K = OO.
7.1 Preliminaries It is known (see Appendix B) that under certain conditions conditions there there exists exists a unique solution of problem (5.1), 1 where the operator A(i) depends on t. Sometimes it is also possible to point out conditions under which the solution :
B y solution we always mean classical solution solution (cf. Appendix B).
147
148
CHAPTER CHAPTER 7. 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
has the desired order order of of regularity regularity (see, (see, e.g., e.g., Sobolevskii Sobolevskii [148]). [148]). However However for for the reasons explained explained in in Appendix Appendix B, B, we we never never use use such such conditions conditions below. below. Instead we posit the the unique unique solvability solvability of of the the starting starting problem problem (5.1) (5.1) asaswell well as the fact that the solution solution is is as as smooth smooth as as needed needed in in order order to to achieve achieve the the desired order of convergence. convergence. At At the the same same time time we we keep keep the the conditions conditions that that ensure the unique solvability solvability and and stability stability of of the the discrete discrete problem problem (5.19), (5.19), (5.20) so that our main main assumptions assumptions will will be be that that A{t) A{t) isis (ip, cr)-sectorial 2 for some
are associated with with the the quadrature quadrature formulas formulas
/ "
3=1
Jo
and / Jo
ip(s)ds^k}^a jiip(cik),
j = l,...,u,
(7.2)
1=1
where ip(s) may be thought thought of of as as an an (3£)-valued (3£)-valued function. function.3 It is well known (see, e.g., [53, 65]) that stating stating the the simplifying simplifying assumptions assumptions S(j>) S(j>) and and C(g) C(g) leads to the fact that that the the quadrature quadrature formulas formulas (7.1) (7.1) and and (7.2) (7.2) are areprecise precisefor for all polynomials of degree degree pp — 1 and q — 1, respectively. For subsequent subsequent use use we denote
and
(L
rtn+Cjk rt n+cjf
2
n
+ C,k)
,
j = l,...,K
Domj4(t) = Dam is independent of t, which is accepted throughout throughout We recall that Domj4(t) Part II. 3 It is just the case in what follows.
7.1. PRELIMINARIES
149 149
Lemma 7.1. Given p, qq > > 1, 1, for for any any ip(t) ip(t) :: [0,T] [0,T] —> X sufficiently smooth, the simplifying assumption assumption ®(p) ®(p) implies implies
(7.3) (7.3)
[ Jtn
while C(q) implies
\\Qnj(n\
[^ \\^{s)\\ds,
j = l,...,u.
(7.4)
Jtn
Proof. Clearly, it suffices to show show (7.3) (7.3) only. only. By By Taylor Taylor expansion expansion we we have have ds.
(7.5)
1=0
With this formula in mind, mind, (7.3) (7.3) easily easily follows follows noting noting that that the the value valueofofQQn(V)) remains unchanged when when substituting substituting ip(t) ip(t) — —X)?=o X)?=o ~i\ ~i\ V'^fa) V'^fa) f° f° r since the quadrature formula formula (7.1) (7.1) isis precise precise for for all all polynomials polynomials ofof degree degree p-1. Further, we denote
, r \i=x
Lemma 7.2. Lei, groen groen q>\, q>\, the the simplifying simplifying assumption assumption G(q) G(q) hold. Then, for any tp(t) : [0, T] —>>XX sufficiently sufficiently smooth, smooth,4 ds,
where 7j(s) is a bounded bounded Peano Peano kernel. kernel. Proof. In fact, the claim follows follows in in the the same same manner manner as as in in the the proof proof ofof the preceding lemma, using using (7.5) (7.5) with with qq ++ 11 in in place place of of p,p, noting noting that that the the quadrature formula (7.2) (7.2) is is precise precise for for all all polynomials polynomials of of degree degree qq— —1,1, and and
observing that Q nj(ipq) = k"+1Hqj^\tn), 4
Cf., e.g., Lubich & Ostermann Ostermann [105] [105]
where %{t) =
^-^q)(tn).
150
CHAPTER CHAPTER 7. 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE
ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
Lemma 7.3. Let the RK method method in in question question be be of of order order pp and and of of stage stage order q < p — 2. Then the order condition holds holds
This result can be established in in the the standard standard manner manner by by using using Taylor Taylor expansion (cf. Ostermann &; Roche Roche [123]). [123]). Now we derive suitable representations representations of of the the error, error, assuming assuming that that ££RR== I.5 When making this assumption, assumption, we we are are distinguishing distinguishing between between the the auautonomous and non-autonomous cases, cases, and and by by doing doing so, so, we we show show that that this this distinction is caused by the accepted accepted compromise compromise between between our our intentions intentions and and real possibilities. In the first (autonomous) (autonomous) case case we we show show error error estimates estimates in in terms of the data, which are realistic; realistic; however however similar similar estimates estimates in in terms terms of the solution are also possible. In In the the general general (non-autonomous) (non-autonomous) case case we we estimate the error only in terms of of the the solution, solution, and and we we cannot cannot satisfactosatisfactorily presently demonstrate anything anything different. different. In In both both cases, cases, autonomous autonomous and non-autonomous, we now assume assume that that problem problem (5.1) (5.1) possesses possesses aa unique unique solution y(t). Let A(t) = A be independent oft. oft. 6 Suppose that A € S(
Yn+1 = r(-kA)Y n + kJ2^j(-kA)
f(t nj) for tn G Clk, Yo = y°.
3=1
Also, for the solution y(t) of (5.1) at nodal nodal points points we we use use the the representation representation
y(tn+i) = r(-kA)y(tn)
+ k^Wj{-kA)
f(tnj) - >„ for t n G &k,
3=1
where (f)n is the truncation error. Therefore, Therefore, for for the the global global error error EEn =
Yn-y(tn),
we have En+i = r(-kA)En + >„,
which further gives, since EQ = 0, 0, n-l
£„ = J^r(-fcA) n - J '-V; for£ n efV 5
(7.6)
In this chapter more general expressions expressions for K will be used only in the very particular case where A(t) = A and /(£) = 0. 6 In this case the unique solvability of (5.1) will, in fact, follow from our subsequent suppositions.
7.1. PRELIMINARIES 7.1. PRELIMINARIES
151
151
Turning next tothe the generalcase case where A(t)depends dependson ont,t,we we assume Turning next to general where A(t) assume that the theconditions conditions ofTheorem Theorem5.1 5.1are aresatisfied satisfiedso sothat thatthe thediscrete discreteproblem problem that of (5.19), (5.20)is isuniquely uniquelysolvable. solvable. Fory(t) y(t) the solutionof of(5.1), (5.1),we wehave, have, (5.19), (5.20) For the solution usingthe theabove abovefunctionals functionals Qnn(-) (-)and and Qnj('), that that using Q Qnj('),
YY ^^
j
)
f(tnjnj)) )) -- QQn(yt) (yt) - -f(t
and and
Subtracting these equalities from the respective Runge-Kutta equations in respective Runge-Kutta equations in Subtracting these equalities from the (5.19)and and(5.20), (5.20),we weget, get, withE Enn just just the thesame sameas asabove aboveand andwith withE Ennj = = (5.19) with
En+1 =E Enn-kJ2 -kJ2 E n+1 =
bjA(t )Enj +Q Qnn(y (yt) bjA(t nj)E nj + nj
(7.7) (7.7)
and and V V
Enj =E Enn-k^ -k^aj iA{tnni)E i)Enl E nj = ajiA{t nl
Qnj (yt), ++ Q nj(yt),
l,...,v. j j==l,...,v.
(7.8) (7.8)
Therefore, solving (7.8) for = (E (Enn\,... \,... ,E ,E and assumingthat that the Therefore, solving (7.8) for E nnE= and assuming the nv) nv ) expressions(i (i++A;a'P A;a'P )^11Q Qnn(yt) (yt) and andT> T>n (i (i ++A:oX A:oX )~11Q Qnn(j/t) (j/t) are aredefined, defined, expressions ri)^ nn)~ ri Qnn (-) (-)= = (Qni(-), (Qni(-), Qnu{-)) Qnu{-)),,similarly similarlyto to(5.54) (5.54)we wefind find whereQ where Enn = = (i(i++kaV kaVnn)~ )~lee ®E ®E +(x (x+ +kaV kaVnn)~* )~* QQ (yt), ), E n + n(y n n whichfurther further gives, inserted into (7.7), which gives, inserted into (7.7), T T (I-kb Vnn{i+kaV {i+kaV )-11e)E e)Enn-kb -kbTTV Vnn(i+kaT> (i+kaT> )-lQ Qnn(y (yt)+Qn(yt) )+Qn(yt) (I-kb V n)n)n n
E = En+X n+X =
kbTTV Vnn(i (i + +kaVn^Qniyt) kaVn^Qniyt) + +Q Qnn{y {yt). ). n -- kb n Using this recurrence formula, since —0, 0,EQ followsthat that fortnnt £ £Q^, Q^, Using this recurrence formula, since EQ — ititfollows for n--ll n
Enn = =J2^n-i,j+i( J2^n-i,j+i( Vj{S kh ++ kaV^Qjiyt)+ Qj(yt)). + Qj(yt)). E ~ kh~TTVj{S kaV^Qjiyt) (7.9) 3=0 3=0
we werecall recallthe thewell-known well-known factfact (cf., (cf.,e.g., e.g., Sinestrari Sinestrari[146]) [146]) In In conclusion, conclusion, that that if ifA(t) A(t)GG S(ip, S(ip,a) a) for forsome some
(7.9)
152
CHAPTER CHAPTER 7. 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
any fixed t £ [0,T], by using formula (B.2), a family of operators e s > 0, which possesses all the properties of holomorphic semigroups. semigroups.7 For further reference we now show a result of a preparatory character which which is involved with the operator e~sA^\ L e m m a 7.4. Let A(t) 6 S(tp, a) a) and and let let aa seminorm \ \t form a (£\
(7.10) (7.10)
#
(( ii .. ll JJ .. ))
and, in particular, for any fixed r\ € N U {0}, t )
&
_
^ ^
^ ^
If o~ > 0 in addition, then the above holds in the case T — K — oo as well. Proof. Let Ys be the contour coinciding with with d(Y d(Y1{pWD{\/s)). Furthermore, Furthermore, it is is sufficient to going over to the shifted operator A(t) — al if a < 0, it consider the case a > 0 only. Assuming therefore therefore the last restriction and using next formula (B.2) with Ts in place of H, we have, for all s > 0, e-sA(t) =
J_
Now (7.10) follows when when integrating integrating by parts and acting further as in the 8 proof of Theorem 2.1. With regard to the second stated estimate (7.11), (7.11), it is the particular case of (7.10) where £ = r\ and | |t = ||-A(<)^ ||.
7.2
Autonomous equations equations
In this section we examine convergence in the case with a constant operator. (Therefore we write A instead of A(t).) As above, we then work with the extended solution of (5.19), (5.20) specified by (5.30). We begin with the homogeneous case f(t) = 0, for which the extended discrete solution is specified by Yn+1 = r(-kA)Y n 7
iovt neClk,
Yo = 9V\
(7.12)
Except strong continuity continuity at 0 if Dom A(t) is not dense in X In fact, this technique can be thought of as a slight modification of a well-known semigroups (cf., e.g., Reed & Simon [133, the argument in the theory of holomorphic semigroups proof of Theorem X.52]). 8
7.2. AUTONOMOUS EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
153 153
and it is compared to the the extended extended solution solution of of the the original original Cauchy Cauchy problem problem (5.1) given by y(t) — e~ tAy° for t > 0, where the operator operator e~ e~tA, t > 0, is denned by formula (B.2). (B.2). First we show an auxiliary auxiliary assertion. assertion. L e m m a 7.5. Let A G G S(
rn(z) = (r(z)n - enz) ( ^ J
,
(7-13)
it holds, with K > 0 sufficiently sufficiently small, small, for for all allkk G G(0,K] (0,K] and andttn G Qk> \\rn(-kA)\\
Proof. Let r\(z) be the stability stability function function of of an an A-stable A-stable method method ofof order order > p, with the property ri(oo) ri(oo) == 0. 0. (For (For example, example, one one can can take take aa z/-stage z/-stage Radau IA method with v > > (p+ (p+ l)/2.) l)/2.) Then, Then, clearly, clearly, itit suffices suffices to to show showthe the desired estimate with r^ (—kA), (—kA), jj == 1,2, 1,2, in in place place of of rrn(—kA), where
Note that there exists a fixed fixed d\ d\ > > 11 such such that that with with some some qq>>1,1, ^1| — aan/-] (r^\\ j j ^ /—'! L^ j Z nQ j / \Z~\J — rlyOO) Q
T (v\\
fr>T oil v d. / 7 . "\ T n + T V^\U'\). r-r- ^-^^ ^-^^
Since |r(oo)| < 1, this estimate estimate further further implies implies that that |r(z) |r(z) n | < ec"l2l q and, thus, ^(z)] < Ce cn|z| ~ 9 , for all n > 0 and z $ IntD(d IntD(d x ). Also, in view of the fact that \r(—z)\ < 1 and |ri(—2)| < 1 for for zz G GS
— (r(y\
— r, r,
(S (S
as well as the estimates, for for some some dd >> 0, 0, \r(z) - n(z)\ < C\z\v+l
for all z G 2?(d),
154
CHAPTER CONVERGENCEESTIMATES ESTIMATES CHAPTER 7.7.CONVERGENCE H-z)\ H-z)\
Ce~c^ and and \n(-z)\ \n(-z)\ < Ce~ Ce~c^ < Ce~
for all all zz££EE¥ i n V{\), V{\), for
and taking taking the condition condition r(0) r(0) = = r'(0) r'(0)== ri(0) ri(0)==r'i(O) r'i(O) = 1 1 into account, account, it follows that follows that \r^\z)\ < < Cn Cn\z\ecnW for for all allzz €€V{d) V{d) \r^\z)\ and cn]zl |r£>(-z)| < Cn\z\eCn\z\e-cn]zl |r£>(-z)|
for all all**€€ for
EVlnV(l). nV(l). E
It is therefore therefore seen seenthat thatthe function function r\, (z) (z)satisfies satisfies the conditions conditions of Lemma Lemma C. which yields yieldsthat that Hr&^-fcA)!! Hr&^-fcA)!!< C. 5.6, which Similarly, can be beshown, shown, applying applyingLemma Lemma5.5, 5.5,that \\r\ (—kA)\\ (—kA)\\ < C, C, Similarly, it can and the proof proof is now nowcomplete. complete. convergence is as as follows. follows. The first first assertion assertionon convergence Theorem 7.1. 7.1. Let LetAA EES(
(7.14) (7.14)
case a > 00 one onecan cantake T = =K K — oo. In the case Proof. follows from from Theorems Theorems6.10 6.10 and and 6.11 6.11and andLemma Lemma 7.4 that with with Proof. It follows 0 sufficiently sufficiently small, small,for all all kk E E(0,K] (0,K]and andtnt E fife, fife, K >0 \H-kA)n\\ \\e~tnA\\ + \H-kA)
< C. C. <
(7.15) (7.15)
method is of of order order p, by by Taylor Taylor expansion, expansion, for any any Furthermore, since sincethe method Furthermore, fixed ipi E (0,(f) (0,(f) the the function function r{z) r{z) = = z~^~ z~^~1{r{z) {r{z) — ez), where where j comes comes from from fixed ipi statement of the the theorem, theorem, satisfies, satisfies,when whensubstituted substitutedfor w(z), w(z),the the conconthe statement ditions Lemma 5.4 and andthe thecondition condition f(oo) f(oo) = = 0. 0. ItIt therefore therefore follows follows that that ditions of Lemma uE EDom m^^+ 1 , for all u || (r(-kA) (r(-kA)
< ^ +1 ||F(-fcA)|| Ch>+1\\Aj+1u\\. - e-fcA) u|| < ||F(-fcA)|| | | |^^+ 1 u | | < Ch>
mind, since since Yn = r(—kA) r(—kA)ny°, using using (7.15) (7.15) and andthe the With this inequality inequalityin mind, With this identity identity Yn-y{tn)
= = (r(-kA) (-kA)n
- e-tnA) y° -tn-lAr(-kA) r(-kA)l-ly°,
(7.16) (7.16)
7.2. AUTONOMOUS AUTONOMOUS EQUATIONS EQUATIONS 7.2.
155155
a simple simple estimation estimationyields, yields, for all allttn G G fife, fife, for \\Yn - y(t y(tn)\\ which shows(7.14). (7.14). which shows for aa >>00isisobvious. obvious. The more precise precisewording wordingfor The more 7.1 can can be bewidely widely used usedsince sincethe the property property of of A ((^-stability ((^-stabilityis Theorem Theorem 7.1 established for very very many many discretization discretizationmethods. methods. For further further progress progresswe we established for For have to distinguish distinguish between betweenthe the above above introduced introducedclasses classesof methods. methods. have to First we we introduce introduce one one more more helpful helpful notion. notion. First Definition 7.1. We Wesay saythat that a rational rational function function LO(Z) LO(Z)approaches approaches a function function Definition 7.1. T](z) with order orderm ifif T](z) with m u(z) = = ri(z) ri(z)++OO(\z\ (\z\ as \z\ \z\-> ->0.0. u(z) ) as
Our next result resultconcerns concernsmethods methods of class class £/. £/. Our next of Theorem 7.2. Suppose Suppose that thatA G GS(ip, S(ip,a), a), the theRK RKmethod method is of of order order p and and Theorem 7.2. Ai[ip]-stable, and aa seminorm seminorm | --||t forms forms a (£\ip, (£\ip,a)-concordant a)-concordantpair pairwith withA, A, Ai[ip]-stable, and for some some p G G N, N, ip ipGG(0,TT/2), (0,TT/2), a G G R, R, and and££>>0.0. Suppose Suppose further, further, for for some non-negative non-negative integers integersj ,, ?, ?, and andmm subject subject to to jj < < pp and and££<<s s+ + some j ,j , that y° G G DomA? DomA? and and 9\ 9\ — —u(—kA), u(—kA), where whereu>(z) u>(z)is aa rational rational function function that y° (if)-regular, approaches approaches with order orderp, and andsatisfies satisfies the the condition condition which is (if)-regular, emz with which deg[o;] < — —q. Then, Then, if if TT < < oo, oo,for forYY specified by (7.12) and for y{t)the the deg[o;] specified by (7.12) and for y{t) n extended extended solution solution of of (5.1) (5.1) with with f(t) f(t) == 0, 0, we wehave, have, with with K > > 00 sufficiently sufficiently for all allkk GG(0, (0,K) K)and and G fifc fifc with with n > > 1, 1, that that small, small, for tn t G )[Y y(tn+m Ckn-^-j)\\A^y\ )[Yn- y(t )}[tn< Ckn-^\\A^y\ n+m)}[t
(7.17) (7.17)
= mm ++j j provided provided that, that, in in addition addition to to The result result remains remains valid valideven evenif ££ = The above, the above, the seminorm seminorm <
Yn-y(t -y(tn+m n+m)
n = r(-kA) r(-kA) u(-kA)y° = u(-kA)y°
=
(r(-kA)ni (r(-kA) +{r(-kA) +{r(-kA)n2
--
-*"iA ) -- e -*"i e-^A) -- e-^
+(co{-kA) - +(co{-kA) G\ ++ G2 G2++G3. G3. G\
tmA tmA
0 e'^+^y e'^+^y
r(-kA)n2Lu(-kA)y° Lu(-kA)y° r(-kA) ee tnA tnA
t
e'e' )e- y°
^
A
u (( °°
156
CHAPTER CHAPTER 7. 7. CONVERGENCE ESTIMATES
With rn(z) given by (7.13), G\ and Gi can also be represented by d = (-k)pAp~J'(/ +
kA)- pr(-kA)n2Lu(-kA)rm(-kA)Ajy°
and
G2 = (-k)pAp-j(I +
kA)- pe-tniAu(-kA)rn2(-kA)Ajy°.
It is obvious that the claim follows if we show that for all k G (0, K],tn G flk w i t h n > 1, and t G [0,T],
X
(7.18)
Observe that instead of estimating }[Gi][t as stated in (7.18) it suffices to
show that with G = (-k)pAp-i(I +
kA)- pr(-kA)nu(-kA)rn(-kA)A^y°,
for all k G [0,K], tn G Clk, and t G [0,T], $i)\\Aiy°\\.
(7.19) (7.19)
To that end, we note that since the method is A/(?)-stable, the function p{—z) has no zeros in S ^ for any fixed ?i G (0,
(7.20)
Now, recalling that 21 = Ap(-kA), applying Theorem Theorem 6.10 in the case /(£) = 0 and Remark 6.8, and using the fact that all the involved operators are pairwise permutable, we get, since £ < m + j , 9 with m and ni defined as above, for all t G [0, T] and t n G f2fc,
Ckpt-l1\\^p-ir{-kA)n2uo(-kA)rn(-kA)Ajy°\ pj) \\u0(-kA) 7n{-kA) Aiy% which further leads to (7.19) in view of (7.20) and Lemma 7.5. Finally, the needed estimate (7.18) for \G2\t and \G3\t follows by actually using the same argument, with the aid of Lemma 7.4 and of the estimate 9
Or £ = m + j and the extra conditions on |-][t are assumed as pointed out in the statement of the theorem.
7.2. AUTONOMOUS EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
\\p(-kAy-'\\ Z-P{W(Z) -
+ \\(kAy-3p(-kA)P-J\\ \\(kAy-3p(-kA)P-J\\ ++ \\Ul(-kA)\\
157 157 < C, 10 where UJX(Z) =
mz
e ).
It is also seen from the above above reasonings reasonings that that in in the the case case aa >> 00the the result result is still valid for T = oo, oo, with with no no restriction restriction on on kk from from above. above. For methods of class Su Su or or of of class class Sm Sm we we have have the the following following converconvergence result. Theorem 7.3. Let the the conditions conditions of of Theorem Theorem 7.2 7.2 be besatisfied satisfied with with the the difdifference that the RK method method is is now now Ajj(ip)Ajj(ip)- or or Ajjj(ip) Ajjj(ip) -stable -stable and and the the concondition £ < ? + j (or the the condition condition ££ << m m ++ jj with with the the corresponding corresponding extra extra requirements) is replaced replaced by by the the condition condition ££ << (<; + p)/{w + 1) — p + j , with w = — deg[a(-) — a(oo)], where the nonstrict nonstrict inequality inequality isis replaced replaced by by the the corresponding strict one one ifif ££ is is an an integer, integer, unless unless ££ == 00 and and (6.21) (6.21) holds. holds. Then, if T < oo ; for Yn and y(t) specified the same same as as in in the the conditions conditions of of Theorem 7.2, the error estimate estimate (7.17) (7.17) holds holds in in the the considered considered case case as as well, well, and the result is still valid valid for for TT == K K— —oo oo ifif aa >> 0. 0. The proof is similar to that that of of Theorem Theorem 7.2, 7.2, applying applying Theorems Theorems 6.10 6.10 and and 6.11 and Remark 6.8. Theorem 7.3 can be applied applied for for all all Gauss-Legendre Gauss-Legendre and and Lobatto Lobatto IIIA, IIIA, IIIB methods while Theorem Theorem 7.2 7.2 isis applicable applicable for for all all other other concrete concrete families families of methods discussed in in Section Section 5.2. 5.2. Further, we examine inhomogeneous inhomogeneous problems problems of of the the form form (5.1) (5.1) but but concontinuing in the case of a constant constant operator. operator. We We therefore therefore handle handle the the rational rational method (5.30) now. In In the the inhomogeneous inhomogeneous case case we we meet meet aa phenomenon phenomenon called order reduction. This This phenomenon phenomenon shows shows itself itself by by the the fact fact that that ifif the the discretization method is is of of high high order, order, we we have have to to impose impose certain certain compatibilcompatibility requirements on the solution solution or or on on the the data data 11 to achieve the optimal order order of accuracy otherwise aa lower lower order order only only isis observed. observed. Below Below we weconsider consider difdifferent situations, including including those those for for which which the the order order reduction reduction phenomenon phenomenon occurs. is of of type type Theorem 7.4. Suppose Suppose that that AA ££ S(tp, S(tp, cr) and the RK method is C(y>), of order p, and of strict strict order order q, q, for for some some ip ip GG (0,TT/2), a G M, and p, q G N subject to to pp > > q. q. Suppose Suppose further further that that 9K 9K== I,I, TT << oo, oo, problem (5.1) possesses possesses an an extended extended solution solution y(t) y(t) of of order order pp ++ I,I,12 and 10
Which follows by Lemma Lemma 5.4, 5.4, similarly similarly to to (7.20) (7.20) These restrictions are often often thought thought of of as as artificial. artificial. In In fact, fact, there there isisno nocommon common opinion opinion of what are artificial conditions. conditions. Many Many authors authors try try to to avoid avoid conditions conditions ofofthe theform form y"' y"' (t) (t)€€ Dom A* with j > 2 while while the the situation situation with with jj == 11 isis thought thought ofof as as quite quite acceptable. acceptable. 12 Which is simultaneously aa solution solution of of (5.1), (5.1), see see Appendix Appendix B. B. 11
158
CHAPTER CHAPTER 7. CONVERGENCE
ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
forl = q,...,p and t G [0,T], tuti/i some G L^O^-X) m — 0 , . . . ,p — q. Then, ifYn is the extended solution of (5.19), (5.20), we have, with y? p+D coming from formula formula (B.5) stated for p + 1 in place of p and with K > 0 sufficiently small, for all k € (0, K] and ttn G fijt, that 1^
\\Yn - y(tn)\\ < C^ n ||y° p + 1 ) || + Ckr\\(tn -
In the case a > 0, the above holds for T — oo as well and one can then take m— — 0. 0. K > 0 arbitrarily large but finite if m > 1 and K = oo ifif m Proof. Our argument will be based on using formula (7.6). An essential ingredient of this effort is finding a suitable estimate of the quantity ||^ n ||) appearing in (7.6). where
(7.22)
where n
j=l
'"
,)
f o r J = 0, . . . , p - l
1=3
and V
Rn
= ds
Now we introduce the functions
j=0
"Therefore, the classical order is observed in the case m = 0 only.
(7.23)
7.2. AUTONOMOUS
EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
159 159
and
It can easily be checked checked (cf., (cf., e.g., e.g., Brenner, Brenner, Crouzeix, Crouzeix, and and Thomee Thomee [50, [50, Lemma 2]) that hi(z) = 0 for Z = 0 , . . . , 9 - l (7.26) (7.26) and hi(z) = O(\z\p~l)
as z^O
iorl = q,...,p,
(7.27)
since the method is of order order pp and and of of strict strict order order q. q. With With the the aid aid ofof the the equality -Ay — y' + f, we we derive derive from from (7.22), (7.22), with with Wj Wj;n defined by (7.23),
=
kQQ(-kA)y'(t n)
P u - V -rri/W(t n) + feWi ;n -
kh Q(-kA)f(tn),
where we denote V
Qj(z)
= hj{z) + ] T cJjWj{z),
J =
0,...,p-l.
Applying repeatedly the the trick trick based based on on using using the the relationship relationship —Ay® —Ay® — — y('+i) _ j(i) for i = l ^ . ^ p j we finally obtain obtain aa new new representation representation for for 4>n — Rn as follows P
f>n-Rn
k 2Q{kA){A)'{t)Y
=
a
1=2
+kWx.n - kho(-kA)f(tn) W
= ^
^
+
1
\
(7.28)
Putting further for short short I'I' = = m&x.{0,p m&x.{0,p — —m m— —I}, I}, II == q,... q,... ,p,p and and denoting denoting hi(z) — z~ l hi(z) for I = q,... ,p, we we note note that that the the functions functions hi(z) hi(z) are are (<^)(<^)14 regular and subject to deg[/ij] deg[/ij] << 0, 0, in in view view of of (7.27). (7.27). Applying Applying therefore therefore Lemma 5.3, we find, for for all all kk G G (0, (0, K], K], that that = q,...,p. 14
We recall that tuj(z), jj == 1, 1,
, v, v, possess possess this this property. property.
(7.29) (7.29)
160
CHAPTER CHAPTER 7. 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
Using now (7.28) instead of (7.22) yields, with the aid of (7.26),
(7.30)
which further implies, by (7.29), Un\\ < CkP +1~m J2 H^'/(0(*™)ll + Cfc P+1||2/(P+1)(*n)ll + \\Rnl
(7.31) (7.31)
At the same time since ||IUJ(—kA)\\ < C, a trivial estimation based based on using (7.24) gives
< CkP+1
max
\\y{p+l\s)\\
| | / « ( a ) | | + Ch? f ^
0<S
ds.
(7.32)
J tn
Next, since problem (5.1) possesses an extended solution of order p + 1, applying formula (B.5) with p + 1 in place of p and noting that ||e~ ij4 || < C for 0 < t < T, it follows that
||y (p+1) (t n )|| < C\\y°{p+1)\\ + C t
||/ ( P + 1 ) ( S )|| ds
(7.33)
J0
and
< Ck\\ y°{p+1)\\ + C ftn+\tn+1
- s)
+Ck [\\f^ +1\s)\\ds. Jo Combining (7.31), (7.32), (7.32), (7.33), (7.33), and (7.34) thus yields
(7.34) (7.34)
l=q
Ckp / Jtn
(t 4-1 — s) II f(p+1^(s) I ds + Ckp+1 I
\\fij'+1Hs)\\ds
(7.35)
7.2. AUTONOMOUS EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
161 161
Finally, by a trivial calculation we we have have n-l
n-1 n-1
ftj
j=0J°
j=l j=l
J
^-
"-1 ft,-
inequality and and by by inserting inserting (7.35) (7.35) into into (7.6) (7.6) the the claim claim With the aid of this inequality is shown because ||r(—kAy\\ ||r(—kAy\\ <
M-kA) (Yn - y(t n ))k l=q+l
15
oo ifif aa > > 0. 0. It is admissible that T = oo
162
CHAPTER CHAPTER
7. 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE
ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
is replaced by ££n := log(t n + i/fc) if where, unless £ = 1, the the factor factor tt n ~ K — 1/(1 — £), while, in in the the extreme extreme case case KK == oo oo and and ££ == 11 ; the factors and tnT are replaced tn replaced by by t\t\ and and ££n, respectively.
Proof. We demonstrate our argument argument only only for for ££ << 11 since since the the below below proof proof barely changes in the case case ££ == 1. 1. Having therefore assumed assumed that that ££ << 1, 1, for for any any scalar scalar positive-valued positive-valued function ip(s), s > 0, with the aid of aa simple simple calculation calculation itit follows follows that that with tpn(s) — (£„ - s)ip(s), for all t n € ftfc, n-l
rti
n-\
n-j n-j
n-1
and further, applying Holder's Holder's inequality inequality for for integrals integrals and and sums, sums, consecuconsecutively, n l
~
^ 3=0
nn
/-*3+i
n
~-' Jt Jt
3
~
~1
^ j=0 j=0
/
n
~^
rh+i
1/K
\
\Jt
I
\\Jtl
I
(E .
(7.38)
Also, under the accepted conditions, conditions, by by Theorems Theorems 6.10 6.10 and and 6.11 6.11 we we have, have, for all t e [0, T], « € X, and and 00 << jj << nn -- 1, 1, that that
l .|
(7.39)
Finally, the claim follows by by using using formula formula (7.6) (7.6) in in combination combination with with (7.35), (7.35), (7.37), (7.38), and (7.39). It appears that sometimes sometimes the the same same order order of of convergence convergence isis achieved achieved under reduced regularity requirements requirements in in comparison comparison with with what what isis stated stated above. We will give only only one one particular particular assertion assertion which, which, however, however, enables enables us to show the main idea. idea.
7.2. EQUATIONS 7.2. AUTONOMOUS AUTONOMOUS EQUATIONS
163
163
Theorem T h e o r e m 7.6. 7.6. Suppose Supposethatthat the the conditions conditions of of Theorem Theorem 7.4 7.4are are satisfied satisfied for for m ==00and forfor some g GgNG N subject m and some ip ipGG (0,7r/2), (0,7r/2), crcrGGR,R,p, p, subject to toqq<
(7.40) (7.40)
where (z) isis given q. q. Then (7.21)(7.21) where hhqq (z) given by by (7.25) (7.25) for forI I—— Then the the error errorestimate estimate pp pp qq qq holds \\A ~ ~ f^ f^ \-)\\i \-)\\i oo ^Q ytn x) isis replaced in which which the the summand summandCk Ck tnn \\A replaced by by holds in oo ^Q ytn .tx) C can can substitute CPPppPP- «--«7 -^ 7) (^ ) ( 00 ) ||||. . Also, Also, ifq ifq ==p-l,p-l, one one substituteC WC W nn | ||//^^( (0 0) | )| | | Ck Ckpp tnn \\f^(-)\\ \\f^(-)\\ Loo(0ttn for the the summand summand for Loo(0ttn .x) x) . Proof. andand (7.30) Proof. Clearly, Clearly, by by(7.6) (7.6) (7.30) itit suffices suffices to to find find aa different differentestimate estimate for for the expression ~ :>~ >~ 11 4>j, 4>j, where the expression EEnn == Yl^Zo Yl^Zor(—kA) r(—kA)nn ~ where
fa fa Using Using now now (7.40) (7.40) and andthe the fact fact that that the the function function p(z)~ p(z)~l isis (?)-regular, (?)-regular, by by z l Lemma (z) == g!g! p{p{ )~ )~ hh qq {z), {z), Lemma 5.3 5.3we we have, have,with with hhqq (z)
||^(-fcA)||
(7.41)
(7.41)
observing that that kAp(-kA) observing kAp(-kA) ==
a(—kA) a(—kA) — —I I — —r(—kA), r(—kA), and and using using the the identity identity n --l l n
En
==
j
^ ^ r r{ {- -
ll
3=0 3=0
= ZZnn -- r(-kA) = r(-kA)nn ZZ00 ++Y,r{ Y,r{ 3=0 3=0
we find, we find,with with the theaid aidof of (7.15) (7.15) and and (7.41), (7.41), n-\ n-\
\\E \\En\\ << wZnW wZnW ++ cwzoW cwzoW ++ J^ J^ 3=0 3=0
< Ck Ckpp ((
(
77
I,
++ 11
3=03=06
W ee therefore r e s t r i c t i o n s oonn/ / W t h e r e f o rleave e leave tthhee restrictions
((t )t ,) , II ==qq++ l,...,p— l,...,p—
1,1,a sa s ssttaat et de dbefore. before.
164
CHAPTER CHAPTER 7. 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
Therefore the claim follows by combining this inequality inequality with with the estimate
Furthermore, note that that
ll/^OHwo*.*) < H/(P)(O)II + r \\&+1){s)\\ds. Jo
Using this result for an estimation in (7.31) and (7.32) and taking (7.36) into account, it is seen, with the aid of the argument used in the proof of Theorem 7.4, that the more precise wording for q = p — 1 is true as well. It is not hard to see that for methods of type C/ (
<-I
= deg[p],
l=
q,...,p.
In conclusion, we remark that all RK methods belonging to the concrete families discussed in Section 5.2 are of type C(
7.3
Non-autonomous equations equations
In the present section we show error estimates in terms of the solution for the case with a variable operator. We assume throughout that that T < oo, 17 problem (5.1) possesses a unique solution y(t) and that 91 = I in (5.19). In our consideration we concentrate on examining the situation where the solution of (5.1) is of low space regularity, and more precisely, it is assumed that at most y^(t) G Vom for t € [0,T] [0,T] and and for for some l>\. We start by showing the following result. Theorem 7.7. Suppose that A(t) G S(ip, a) and A(t) A(t) satisfies hypothesis lip, while the RK method is of type Vi(
Hereinafter y(t) has the same meaning.
7.3. NON-AUTONOMOUS EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
165 165
of the numerical solution by (5.19), (5.20), it holds, with K > 0 sufficiently small and pi\ > 0 sufficiently large, for all k £ (0, K) and t n G £}&,
|| L l ( o, i n ;£)-
(7-42)
Proof. Similarly to (5.43) we conclude that with ^i > 0 sufficiently large, the operator (D n - V{tn)) (i + fcaDn)" 1 (8) (A(t n) + Mi)"1 i s defined on X and18
||(D n - T)(tn)) (i + fca'Dn)"1 ® (A(tn) + MX)"1 || < Ck.
(7.43)
Using therefore the representation
) ) - 1 ^ - V(tn))(i + fcaDJ" 1 ® (A(t n) + MI)" 1 , (7.44) which is, in fact, an analogue of (5.44), it follows, with the aid of (5.35) and (7.43), that the operator D n (i + kaVn)~l ® (A(tn) + Mi)"1 is defined on X and (7.45) ||Dn(i + kaVn)- 1 ® (A(t n) + MI)" 1 II < C.
Also, it follows from (6.56) with £ = 0 that for £n,£j £ ^fc such that tj < tn,
(7.46) (7.46)
Now, by (7.9) and Lemma 7.2, we have En = E^] + E%] + E^\ where, w i t h H = (Hqi,...,
Hqu)
,
3=0
j=0
and
n-l
3=0 18
We recall that the operator A{t) is now Lipschitz-continuous.
166
CHAPTER CHAPTER 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCEESTIMATES ESTIMATES
It will be well defined. thethe be seen seen from from below belowthat thatthese theseexpressions expressionsareare well defined.By By triangle inequality with \\En\\En ||, ||, triangle inequality itit thus thussuffices sufficestotoshow showthat that(7.42) (7.42)holds holds with j = 1, 2, 2, 3, 3, in in place placeofof ||.E n||. First of of of \\En' of all all we we observe observethat thatthis thisfact facteasily easilyfollows followsin inrespect respect \\En' since we we have have by by (7.3) (7.3)and and(7.46), (7.46),
"'"lly^OOIIda. "'"lly^OOIIda.
o
Further, using thethe assumed hypothesis Further, using (7.46) (7.46)and and(7.45) (7.45)and andnoting notingthat thatbyby assumed hypothesis of Lipschitz-continuity, Lipschitz-continuity,similarly similarlytoto(6.47), (6.47), -1\\
foraUt,ae[0,T], foraUt,ae[0,T],
(7.47) (7.47)
we find, find, since since A(t) A(t) isisclosed, closed,that that n-l j=0
This result result shows shows (7.42) (7.42)with with||^||^ 2 ) || substituted substituted for for \\E \\En\\. '\\.'\\.ToTothat wewe findfind from It thus thus remains remains toto estimate estimatesuitably suitably\\En \\En thatend, end, from { ] { ] ] where (7.44) that that EE n - E n + E£ , where
j=0
and
3=0
It follows follows from from (7.46), (7.46),(5.35), (5.35),and and(7.43) (7.43)that that \\(A(tj) 3=0
7.3. NON-AUTONOMOUS EQUATIONS EQUATIONS 7.3. NON-AUTONOMOUS
167167
However, by the thefollowing following identity identitystated stated for (X)-valued (X)-valued functions, functions, However, by for ftj+i ftj+i K*7/J I "" ll K*7/J
II
I 7/j I 7/j | c| I c I
I " I- i "-i- i -i SI 1/1SI I 1/1 Q II I QnII o
no
we have instead, instead,using using(7.47) (7.47) and the thefact fact that that A(t) A(t) isisclosed, closed, we have and *+ 2
^^
rtrt +i
k J 22 j=0 JtJtJ j=0
l=q+l
This fact further furthergives givesthat that This fact +2 +2
\\(A(0 \\(A(0 +2) \\{A{s)+ ml) ml) y^ y^+2) (s)\\ ds, ds, fn \\{A{s) (s)\\
o
and (7.42) holds holdswith with\\En \\En ||||substituted substitutedfor for ||£? ||£?n||. It It thus thus remains remainsto to show show and (7.42) 4) (7.42) when whensubstituting substituting||£n ||£n for ||E ||En ||. (7.42) || for Using now nowthe theidentity identity Using (-kA{tj)) wT(-kA{t
=bbT - A;A(^)b A;A(^)bTa(i a(i ++ =
kaV(tj))-\ kaV(tj))-\
and takingLemma Lemma7.3 7.3 into into account, account,we we find find and taking n - ll { ]
+2 +2
T = k^ k^ J2^n-i,j+ikA(t J2^n-i,j+ikA(t a(i En = j)b a(i
+1 1 ka'D(t HA(tj)y^ )y^+1 ++ka'D(t \tj). j))- HA(t
(7.48) (7.48)
Since deg[p] Since deg[p] = = —1, —1, p(z)"" p(z)""1 is is ((^)-regular, ((^)-regular, and and the the entries entries of of the the matrix matrix 1 a(t — — 2a)"" 2a)"" vanish vanish as as \z\ \z\ — — >>00, 00,by byLemma Lemma 5.3 5.3 itit follows follows that that with withr](z) r](z) == \r](-kA(t))\\
forkke e(0,K] (0,K]and and [0,T]. 6 for t 6t [0,T].
Next, using usingthe theequalities equalities Next, (-kA(tj))H ))H wT(-kA(t
p(-fcA(t,-))»7(-fcA(tj)) == p(-fcA(t,-))»7(-fcA(tj))
and and kA(tj) fc9l(tj) = I= - I ilj- -ilj k
(7.49) (7.49)
168
CHAPTER 7. CONVERGENCE
instead of (7.48) we have, with Z3 = kq+2r]{-kA(t3))
ESTIMATES
A(t3) y{g+l)(t3),
that
n-l n
3=0
where n-l
n-l
3=0
and n-l j=0
Since A(t) is under hypothesis lip, it follows from (6.61) that \\?Bj\\ < C, which further implies
3=0
Therefore \\En || is finally estimated just the same as \\En || and it remains to prove that (7.42) is fulfilled with ||£ n 6) || in place of ||E n ||. Applying again hypothesis lip for A(t), it holds
\\(A(tj)-A(tj+1))y^1Htj)\\
Using now the last two estimates together with (7.47), (7.49), and the above argument and applying the identity
+V+2V(-kA(tj+1))
7.3. NON-AUTONOMOUS NON-AUTONOMOUS EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
169169
simple estimation estimation gives gives a simple <
\\(A(s)+fi1I)y^+2\s)\\ds. \s)\\ds. \\(A(s)+
(7.50) (7.50)
-i
Therefore, noting that that by by(7.47), (7.47), Therefore, noting
Hs)\\ds I*" \\A(tn)y^+2Hs)\\ds
Jo
||(A(S) + M l 7)^^( 7)^^(S )||d S , ||(A(
Jo with the the aid aid of of (7.46), (7.46),(7.49), (7.49),and and(7.50) (7.50)it itfollows followsfrom from above representhethe above representation for for EEn that that
Jo n-l
J=0
This completes completes the the proof proofsince sincethe thelast lastterm termononthetheright right estimated is is estimated justjust same as as ||ij4 ||ij4 ||-||the same D D natural to to expect expectthat thatthe theorder orderofofconvergence convergence reduces under weaker It is natural reduces under weaker requirements of of space spaceregularity. regularity.InInthe thefollowing followingstatement statement space regurequirements nono space regurestrictions are areimposed imposedononhigher higherderivatives derivatives exact solution. larity restrictions of of thethe exact solution. Theorem 7.8. 7.8. Let Let the theoperator operatorA(t) A(t) and andthe theRK RKmethod method satisfy condiTheorem satisfy thethe condiof Theorem Theorem 7.7 7.7for for some sometptp6 6(0,TT/2), (0,TT/2), a G N, N, andp,q andp,q €€ NN such suchthat that tions of Let also also the the coefficient coefficientmatrix matrixa abebenon-singular. non-singular.Then, Then, forfor thethe q < p — 1. Let En of the the numerical numerical solution solutionofof(5.1) (5.1)byby(5.19), (5.19),(5.20), (5.20),it it holds, with error E holds, with £lk, sufficiently small, small,for forall allk kGG(0,(0, and K > 00 sufficiently K]K]and tn t € £lk, \\En\\ <
(O(O +1
+CF||^ +CF||^ )(.)|| L l (o, t t i ; £)Proof. Since oo is Proof. is non-singular, non-singular, we wehave have
(7-51) (7-51)
170
CHAPTER7. 7.CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE ESTIMATES CHAPTER ESTIMATES
where Qj(-) Qj(-) == a^Q^-)a ^ Q ^ - ) -Also, Also,byby(5.43) (5.43) it follows where it follows thatthat \\CDj- V(tj)) V(tj)) (i(i++ kaVj^aW kaVj^aW <
n-l n-l
\\En\\ = | ||ffcc^^iilln _ 1 J ++ 11b r D ( i ,,))))((ii ++
1 fcaD(^))fcaD(^))aQJ(yi)ll
(7.52) (7.52)
This aim aim can canhowever howeverbebeachieved achieved using argument place of of ||jE ||jEn||. This in place byby using thethe argument employed in the theproof proofofofTheorem Theorem7.77.7 and applying equality employed in and by by applying the the equality aQ^yt) = aQ^yt) =
A^)) (-kA(tj))GT(-kA(t (-kA(tj))QJ(yt), A^)) P(-kA(t
— p(z)~ p(z)~1hT(x — za)~ za)~1a, since since where GT(z) — where G
Lemma 5.3. 5.3. by Lemma Next we we show show an analogue analogue of both both Theorem Theorem 7.7 7.7 and and Theorem Theorem 7.8 7.8 when when Next A(t) is is under under a different different Holder-continuity Holder-continuitytype typehypothesis. hypothesis. operator A(t) the operator Theorem 7.9. Let Let A(t) A(t) €€S(ip,cr) S(ip,cr) and and let let the the RK RK method method be both both of type type Theorem 7.9. Vj(ip) and of of type type Vf(
can then then assume assume that thatq < < pp — 1 instead instead of the the above above restriction restrictionq
7.3. NON-AUTONOMOUS NON-AUTONOMOUS
EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
171 171
Theorem 7.10. Let the the operator operator A(t) A(t) and and the the RK RK method method satisfy satisfy the the conconditions of Theorem 7.7 for for some some tp tp G G (0,TT/2), a G N, andp,q G N such such that that q < p — 1. Also, suppose that aa seminorm seminorm $$ forms forms aa (£|1|<£>, (£|1|<£>, a)-concordant a)-concordant pair with the operator A(t) A(t) for for some some ££ G G (0,1] (0,1] and and that that aa rational rational funcfunction to(z) is (ip)-regular (ip)-regular and and satisfies satisfies the the condition condition deg[o>] deg[o>] << —1. —1. Then, Then, ifif ^(.)y(«+i)(.) i?/ (p+i)(.) e LK{0,T;X) for some K G G [1/(1 [1/(1 -- £),oo], the error En of the numerical solution solution of of (5.1) (5.1) by by (5.19), (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) satisfies satisfies the the estimate, estimate, with some [i\ > 0 and with with K K > > 00 sufficiently sufficiently small, small, for for all all kk GG(0, (0,K] K] and and
M-kA(t n))En]
tn
<
where the right-hand side side of of this this inequality inequality isis taken taken log(2 log(2++ l/fc) l/fc) times times inin the the case K = 1/(1 — £).
Proof. First of all it follows from from Theorem Theorem 6.12 6.12 and and Remark Remark 6.8 6.8 that that for for all all tn, tj G Q.k such that tj < < ttn and u e X ,
Using therefore this estimate estimate together together with with (7.45), (7.45), (7.3), (7.3), and and (7.4), (7.4), aa direct direct estimation on the basis of of (7.9) (7.9) shows shows the the claim, claim, with with the the aid aid of ofthe the argument argument leading to (7.38).
One more direction for for possible possible extension extension isis performed performed in in the the next next asassertion. Theorem 7.11. Let the the operator operator A(t) A(t) and and the the RK RK method method be beunder under the the conconditions of Theorem 7.7 for for some some tp tp G G (0,TT/2), a G N, andp,q G N such such that that q < p — 1, and let the coefficient coefficient matrix matrix aa be be non-singular. non-singular. Let Let there there further further be given seminorms \ j . and and \\ |*.;t of which the former one is independent independent of of t and has domain C X while while the the latter latter one one forms forms aa (*;"f*\(p, a)-concordant pair with A(t) for some some 7* 7* G G [0,1) [0,1) so so that that we we have, have, with with some some /ii /ii >> 00 sufficiently large, for all all tt G G [0,T], x G %*> and u £ Dom | |. ; that
|(X, A(t) (A(t) + fnIT'u)] < C\((A(t) C\((A(t) + +
niI)- 1yx\..-M-
Then ify {p+1){-) G Li(0,T;X) and and \yiq+1)(-)\. G LK{0,T;R) for some K G [1/(1 — 7*), 00], the error E n of the numerical solution solution satisfies satisfies the the estimate, estimate, with K > 0 sufficiently small, small, for for all all kk G G (0, (0,K] K] and and ttn G fife,
(7.53)
172
CHAPTER7. 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE CHAPTER
ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
where the the first first term term on on the the right-hand right-hand side sideof this this inequality inequality is taken taken log(2 log(2+ where 1/fc) times times in the the case case K = = 1/(1 1/(1 — 7*). 7*). 1/fc) Proof. As in in the the proof proof of Theorem Theorem 7.8, 7.8, using using (5.44), (5.44), (7.3), (7.3),and and (7.4), (7.4), it Proof. As suffices to show show the the claim claim with with \\E \\En\\ defined defined by by (7.52) (7.52) in place place of ||J5 ||J5n ||. By By suffices (7.53) we have, have, with with the the aid aid of ofthe theabove above argument, argument, (7.53) we
Ck^J2 \\En\\ < Ck^J2
sup \((A( \((A(tj) sup
j=0 llxll*=l llxll*=l j=0
apply Theorem Theorem6.12 6.12 (more (more precisely, precisely,the the stability stability estimate estimate thus remains remainsto apply It thus (6.58)), Remark Remark 6.8, 6.8, and andthe thereasoning reasoning leading leadingto (7.38). (7.38). (6.58)), the last last two two theorems, theorems, note notethat thatsimilar similarassertions assertions are esesAs concerns concerns the are tablished under underthe the Holder-continuity Holder-continuitytype typehypotheses hypotheses that are assumed assumed in tablished that are the statement statement of Theorem Theorem 7.9. 7.9. Further we present present some someerror errorestimates estimatesthat that are intended intended for for use use when when Further we are RK method method is of of class class 5 / ////.. We Wedo dono nomore more than than to show show two two separate separate the RK results. results. Theorem 7.12. Suppose Suppose that that the the operator operator A(t) A(t) is is under under hypothesis hypothesis lip lip Theorem 7.12. and A(t) A(t) G GS((p, S((p,a)a) while while the the RK RK method method satisfies satisfies the the condition condition deg[a(-) deg[a(-)— and a(oo)] = —1 —1and andisis both both of type type Vm(ip) Vm(ip) and and of of type type Vj Vjn{(p) {(p) as as well well as of of a(oo)] order p and and of of stage stage order order q, for for some some
Proof. fact, the the result result can can be be shown shown in aa manner manner similar similarto that that used used in Proof. In fact, the proof proof of Theorem Theorem 7.8. 7.8. To To achieve achieve success successwe we also also use use the the estimates, estimates, for for < nn -- 1,1, 0 < jj < and and l
-^-^ <
of which which the the former former one one follows follows by by Theorem Theorem 6.15 6.15 while while the the latter latter one one can can be proved proved in the the same same way way as as (5.43). (5.43).
7.4. WORKING AGAINST AGAINST ORDER ORDER REDUCTION REDUCTION
173 173
Theorem 7.13. Suppose Suppose that that A(t) A(t) G GS((p, S((p, a) a) and and the the RK RK method method isis both bothofof type Vjjj(ip) and of type type Vf Vfn(ip) as well as of order order pp and and of of stage stage order order qq and satisfies the condition condition deg[a(-) deg[a(-) — a(oo)] = —1, for some some
|t] and \ip(A(t;
, ; | | mm ; t,m = 0,*0), wt/i .4(£;-,-) a testing testing
functional for A(t) and and with with some some 70 70 G G [0,1) [0,1) and and $\ $\ GG (0,1]. Let also the conditions (6.62) and and (6.63) (6.63) hold hold with with 77 == 7* 7* == 1/2 1/2 and and with with some some G [0,1) such that 1?. + i9*. << 1. 1. TTien TTien i/ie i/ie error error estimate estimate (7.42) (7.42) holds under the same regularity regularity requirements requirements on on y(t) y(t) as as in in the the conditions conditions ofof Theorem 7.7. If in addition addition the the coefficient coefficient matrix matrix aa isis non-singular, non-singular, then then 0 the estimate (7.51) holds holds as as welP welP under the regularity requirements requirements on on y(t) y(t) as in the conditions of Theorem Theorem 7.8. 7.8. The proof is similar to those those of of Theorems Theorems 7.7 7.7 and and 7.8, 7.8, noting noting that that the the stability estimate (7.46) (7.46) is is in in force force under under the the accepted accepted conditions, conditions, as as itit follows from Theorem 6.16. 6.16. It is worth noting that the the conditions conditions of of Theorems Theorems 7.7, 7.7, 7.8, 7.8, 7.9, 7.9, 7.10, 7.10, and and 7.11 are fulfilled for all Radau Radau IA, IA, IIA IIA and and Lobatto Lobatto IIIC IIIC methods methods as as well well as as for all RK methods which which satisfy satisfy (5.26), (5.26), (5.27). (5.27). Besides, Besides, Theorems Theorems 7.12 7.12 and and 7.13 are applicable, for instance, instance, for for all all Gauss-Legendre Gauss-Legendre of of odd odd order. order. The The magnitudes of orders and and stage stage orders orders for for these these methods methods are are pointed pointed out out inin Section 5.2.
7.4
Working against order order reduction reduction
Now the reader sees that that the the classical classical order order of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods isis not not in general achieved if the the operator operator in in question question isis unbounded unbounded and and the the data data are not sufficiently smooth. smooth. Therefore Therefore the the question question arises arises ifif there there really really are any means of avoiding avoiding the the phenomenon phenomenon of of order order reduction reduction or or atat least least of raising the order of convergence. convergence. In In the the present present section section we we discuss discuss some some possibilities along those those lines. lines. For For simplicity simplicity we we restrict restrict ourselves ourselves to to the the case case where A(t) G S(tp, a) with with aa > > 0, 0, which which yields yields that that the the operator operator A(t) A(t) has has aa bounded inverse with aa uniform uniform estimate estimate ^ ( i ) " 1 ! < C for t G [0,T]. We begin with a discussion discussion in in the the case case where where A(t) A(t) == AA isis independent independent of t. Let the RK method method be be of of order order pp and and of of strict strict order order qq << pp — —1.1. We We associate to problem (5.1) (5.1) the the following following auxiliary auxiliary problem, problem, with with jj — —pp — q — 1 B
We then assume that qq << pp — —1. 1.
174 174
CHAPTER 7. CONVERGENCE ESTIMATES CHAPTER 7. CONVERGENCE ESTIMATES
or with with jj = =p p— — q, q, {j j + Az Az = = (-l) (-l) Az' + A-jf{j \
0
1=1 1=1
The point pointis is that that the thesolutions solutionsof of (5.1) (5.1)and and(7.54) (7.54) are are connected connectedby by The
y{t) z(t)- f^i-lYA-'f^Ht). f^i-lYA-'f^Ht). y{t) = z(t)
(7.55) (7.55)
i=i i=i
Therefore, havingobtained obtained an approximation approximationfor for z(t) z(t) and andusing using next nextthe the Therefore, having an last relation,it itis easy easy to to get getan anapproximation approximationto to y(t). y(t). At Atthe the same time time last relation, same it is is essential essential that thatone one can canapproximately approximatelycalculate calculate z(t) by bya a suitable suitableRK RK z(t) method, achieving achievingthe theoptimal optimalorder orderof of accuracy accuracy (= (= p) p) under under reduced reducedspace space method, regularityrequirements requirements on the thetime time derivatives derivativesof of /(£). /(£).Acting Acting so, so, we wehave have on regularity the following. following. the Theorem 7.14. 7.14. Let LetT T= =oo, oo, j = =p p— —q or or j — —p p— —q — —1, 1, A A£ £ S(
Then, assuming assuming in inaddition, addition, if ifjj = =pp— —q — —1, 1, that that f^ f^q\t) GDom.A Dom.A for for Then, G t G G [0, [0,T], T], the the error error Y Yn — —y(t y(tn) of of the thenumerical numerical solution solutionof of the the original original (5.1) satisfies satisfies the the estimate, estimate, with withK K> >0 0sufficiently sufficiently small, small, Cauchy problem problem(5.1) Cauchy allk kG G (0, (0,K] K] and andtn G G Qk, Qk, for for all \\Y \\Yn-y(t -y(tn)\\
< <
^^ 1=1 1=1
l=q l=q
where y? y? ,,^ comes comesfrom fromformula formula(B.5) (B.5)stated stated for for pp++11ininplace place of of p. p. where
7.4. WORKING AGAINST AGAINSTORDER ORDER REDUCTION 7.4. WORKING REDUCTION
175 175
Proof. Since Since problem problem(5.1) (5.1)possesses possessesan an extended extendedsolution solutionof of order order p p+ + 1, 1,itit Proof. not hard hard to to see seethat that the the same same is is true true for for problem problem (7.54) (7.54)and and is not
( = 11
which results resultsfrom from(7.55) (7.55) by using using (B.4). (B.4).The Theclaim claim thus thusfollows followsby by direct direct which by applicationof of Theorem Theorem7.4 7.4 to toproblem problem (7.54). (7.54). application theexpression expressionon on the theright-hand right-handside sideof of the thelast last error errorestimate estimate Note thatthe Note that term of of the theform form Cfc Cfcp||^4y^ ||^4y^p~1)(.)||£ )(.)||£oo 3e) if j — — — while contains contains aa term (0 t 3e) if j — p — q — 1 while oo 1 n; of A A appear appear in in the thecase case j — —p — — q. q. no positive positivepowers powersof no Further we we turn turn to to the thecase case with with aa variable variable operator. operator. We We will will show show Further only that, that, modifying modifyingthe the RK RKmethod method in in aa suitable suitable way, way,itit isispossible possible to to only raise the the order order of of converegence converegenceat at least least by by 1, 1, without without imposing imposingstronger stronger raise restrictions of space space regularity regularityon on the theexact exact solution solutionbut but requiring requiring instead instead restrictions of more regularity regularityin in time. time. Note Notethat thatby by further further extensions extensions of these these techniques techniques more of to get gethigher higher orders ordersof of convergence convergenceunder underthe theoriginal original requirements requirements in order order to of space spaceregularity regularitywe we are areled ledtotothe the necessityof of imposing imposingcertain certain(difficult (difficult necessity for verification)extra extraconditions conditions on the theoperator operator A(t). A(t). Anyway Anyway we we leave leave for verification) on our present present consideration. consideration. such extensionsbeyond beyond our such extensions theRK RKmethod methodin in question questionbe be of oforder orderp and andof ofstage stage order orderq q<
0
= jj//''--^^oor rVVCCOO z(0) = ) .) . z(0)
(7.56) (7.56) (7.57)(7.57)
For our our aims aims it it is is important important that thaty(i) y(i) can canbe beexpressed expressed by by y(t) y(t) — —z(t) z(t)+ + For A(t)~ f(t). We Westate state here hereonly onlyone oneresult result illustrating illustratingthe themain main idea. idea. Further Further A(t)~l f(t). canbe bestudied studiedon onthe thebasis basis of of the theassertions assertionspresented presented in Section Section possibilities in possibilities can 7.3. 7.3. Theorem 7.15. Let LetTT<
We recall recallthat thatA(t) A(t) 11 is is uniformly uniformlybounded, bounded, by our ourassumptions. assumptions. We by A(t) A(t) isisindependent independentof of t.t. particularthese theseassumptions assumptions mean In particular mean that that Dom Dom
22 22
176
CHAPTER 7. CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCE CHAPTER
ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
auxiliary problem problem (7.56) (7.56) and let let YYn = Zn + A'1 (tn) f (tn). Then it holds, the auxiliary sufficiently small, small, for all kk G G(0, (0,K] K] and andttn G Cl^, Cl^, with K > 0 sufficiently q+2
\\Yn-y(tn)\\
2
<
++
P+1
l=q+3
Proof. By Theorem Theorem 7.7, we we have23 \\Yn-v(t \\Yn-v(tn)\\ = \\Zn-z(tn)\\ < ;^)+C^||^+1 )(-)|| il (o,t n ;3e)+ W +2 ||A(.)^ +2 )(-)||L 1 (o,t n ;^)+C^||^
(7-58) (7-58)
with the the aid aid of of the the equalities equalities Now, with y(t) -- A(t)-lf(t) - - A ( i ))--yy (t) z(t) - y(t) and
-A{ty'A'(t)A{t)-1 (Ait)'1)1 = -A{ty'A'(t)A{t)as well as of the the estimate estimate24 l
\\
fori = l , . . . , pp ++ ll,,
that for m = = qq + + 1, 1,qq+ +2, 2, Leibniz' rule rule it follows that by Leibniz' m+l
\\A{t)z^\t)\\ = \\A(t) (A(t)-ly'(t)){m) \\ \\A{t)z^\t)\\ and p+2
(t)\\
Therefore combining combining the last two estimates estimates with with (7.58) (7.58) and observing observing that that Therefore [0,T], f o r t e [0,T], l(o,t;3E),
1=1
m = qq + + 2,p+l 2,p+lt
1=1 1=1
the desired desired result result follows. follows. 23
+ nil nil since A(s) 1 is uniformly uniformly bounded. bounded. One can write A(s) instead of A(s) + This estimate estimate obtains obtainsby the (p+ (p+ l)-tuple strongly stronglycontinuous continuousdifferentiability differentiabilityof A(t)
24
on "Dora.
7.5. COMMENTS AND BIBLIOGRAPHICAL BIBLIOGRAPHICAL REMARKS REMARKS
177 177
Note that applying the RK RK method method directly directly to to problem problem (5.1) (5.1) and and using using Theorem 7.8 does not allow allow us us to to be be confident confident that that \\Y \\Yn - y{tn)\\ ~ O(k g+2) unless we make certain assumptions assumptions on on the the behaviour behaviour of of A{t)y^ A{t)y^q+2\t) (cf. Theorem 7.7).
7.5
Comments and bibliographical bibliographical remarks remarks
Section 7.2: The homogeneous homogeneous case case seems seems to to have have been been thoroughly thoroughly invesinvestigated by now even in the the framework framework of of Banach Banach spaces. spaces. Apparently, Apparently, Le Le Roux [102] is the first who who derived derived error error estimates estimates in in the the case case with with sectorial sectorial operator. It is remarkable remarkable that that her her result, result, although although presented presented for for Hilbert Hilbert spaces, admits an extension extension to to aa Banach Banach space space setting. setting. Such Such an an extension extensionisis stated in Brenner &; Thomee Thomee [52], [52],where where an an analogue analogue of ofthe thepresent present Theorem Theorem 7.1 for general Co semigroups semigroups isis also also contained. contained. Analogues Analogues ofof Theorem Theorem 7.2 7.2 in the case £ = 0, stated for for methods methods of of class class 5/ 5/ as as well, well, are are found found inin [102] [102] and [52]. Regarding the general general case case ££ >> 0, 0, the the results results related related to to Theorem Theorem 7.2 are presented in our work work [37]. [37]. Although Although the the paper paper [37] [37] deals deals with with the the case m — 0 only, its techniques techniques are are trivially trivially extended extended in in order order to to be be appliapplicable for m > 1 too. Apart Apart from from everything everything else, else, we we give give here here aa similar similar result for methods of the classes classes 5// 5// and and 5/// 5/// (see (see Theorem Theorem 7.3). 7.3). Note Note that that for both classes of methods methods the the presence presence of of aa damping damping factor, factor, whose whose role roleisis the initial initial conconplayed by the operator u>(—kA), is essential even for £ = 00 ifif the dition y° is not smooth enough. enough. The The idea idea of of damping, damping, when when deriving deriving error error estimates for non-smooth non-smooth data, data, goes goes back back to to the the work work ofof Luskin Luskin && RanRannacher [109] and Rannacher Rannacher [132] [132] carried carried out out for for Hilbert Hilbert spaces spaces and and some some special methods. Also, some some nonsmooth nonsmooth data data error error estimates estimates inin aa Banach Banach space setting are contained contained in in Hansbo Hansbo [82, [82, 83], 83], for for A-stable A-stable methods methods only only when dealing with the classes the classes Sn Sn and and 5///. 25 It is easily seen from the above considerations that that showing showing nonsmooth nonsmooth data data error error estimates estimates reduces, reduces, through applying Lemma Lemma 7.5, 7.5, to to making making use use of of certain certain strong strong stability stability type type estimates (cf., e.g., the proof proof of of Theorem Theorem 7.2) 7.2) while while the the role role ofof damping damping inin stability analysis has already already been been demonstrated demonstrated in in the the preceding preceding chapter. chapter. In the inhomogeneous case case one one should should expect expect extra extra difficulties difficulties which whichreresult from the fact that the the solution solution of of the the original original Cauchy Cauchy problem problem (5.1) (5.1) has has to satisfy certain compatibility compatibility conditions conditions in in order order to to obtain obtain the the optimal optimal order of converegence otherwise otherwise one one meets meets an an order order reduction. reduction. ItIt turns turns out out that a suitable choice of method method allows allows one one to to reduce reduce the the requirements requirements ofof 25
For methods of these classes, classes, the the requirement requirement of of ^-stability ^-stability implies implies the the condition condition deg[a(-) - a(oo)} = - 1 .
178
CHAPTER7. 7.CONVERGENCE CONVERGENCEESTIMATES ESTIMATES CHAPTER
space regularity,which whichare arevery veryoften oftenthought thought artificial. This possibility space regularity, of of as as artificial. This possibility is studied studied in indetail detailfor forthe thefirst firsttime timebyby Crouzeix in the context of Hilbert Crouzeix [59][59] in the context of Hilbert spaces; unfortunately, unfortunately, his histechniques techniquescannot cannotbebe extended Banach case. spaces; extended to to thethe Banach case. For equations equations inin aaBanach Banachspace, space,a arelated relatedresult result is first given in Brenner, is first given in Brenner, Crouzeix, and and Thomee Thomee[50]. [50].Their Theirachievement achievement been further extended Crouzeix, hashas been further extended in in Ostermann & &Roche Roche[123, [123,124] 124]and andininLubich Lubich Ostermann [105]. It follows follows [105]. Ostermann &; &; Ostermann their work workthat thatsometimes sometimesit itis is natural expect even fractional orders from their natural to to expect even fractional orders convergence. The Theproofs proofsofofTheorems Theorems7.47.4 and follow in essence of convergence. and 7.67.6 follow in essence the the paper [50]. [50]. paper Section 7.3: 7.3: The The question questionofofconvergence convergence Runge-Kutta methods, Section of of Runge-Kutta methods, ap- applied to to linear linear non-autonomous non-autonomousdifferential differentialequations equations a Banach space, plied in in a Banach space, not seem seem to tobe bestudied studiedthoroughly thoroughlyupup now. mention however does not to to now. WeWe mention however a a paper of of Gonzalez Gonzalez &&Ostermann Ostermann[71] [71]which which contains results close paper contains results thatthat are are close the assertion assertion ofofthe theabove aboveTheorem Theorem7.7. 7.7.AtAt same time Theorem to the thethe same time Theorem 7.7 7.7 stated under under somewhat somewhatless lessrestrictive restrictiverequirements requirements than in [71]. Some is stated than in [71]. Some further developments developments are aregiven givenininthe thestatements statements Theorems further of of Theorems 7.8,7.8, 7.10,7.10, 7.11. Theorem Theorem7.12 7.12presents presentsa aconvergence convergence result methods of class and 7.11. result for for methods of class as well. well. The The mentioned mentionedresults, results,including including that paper Si a as that of of thethe paper [71],[71], are are helpful for for applications applicationsconnected connectedwith withmultidimensional multidimensional problems not helpful problems in in spaces with with maximum maximumnorm normwhile whilethe theassertions assertions Theorems spaces of of Theorems 7.9 7.9 andand 7.137.13 intended for for use useininsuch suchsituations. situations. are intended Section 7.4: 7.4: The The question questionofofworking workingagainst againstorder order reduction Section reduction has has beenbeen extensively discussed discussedininthe theliterature literature(see, (see, e.g., Abarbanel, Gottlieb, extensively e.g., Abarbanel, Gottlieb, and and Carpenter [1], [1], Calvo Calvo kk Palencia Palencia[55], [55],Carpenter Carpenter [57], Keeling Carpenter et et al. al. [57], Keeling [92],[92], [130], and Sanz-Serna, Sanz-Serna, Verwer, Verwer,and andHundsdorfer Hundsdorfer[140]). [140]).OurOur conPathria [130], conPathria sideration in in the the present presentsection sectionhas hasnonopretensions pretensions being a complete sideration to to being a complete exposition of of the the problem. problem. exposition
Chapter 8
Variable Stepsize Approximations Our aim here is to extend some of the previous results to the case of nonuniform time partitions. partitions. In this chapter we never speak about discrete discrete semigroups since the transition operator depends depends essentially essentially on the corresponding time moment. distinguish moment. In our analysis below we nevertheless distinguish between two cases: commutative commutative and non-commutative. In the commutative case, although the transition operator varies varies with with time, time, it is always a (varying) function of one fixed operator. This circumstance circumstance allows allows us to use the operator calculus methods. methods. In this sense the situation is similar to that covered by autonomous equations and uniform grids. In the non-commutative case we make use of certain perturbation techniques. techniques. Throughout this chapter chapter any set of nodal points {io,*i> , £JV}J N > 1, such that to = 0 < t\ < . . . < % = T is called a non-uniform grid (non-uniform partition) in the segment [0, T] and is denoted by 15^- The situation when T — oo is also covered by our consideration; but in this case Uk consists of infinitely many nodal points. points. The parameter k is now not a number but a sequence (finite or infinite), and more precisely, k is defined as k = {ko,..., fcjv-i}, where kn = tn+\ — tn is the variable stepsize. Hereinafter, given a grid 15 & with N + 1 nodal points, it is always accepted that k]y — /cyv-i and ijv+i = % As above, we distinguish any objects that may depend on discrete time tn by n as a subscript. Also, we denote &fc = Uk \ {tN} and dZn = k-1(Zn+1-Zn)
for any discrete function Zn : 15^ —* -£ 179
for t nel5k,
(8.1)
180
CHAPTER 8.8. VARIABLE VARIABLESTEPSIZE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS CHAPTER
let the the above aboveRK RKmethod method Further, let let there therebe beaanon-uniform non-uniformgrid grid 15k and let Further, (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) be be used usedfor fordiscretization discretizationofofproblem problem (5.1) 15k, with with 9t 9t == I.I.1 (5.19), (5.1) on on 15k, Since Runge-Kuttadiscretization discretizationapplies applies locally, that separately at each Since Runge-Kutta locally, that is, is, separately at each moment, we wethen thenhandle handlea adiscrete discreteproblem problem which takes, in fact, time moment, which takes, in fact, the the same form form as as the the above abovediscrete discreteproblem problem(5.19), (5.19),(5.20), (5.20), with minor same with the the minor difference that kk isisreplaced replacedbybyknk and, and, in in particular, particular,tntj are are now now given givenby by difference that is not not hard hard to tosee seethat thatthe thestatement statementof of main theorem tnj = ttn + Cjkn. It is thethe main theorem representabilityofofthe thestarting startingproblem problem (5.19), (5.20) in the form (l.l)2 is (l.l) on representability (5.19), (5.20) in the form place of of k,k, provided providedthat thatdYdY (1.1) isis now now understood understood force with with kkn in place in force n in (1.1) the new new sense, sense, asasspecified specifiedbyby(8.1). (8.1).AtAtthethe same time, if A(t) in the same time, if A(t) = A= isA is independent ofof t,t, similarly similarlytotothe thecase casewith witha constant a constant stepsize, independent stepsize, we we thenthen consider problem problem (1.1) (1.1)with with consider k-1a(-knA), fHn = k-
Qn = I, I, Q
(8.2) (8.2)
and V
T
A))//^^--)), , Fn = w (-fc n ^)* n = J ^ - ffccnnA
(8.3) (8.3)
as a generalized generalized form formofof(5.19), (5.19),(5.20). (5.20).AsAs Chapter 5, we then in in Chapter 5, we then dealdeal withwith substituted for fork,k,which whichdefines definesuniquely uniquely the rational rational method method(5.30), (5.30),with withknk substituted a discrete discrete function function YYn : 15 k — — This function functionisiscalled calledthe theextended extended solution >> X. This solution the autonomous autonomouscase. case.Regardless Regardlessofof way by the the RK RK method methodon on15 k in the thethe way in in which 2l 2ln appears, appears, we we always alwaysassume assumethat that2l^v 2l^v — 21JV-I> 21JV-I> where where iV iV++ 11isisthe the which number number of of nodes nodesofof15 kBelow we Below we derive derivestability stabilityand anderror errorestimates estimates forfor thethe solution solution or iforA(t) if A(t) = = A then then for for the theextended extendedsolution solutionofof the the Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta procedure procedure (5.19), (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) in the the situation situationwith withaavariable variablestepsize. stepsize.InIn fact, fact, wewe take take thethe same same conditions conditions on the the operator operator A(t) A(t) asasininthe thecase casewith witha constant a constant stepsize. stepsize. At At the the same same time, using using the the assumption assumptionthat thatA(t) A(t)€ €S(ip,a), S(ip,a),wewe assume in addition time, assume in addition thatthat a > 0, 0, for for simplicity. simplicity. Also, Also,we weare arenot notconcerned concerned with of the above with all all of the above SJJJ, dealing dealing with with class class5/5/only. only.InIn introduced classesofofmethods methods5/, 5/,SJI, SJI, SJJJ, introduced classes the case case with with aa time-variable, time-variable,Holder-continuous Holder-continuous operator, some operator, we we taketake some extra restrictions restrictions on onthe theused usedfamilies familiesof of non-uniform grids. extra non-uniform grids. ^ o r the sake of simplicity, simplicity, no correction correction of the the initial initial condition conditiony° is is introduced introduced in this chapter. chapter. 2 of Theorem Theorem 5.1 That is, of
8.1. THE THE COMMUTATIVE CASE 8.1. COMMUTATIVE CASE
181 181
8.1 The commutative 8.1 The commutative case case Here weconsider considerthe thecase casewhere where theoperator operatorA(t) A(t)== doesnot notdepend depend on Here we the AA does on thissituation, situation, forany anytnn,ti ,ti G GUk Uk the corresponding transition operators t. In Inthis for the corresponding transition operators t. andit/ it/commute, commute, andone one can therefore usean anoperator operatorcalculus calculus formula iin and and can therefore use formula iin themain maintool tool ofanalysis. analysis. as of as the ofall allwe we givesome some useful comments. Letthe the RK methodbe beAj(ip)Aj(ip)First First of give useful comments. Let RK method
forall all G zS S for zG
(8.5) (8.5)
and and max{(1 {(1+ + |z|) |z|)11, ||rr((zz) |)}| <}e< efor forall all z z max
(8.6) (8.6)
with some G(|r(oo)|, (|r(oo)|,1). 1). Note Notethat that atthe the expenseof ofchoosing choosingd\ d\ suffisuffiee G at expense with some can takenas asclose closeto to|r(oo)| |r(oo)|as asdesired. desired. ciently large, ee can bebe taken ciently large, Next weshow showcertain certain auxiliary results. Inthe the corresponding statements Next we auxiliary results. In corresponding statements letthe the operatorA(t) A(t)depend dependupon upon forthe the reasonthat that assumption we let we operator tt for reason thisthis assumption beneeded neededfor forour our subsequent purposes. will subsequent purposes. will be L 8 . 1 .Let LetA(t) A(t) € S(tp,cr)and andlet let the methodbe be Aj(ip)-stable, Aj(ip)-stable, L eemmmm a a8.1. € S(tp,cr) the RKRK method
Proof. Withoutlossloss ofgenerality generality it can can assumedthat that > > hi. hi. Proof. Without of it bebe assumed hhnn > > Accepting therefore thelast last condition, condition, wefurther furtheruse usethe thefollowing followingidentity identity Accepting therefore the we (8.7) (8.7) where where i --ii
= (r(-hjA{t)) (r(-hjA{t)) r(oo)/) = -- r(oo)/) Clearly, Clearly,the thesame sameis istrue truefor forthe the function functiona(z). a(z).
(8.8) (8.8)
182
CHAPTER CHAPTER 8. 8. VARIABLE VARIABLE STEPSIZE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
Denoting next next
1=1
we let F ^ be be the the contour contour coinciding coincidingwith withthe theboundary boundaryofofthe theset setT>(r^ T>(r^ld) U E Vl , where d is the same as in (8.4) and ip\ ip\ comes comes from from the the statement statement now with with R = 0 of Lemma A.I. A.I. Note Note that that this this lemma lemma can can be applied now since a > 0. Clearly, F ^ can be decomposed into into two two parts parts as follows l } T(j) = rU) u r C;)) w h e r e TT(J) = dV{drr ) n ( - E^_ V1) and i f = { z £ C : argz = dzipi, T~ ld < \z\ < oo}. Using then then the the operator operator calculus calculus formula formula (A.10) with A(t) A(t) in place of £ and with F ^ in place of ER+£, we get, for 1 < 3 < n, jj ll
1 Gj(t) = j)
j) { j G[ = G[ = +G+G 2\
where G\
{j
— (2vrz)~ 1 fa)
\
(8.10) (8.10) / = 1,2. Since A(t) € S(tp,o),
using Lemma
A.I yields, with the aid of (8.4), that that
HG^II < C f e^lzl^ldzl
< C.
(8.11) (8.11)
Further, applying applying again again Lemma Lemma A.I A.I and and taking taking into intoaccount account(8.5), (8.5),(8.6), (8.6), and the obvious obvious inequality inequality
r(-z) -r(oo)| -r(oo)| < C(l + l^l)"1 for all zeH Vl,
we obtain d\h~
/
=:
poo poo e-^j-ixx-idx
+c c
(l + + hjx^x^dx hjx^x^dx
h + h-
(8-12) (8-12)
It is not hard to see that for hj < Tj-i, /
hj d\
e'crixx'1 dx
roo roo b
e'^x' e'^x'1
dx = C,
(8.13) (8.13)
8.2. THECOMMUTATIVE COMMUTATIVE 8.2. THE CASECASE
183 183
whilefor forhj hj>>Tj_i, Tj_i, while
h
x'11 dx dx <
(8.14) (8.14)
Jd/2 Jd/2
andusing usingthe theobvious obviousfact factthat that 1% <
D D
8.2.Let Let the conditionsof ofLemma Lemma 8.1 8.1be be satisfiedfor forsome some
a(-hiA(t))JJJJr(-hjA{t)) r(-hjA{t)) a(-hiA(t))
whereee comes comesfrom from(8.6) (8.6)and and given is by (8.9). (8.9). TjTj is given by where Proof. Sincedeg[p] deg[p] = —1, —1, it it follows followsfrom from Lemma 5.3that that Proof. Since = Lemma 5.3 + hA(t))p(-hA(t))\\ hA(t))p(-hA(t))\\ | | ((// +
h>0, <
which further yields, forall allh h>> 0 and which further yields, for 0 and u EuX,E X,
\\a(-hA{t))u\\ \\a(-hA{t))u\\ == l
u\\. u\\.
(8.15) (8.15)
Let now nowFFbebe the contourcoinciding coinciding Using ^ therefore theoperoperLet the contour withwith d E ^ d..44EUsing therefore the ator calculus calculus formula (A.in 10) in whichthe thepath path of ofintegration integrationis isreduced reducedto to ator formula (A. 10) which F since sincethe theintegrand integrandis isbounded boundedat at 0, 0,we we have F have
hiA(t) hiA(t)
(8.16) (8.16) \<j
4
As fromfrom As above, above,>ii comes the thestatement statementof ofLemma LemmaA.I. A.I. Also, Also, recall recall that that the theestimate estimate inthis this statement statement holds holds withwith R R= =00since sincea a >>0.0. (A.I) (A.I) in
CHAPTER 8. VARIABLE VARIABLE STEPSIZE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
184 where
{zl -
dz.
(8.17) F 2 = dV(d xh~{1) n 00 << |z| Let next r i = {z G C :: argz argz == |z| << d^ d^1}, (— ETT-^J) and let F = T\ UF2 be be oriented oriented clockwise. clockwise. Since Since the the norm norm of of the the 2 integrand on the right-hand right-hand side side of of (8.17) (8.17) isis O(|z|~ O(|z|~ ) as \z\ —* oo, after a tolerable deformation of of the the path path of of integration integration we we use use formula formula (8.17) (8.17) with with T in place of F. Therefore, Therefore, taking taking into into account account that that Jf(zl Jf(zl — —A(t))"" A(t))""1 dz = 0 and applying Cauchy's Theorem Theorem we we obtain, obtain, instead instead of of (8.17), (8.17),
G (0 = A
2m
/" z(i + htz)-1 TT r(-hjz)(zl Jr t,,
dz.
(8.18)
Denote next by G 1 and G 2 the right-hand side of of this this equality equality with with Fi Fi and F2, respectively, in in place place of of F. F. With With the the aid aid of of Lemma Lemma A.I, A.I, (8.5), (8.5), and and (8.6) we get
< Chi
'n~jX dx
j=0
j=0 j=0
At the same time by Lemma Lemma A.I A.I and and (8.6) (8.6) itit follows follows that that
G2l)\\ < Chi
\r(-hjz)\\dz
n Chiee n ff \dz\ < 77r
(8.20)
It thus remains to combine combine (8.15), (8.15), (8.16), (8.16), (8.18), (8.18), (8.19), (8.19), and and (8.20). (8.20). We further extend both both Lemma Lemma 8.1 8.1 and and Lemma Lemma 8.2 8.2 in in the the following following way. way.
8.1. THE COMMUTATIVE COMMUTATIVE CASE CASE
185 185
L e m m a 8.3. Let Let the the conditions conditions of Lemma 8.1 be satisfied for some tp G (0,TT/2) > 0. 0. Let Let also seminorms seminorms \ \t and and || |* |*;t form respectively respectively (0,TT/2) and a > (£|1|?, cr)- and (*;£*|l|>, (*;£*|l|>, a)-concordant a)-concordant pairs pairs with with A(t), for for some £,£* G [0,1], and let w(z) w(z) be beaa rational function function which which is (ip)-regular (ip)-regular and satisfies max{£,£*}. Then Then for any any non-decreasing non-decreasing finite finite the condition condition deg[w] deg[w] < — max{£,£*}. numbers 0 < hi < < holds, for all all tt G G [0,T] [0,T] < hhn, it holds, sequence of positive numbers and I = 1 , . . . , n , n-l
sup \oj(-hiA(t)) \oj(-hiA(t)) JJJJ r(-hjA(t))u\ r(-hjA(t))u\t < C ^ ee j T ^ + Ch^\r(oo)\ Ch^\r(oo)\n and
sup |a;(-M(t)r |a;(-M(t)r I I ri-
n-l
from (8.6) and and TJ is given by (8.9). where e comes from The proof proof is similar to that of Lemma 8.1 and of of Lemma 8.2 in the the cases and ££ G G(0,1], respectively. respectively. £ = 0 and introduce some some notions notions which which are needed to state the below Next we introduce families of grids. restrictions on the used families restrictions Definition 8.1. With any finite sequence sequence K,n — (kj)^=1, we associate associate the Definition reordered sequence 7in = (/ij)^ =1 given by hj = kkL^, where the bisection bisection t(-) reordered sequence is chosen so that h\ <
and 1) whenever whenever hj — hj+\. L(J) < i(j + 1) finite sequence sequence Tin will then then be called the ordered sequence sequence for /Cn. The finite Definition Let 77 be beaafamily of grids in [0,T]. The family 7 is called Definition 8.2. Let if there exists exists a constant C > 0 such exponentially balanced balanced with with basis basisQ > 1 if exponentially points5 and for for any any indices I, n that for any grid 15k G T with N + 1 nodal points subject to 0 < I < < nn < < N, N,
3=1 5
recall tthhaatt k = W e recall
{k0,...,
186
CHAPTER CHAPTER 8. VARIABLE STEPSIZE STEPSIZE
where the finite sequence W n _; + i = (hj)^~^ +l P*
/;
APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
is the ordered sequence for
\n—Z+l
K-n-l+1 = Kkj+l-l)j=l
with range range Definition 8.3. A family of grids 7 is called locally balanced with or l Q > 1 if Q" kn+i
(8-21) (8-21)
range Q, while since T is locally balanced with range ^ 3=1
1
^
> Q- {n-l+l-m)K_l+l.
(8.22)
3=1 3=1
Combining (8.21) and (8.22) therefore yields, yields, with with any fixed Q\ > Q, for m = 1 , . . . , n — I + 1,
3=1
33== 1
33== 1
which means that T is, in fact, exponentially balanced balanced with with basis basis Q\ > Q, where Q\ can be chosen as close to Q as desired. As a simple example, we note that the family of grids defined by kn — Qnko, n = 0 , 1 , . . . , Q — const > 1, where &o > 0 is a free parameter, is obviously locally balanced balanced with with range range Q. Yan [166] defines the so-called quasi-quasiuniform quasi-quasiuniform assumption assumption on the variable stepsize which is as follows. T is called a family of quasi-quasiuniform grids if, whenever tn,tn+\ G U^, for all 15k € T, kn < kn+1
(8.23) (8.23)
and ckn+i
Ctn+1/(n
+ 1).
(8.24)
However it turns out that any family of increasing quasi-quasiuniform quasi-quasiuniform grids grids is, in fact, exponentially balanced balanced with with basis basis Q > 1, where Q can be chosen as close to 1 as desired.
8.1. THE COMMUTATIVE CASE CASE
187 187
To see this fact, we note first first that, that, as as itit follows follows from from (8.23), (8.23),for for all allUk Uk££ 77 and ti,tn £ Uk with 1 < I < n, ., i-i
nn
j=o
j=i j=i
which further implies t n + i/(n + 1) < (<„+! - ti)/(n ti)/(n -l-l + + l). l). Obviously, the last inequality inequality holds holds for for II == 00 as as well. well. Therefore, Therefore, instead insteadofof n (8.24) we actually have, whenever whenever t/,£ t/,£n+i 6 Uk & d U < *n> for all Uk £ T, cfcn+i
{tn+i ~ ti)/(n ti)/(n -- // ++ 1). 1).
With this inequality in mind, mind, we we obtain, obtain, whenever whenever t;t; << ttn and 1 < m < n-l + 1, n-l
n
k
n-l
kj <J2 J 3=1
+ C
'kn-1 < (1 + C/( n-l))
E fc j
3=1
n-l
<
n + C/g) ^ fc : < ( — l + l m i —I 7='
i+m-1
and, clearly, 5^?=/ % admits admits the the same same bound bound for for // == nn as as well. well. Also, Also, letting letting Q be any fixed number >> 1, 1, itit holds, holds, with with any any fixed fixed dd>>0,0, < CQn-l+1~m.
(8.26) (8.26)
m
Finally, combining (8.25), (8.25), (8.26), (8.26), and and the the fact fact that that any any Uk Uk€€ TTisisan anincreasincreasing grid shows the claim. Definition 8.4. T is called calledaa family family of of quasi-uniform quasi-uniform grids grids ifif there thereexists existsaa constant C such that max kn < C min k n 6 u
for all Uk £ 7.
If T is a family of quasi-uniform quasi-uniform grids, grids, then, then, for for any any 13k £ 7, ti,t n £ with / < n, and l<m
— —ll + + l,l, letting, letting, as as above, above, TC TCn-i+i
— (hj)^l[
188 188
CHAPTER VARIABLE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS CHAPTER 8. 8. VARIABLE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS
be theordered orderedsequence sequence for K Kn-i+\ be the for
+1 +1
(kj+ == (kj
,
m m
x x
3=1 3=1
m m Using this thisestimate estimate andthe theparticular particularcase caseof of (8.26), (8.26), where wherethe the exponent exponent Using and on the theleft left equals equals1, 1, we weobtain obtain that thatany anyfamily family of of quasi-uniform quasi-uniformgrids grids is is d on exponentiallybalanced balanced with Q >> 1,1,where where Q Q can canbe betaken taken as as close closeto to exponentially with basisbasis Q as required. required. 1 as The above abovediscussion discussion andour oursubsequent subsequentconsideration consideration in this this chapter chapter The and in shows that thatit it suffices suffices to to deal deal only onlywith withexponentially exponentially balanced families of shows balanced families of grids. grids. Now we westate state aa stability stabilityresult resultfor for problems problemswith withaa constant constant operator. operator. Now Letthe theoperator operatorA(t) A(t) == AAbebe independent of of t,t, let letAA€ € independent T hheeoorreemm 88..11. .Let S(ip, a), a), and andlet letthe the RK method be beof oftype type Ci(ip), Ci(ip),for for some some
*n€€ UUk. f°f°r *n
(8.27) (8.27)
Furthermore, if if in in addition addition 77 is is an anexponentially exponentiallybalanced balanced family of grids grids Furthermore, family of Q such such that that with basis basisQ with Q<|r(oo)|-\ (8-28) Q<|r(oo)|-\ (8-28) then holds, holds,for for any anyfixed fixed£ £ 66 [0,1], [0,1], for for all allUk Uk€ €7 7and and G t Uk, Uk, it then forfor all tall n G n-ln-l
/ n ||
i
\
+Y Ytkl(tn+ i-ti+1 )-tmax + n+i-ti +1)-tmax i=o i=o
\\f(tij)\\).. \\f(tij)\\)
\
(8.29) (8.29)
Proof.First First of of all allby byLemma Lemma5.3 5.3we weobtain obtain since sincedeg[u>j] deg[u>j] < 0, 0, Proof. < C, jj ==l,...,u, l,...,u, < C,
(8.30) (8.30)
uniformly withrespect respect to to kk >>0.0.Therefore, Therefore,if if TT isisan anarbitrary arbitraryfamily family of of uniformly with grids, grids, (8.27) (8.27) follows followsby by applying applyingLemma Lemma 8.1 8.1and and(8.30) (8.30) for for an anestimation estimationon on
8.1. THE COMMUTATIVE
CASE CASE
189 189
the basis of the representation, for tn G Uk, n-l
Yn = r(-fc n_iA)
r(-koA)y° + J^ kr(-k n^A)
r(-kl+1 A)Ft. r(-k l+1A)Ft.
(8.31)
1=0
Let now 7 be an exponentially balanced balanced family family of grids with basis Q satisfying (8.28). We then have, for all Uk G 7 and tn,ti G Uk such that | r ( o o ) r / + 1 < Q - > - ; + 1 ) < Ckn(tn+1
- U)- 1
(8.32)
and
(
\ ~l
n-l+l-j
Y, m=l
h
m)
j = 0,...,n-l,
(8.33)
/
where (^m)^] 1 " 1 ^s * n e ordered sequence for (km+i-i)^L.f1. Select further 1 6 some s G (^(oo)!,^" ). Applying then Lemma Lemma 8.2 and taking (8.32) and (8.33) into account yields yields that that for ti < t n, n-l ) 3=1
ti)-1.
(8.34) (8.34)
(A.18), we Therefore, by Lemma 8.1, (8.34), and the convexity inequality (A.18), get, for any fixed £ G [0,1], for fy
3=1
Using now this inequality for an estimation on the basis of (8.31), with both sides multiplied from the left by 2l|, leads to (8.29). and let let the the operator A(t) = A and the RK RK Remark 8.1. Let T = oo and method satisfy the conditions of Lemma 8.1 for some
We recall that e in the statement of Lemma 8.2 can be chosen as close to |r(oo)| as desired.
190
CHAPTER 8. VARIABLE VARIABLE STEPSIZE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS CHAPTER
and the estimate estimate (8.29) (8.29) holds holdswith with}[u(—k }[u(—k substituted for for nA)Yn][tn substituted (0,1] and and ifif 77 isis an an exponentially exponentiallybalanced balanced family of of grids grids with withbasis basis if £ £ (0,1] (8.28). satisfying (8.28). Q satisfying result follows follows from from Lemma Lemma8.3. 8.3. This result
non-commutative case case 8.2 The The non-commutative In this section section we we proceed proceed from fromthe thesupposition suppositionthat thatthe theoperator operatorA(t) A(t)may may on t.t. Throughout Throughout the thesection sectionititisisassumed assumedthat thatT T<
(8.35) (8.35)
and Ckn+i. kn < Ckn+i.
(8.36) (8.36)
Let further further zznj and w wnj be nonnegative nonnegativesolutions solutionsofofthe therespective respectiveinequaliinequali7 ties, for all all 13k £ 7 and and ti,t ti,tn £ 13k with t\ < < ttn, n-\ Cl
M++ii((VVii - f 0~ C2 zn,i < C(tn+1 - i,)~ + C j ] f cc,,ZZM
(8-37) (8-37)
q=l
and n-l q=l
with some some Ci,C2 Ci,C2 ££ [0)l)[0)l)- Then, Then,ififKK isissufficiently sufficientlysmall, small,wewehave, have, forfor allall 13k £ 7 and and ti,t ti,tn £ 13k with ti
(8-38) (8-38)
^r C l -
(8.39) (8.39)
and In the particular particular case case(j(j == 0,0, condition condition(8.36) (8.36)isisnot not needed. needed. 7
Actually, both zn,i and w wn,i depend on 15kActually, both
8.2. THE NON-COMMUTATIVE NON-COMMUTATIVE
CASE CASE
191 191
Proof. We show only the former former stated stated estimate estimate (8.38), (8.38), noting noting that that (8.39) (8.39) is proved by using the same same reasoning. reasoning. from (8.37) (8.37) that that for for all all Uk Uk GG TT Denoting z n^ = {tn+\ —tfi^Znj, it follows from and ti,tn G Uk with t\
^n,l
—^
' ^ v n~Hl
I) I)
//
^qx^n-hl
^ q)
*"n, q+\\^q-\-l
^1}
yo.^uj
q=i
since \tn+l ~ tq+l) X ^ C\tn-\-\ ~ t q) 1 f° r ^g+1 ^ ^ni by (8.36). Let further T\ T\ G G (0, (0, T/2] T/2] be be aa fixed fixed number number which which will willbe be specified specified later and let K > 0 be subject subject to to K K < < T\. T\. Given Given ttn G 13k, we put, for j > 1, 1, = maxi"^, maxi"^, Tj = [max{0,t n + i - j T i } , t n + i - (j - l)7i) and Zj = IJtTj
and denote by t', -, and £'/-, £'/-, the the largest largest and and smallest smallest nodes, nodes, respectively, respectively, ofof ^5fcU{£n+i} such that TJ C [£ , unless Tj is void. By (8.40) we therefore therefore have, for m > 1,
\
x rnax
( i n + 1 - t;) Cl
.
(8.41)
Taking (8.35) into account, account, recalling recalling that that KK << T\, T\, and and noting noting that that titi calculation now now gives, gives, with with AAXo t'o < t'f-s < t n+\ if ti ^ Tj, a simple calculation U< < ttn, [x0, X0 + 3Ti], for j > 1 and U < I
(*n+l - ^)" ^ ) " C l ((^^ -
'9+lS^
max
/
(t n+i
-
x06[0,r-2T1] 7[t,,t B+i]nAX0
Combining this estimate estimate with with (8.41), (8.41), we we obtain, obtain, for for mm >> 1,1, Zm
l
+ T-,
192 192
CHAPTER 8. VARIABLE VARIABLESTEPSIZE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS CHAPTER 8. APPROXIMATIONS
noconstant constantC C depends dependson onT\. T\.Taking Takingnow nowT\T\sufficiently sufficientlysmall, small, it whereno where it follows that follows that 1 1 —I— ~ f ,, —I— ~
III III
XX
£j £j
which further implies Zm < CCsince sincem m <<\T/T\\ \T/T\\ + + 1.1. Clearly, Clearly,this this which further implies that that Z m < bythe thedefinition definitionof ofZj Zjand and ~znnj.. j.. inequalityshows shows (8.38), by ~z inequality (8.38), In conclusion, note applying thesame sameargument, argument, it is isnot not necessary In conclusion, note that,that, applying the it necessary use(8.36) (8.36)if if Ci Ci==0.0. to use to Now weshow showstability stability inthe thecase casewith withaa variable variableoperator. operator. It isisconveconveNow we in It nientto todenote, denote,given given gridUk, Uk,for forany any tG[0,T] [0,T]and and ti,tnn €€Uk, Uk, nient aa grid tG ti,t t), t),
i(t)=U (t)---Ui(t), iXiX n>i(t)=U n(t)---Ui(t), n> n
dealingwith with theRK RK method(5.19), (5.19), (5.20) applied to (5.1) (5.1) Uk, dealing the method (5.20) applied to onon Uk, andand
8 8 dealing with problem (1.1)considered consideredon onUkUkUsingthe theabove abovenotation, notation, dealing with problem (1.1) Using to (1.4) (1.4) the solutionY Ynn of of (1.1) (1.1) the non-uniform case isreprerepresimilarly similarly to the solution inin the non-uniform case is sented as sented as
n --ll n
o Ynn = =U Unn.. ..lfi yo +YY/kUn-i,i+iFi. kUn-i,i+iFi. Y + lfiy
(8.42) (8.42)
1=0 1=0
Also, forsubsequent subsequent usewe we pointout outthe the identity,for forttnn,ti ,ti 6615k 15k such suchthat that Also, for use point identity,
U< U
iln_l,l = Un-l,l(*l) Un-l,l(*l) + Yl Yl kkqq&n-l, &n-l,q+ l{%{tl) -- 2t,)U,_i,j(*i). 2t,)U,_i,j(*i). iln_l,l = + q+l{%{tl)
(8-43) (8-43)
q=l q=l
Henceforth, Henceforth,given given aa non-uniform non-uniform gridgrid Uk, Uk,by bythe the discrete discretesolution, solution, for for brevity,we brevity, wemean meanthe thesolution solutionby bythe theRK RK method method(5.19), (5.19), (5.20) (5.20) applied applied to to problem (5.1)on on Uk- Note Notethat that allthe thebelow belowstatements statements contain assumpproblem (5.1) Ukall contain assumptionsthat thatensure ensure the therepresentability representability of ofthe the starting startingRK RKproblem problemin inthe theform form tions in which which2l 2lnn, Q3 Q3nn,and andFF arespecified specifiedby by(5.38), (5.38),(5.39), (5.39), and(5.41), (5.41), (1.1) (1.1) in and n n are with kknn substituted substituted for fork.k.InIn what whatfollows follows we wealways alwaysassume assume thatthat 2l 2lnn, Q3 Q3nn, with and F and Fnn are aredefined definedas asspecified specifiedand andwe we use use thethe representation representation (8.42) (8.42) for forthe the discrete solution discrete solution Y Ynn without withoutexplicit explicit mention. mention. Our Our first firstresult result on onstability stabilityis isas asfollows. follows. 8 8
isassumed assumedthat t h aiitnn,i{t) ,i{t) ii — —lln,i lln,i = = // ififn n< 2. < 2. It It is
8.2. THE NON-COMMUTATIVE NON-COMMUTATIVE CASE CASE
193 193
Theorem 8.2. Suppose Suppose A(t) A(t) G GS((p, S((p, a), a), aa seminorm seminorm \\ \\t forms a (71 \ip, a)concordant pair with A(t), A(t), and and A(t) A(t) saisfies saisfies hypothesis hypothesis hol®[i?; hol®[i?;\-\t], \-\t],for for some some
||2ln(tn)^n|| < Ct^y \\
+ C *£ k(t n+1 - tl+1)~t max ||/(ty)||. (8-44) -- 3 -
1=0
v
Proof. Similarly to (6.61) and (6.59) (6.59) we we have, have, with with some some fig fig >> 0,0, for for all all Uk G T, t n G Uk, and u G X,
_
(8.45) (8.45)
and | | F n | | < C m a x ||/(t nj -)||.
(8.46) (8.46)
Next, by the convexity inequality inequality (A.18) (A.18) and and Lemma Lemma 8.1 8.1itit holds, holds,for fort\t\ << ttn,
= . (8.47)
Since T is an exponentially exponentially balanced balanced family family of of grids gridswith with basis basisQQ<< by Lemma 8.2 as in the proof proof of of Theorem Theorem 8.1, 8.1, itit follows follows that that < C(tn+l - i j ) " 1 .
(8.48)
Using also Theorem 6.9 and and Lemmas Lemmas 8.2 8.2 and and 8.3, 8.3, itit isis not not hard hard to to see see that that
(8.49)
Therefore, combining (8.47), (8.47), (8.48), (8.48), and and (8.49) (8.49) yields, yields, for for ttt < tn,
9
The fractional powers 2l 2l n (t n ) ? , ^ > 0, are defined and bounded bounded on on X X since since aa >> 0. 0.
194
CHAPTER 8. VARIABLE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
\t Further, by Theorem 6.1 it follows that the seminorm X^=i \vj(~kA(t)) forms a Aj (7i)-concordant pair with with k~ k~1a(—kA{t)). Hence applying applying Lemma Lemma 1.9 shows that with some fj-o > 0 and 72 € (71,1), for all u £ X, V
u||.
(8.50)
Now, with the aid of (8.45), (8.49), (8.50), and the above argument, we obtain, with 73 = max{l — i9,72}, for ti < t n,
Using this inequality together together with with (8.48) (8.48) for an estimation on the basis of (8.43), with both sides multiplied multiplied from from the left by 2l n (i n )^, the reader will have no difficulty in seeing that with znj = ||2ln(£re)^.Un_ij/||, for ti < t n, n-l
Zn,l < C{tn+l - tt)-t + CY/kqZn,q+l(tq+1
-
U)^.
q=l
Noting that 73 < 1, observing that (8.36) holds, holds, by the fact that the family T is exponentially balanced balanced with with basis basis Q, and applying then Lemma 8.4, we find, for ti
Theorem 8.3. Let the conditions of Theorem 8.2 be satisfied with the difference that the operator A(t) fulfils hypothesis hol[i9] hol[i9] instead instead of h6\®[d; \-\t\. Then the stability estimate (8.44) (8.44) holds holds for any fixed £ G [0,1]. Proof. Clearly, it suffices to show the result for £ = 1 only. To that end, we put, for t\ < t n, Let p be the smallest integer such that that I < p < n + 1 and t n + 1 - tp < - ( t n + i - **)
8.2. THE NON-COMMUTATIVE
CASE CASE
195 195
Observe that p > I + 1. If p = n + 1, 1, we we have tn+i — U < 2k n, which gives, applying Theorem 8.2 with £ = 0, Lemma 1.1, and Theorem 6.2, Wn,l < 2||fc n 2l n (t n )|| \\iin-l,l\\ < C Assume further that p < n. We then use the identity, for t\
(tn+i
n-1
+ (*„+! - t j ) J2 *?2ln(*n)^-l,«+l(*n)(a,(t *?2ln(*n)^-l,«+l(*n)(a,(t n )-2l,)ll,-l,J.
(8.52)
q=p-l
Under the accepted Holder-continuity Holder-continuity type type hypothesis, hypothesis, instead instead of (8.45) it holds, for all u G X, ||®n«|| < Cki{pin{tn)u\\
+ \\u\\).
(8.53)
With this estimate in mind and applying Theorems 6.9 and 8.2 (the latter one with £ = 0), we find, for ti
k% + {tn - t qf) < c(tn+1 - tqy ((t g+1 - t{)-lwqyl + I) . Using this estimate, Theorem Theorem 8.2 with £ = 0, and the argument employed in its proof for an estimation on the basis of (8.52), we now get, for t\ < t n,
- v-i n-1 v \ "* h (+ -^ / r°q\''n+l q=p-l
+ ,, + ,\~^(+ ,\~^(+ ''q+lj y^n+l ''q+lj
+ + \® \®((+ ((+ ,, ^q) \\ l>q+l
i,\~^in i 4- l\ w H) q,l '
(R ^4^ \p.Ot)
The fact that T is an exponentially balanced balanced family family of grids with basis Q implies (8.36). Therefore Therefore it holds (tn+i ~ tq+l)~l
< C{tn+l - tq)' 1
for t q < tn-
(8.55)
Also, by the definition of p we have (tn+\ — tp-i)~
< 2(i n + i — ti)~ and (t p — ti)~ < 2(tn+i — ti)~ . (8.56)
196
CHAPTER CHAPTER 8. 8. VARIABLE VARIABLE STEPSIZE STEPSIZE
APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
By (8.55) and (8.56) it then then follows follows from from (8.54) (8.54) that that for for ttt < tn, n-l
Wn,l
and further, since p > II + + 1, 1, n-l
wnii
k q(tn+i -
t q)~(l~^wqtl.
q=l
Finally, using Lemma 8.4 estimate 8.4 and and recalling recalling that that 11 — i9 < 1, the last estimate yields that w nj < C which shows the the claim, claim, with with the the aid aid of of (8.42) (8.42) and and ' (8.46). Remark 8.2. Let the conditions conditions of of Theorem Theorem 8.1 8.1 or or of of Theorem Theorem 8.2 8.2 be besatissatisform aa fied for some (p G (0,TT/2), a > 0, and£ G [0,1], 10 let a seminorm][-}[t form (£\l\ip, a)-concordant pair pair with with the the operator operator A(t), A(t), and and let let UJ(Z) be a rational function which is ((p)-regular ((p)-regular and and satisfies satisfies the the condition condition deg[w] deg[w] << —£. —£. Then Then the stability estimate (8-44) (8-44) holds holds with with ][w(—k ][w(—knA(tn)) Yn][tn substituted for This assertion can be established established with with the the aid aid of of the the above above argument, argument, G Dom Dom A(t), A(t), using, if £ G (0,1], the fact that for all u G
lui^CMAW + VufM1-*. Note that for £ = 1 the the last last inequality inequality isis aa trivial trivial consequence consequence ofof the the can (£|1|<£,cr)-concordance of of the the pair pair (][-][t; (][-][t; A(t)), while for 0 < £ < 11 itit can be shown in a manner similar similar to to that that used used for for proving proving the the convexity convexity ininequality (cf., e.g., Krein Krein [96, [96, The The proof proof of of Theorem Theorem 5.2]). 5.2]). It turns out that if A(t) A(t) is is under under hypothesis hypothesis lip, lip, in in the the case case ££ == 00 itit isis not necessary to impose impose any any restrictions restrictions on on the the family family of of grids. grids. Theorem 8.4. Let the the operator operator A(t) A(t) and and the the RK RK method method satisfy satisfy the the conconditions of Theorem 8.3 8.3 with with the the difference difference that that A(t) A(t) now now fulfils fulfils hypothesis hypothesis lip 11 and T is an arbitrary family family of of grids. grids. Then Then the the stability stability estimate estimate (8.44) (8.44) holds with £ — 0.
The proof of the theorem theorem will will be be based based on on the the following. following. 10 n
The case £ = 1 is included included under under the the conditions conditions of of Theorem Theorem 8.2 8.2 only. only. That T h a t is, one formally takes takes i? i? == 1. 1.
8.2. THE THE NON-COMMUTATIVE NON-COMMUTATIVE CASE CASE
197 197
Lemma 8.5. Under Underthe theconditions conditionsofofTheorem Theorem 8.4, Lemma 8.5. 8.4, forfor all all Uk Uk G T,GtT, n,ti G [0,T], and t,s t,s GG[0,T], Uk, and
Proof. Given tn,ti G Ufc Ufc such such that that t\t\ <
where Gj(t) isisgiven givenby by(8.8). (8.8).Let Letfurther furtherthethe contour ^ just be just same where Gj(t) contour F ^F be the the same as in the the proof proof ofofLemma Lemma8.1. 8.1.By Bythe theoperator operator calculus formula calculus formula (A.(A. 10),10), afterafter a deformation deformation ofofthe thepath pathofofintegration, integration,wewe have, 1, have, forfor j =j 1=, .1. .,,. n. . ,—nI + 1,
Jw
JJ ww
2TT* 2TT*
i-i
z)((zl - Ait))' Ait))'1 - (zl (zl -- A(s))~ A(s))~l) dz. (8.58) (8.58) x J J r(-hqz)((zl 9=1
By the the accepted acceptedLipschitz-continuity Lipschitz-continuitytype type hypothesis resolvent idenhypothesis andand thethe resolvent identity (6.45) (6.45) with with kk== 1,1,we wefind, find,forforz G zG
||(zJ -- A(i))A(i))-1 !! ||(A(t) ||(A(t) -- A( A(5)) (zl (zl -- A{s)) A{s))-l\ < ||(zJ
With With this this estimate estimateininmind, mind,the thenorm normof of thethe integral integral on on thethe right-hand right-hand sideside of (8.58) (8.58) can can be bebounded boundedbybythe theamount amount
r
C\t-s\ C\t-s\
/ \r(-h \r(-hiz)-r(oo)\T\\r(-h z)-r(oo)\T\\r(-hqz)\\z\z)\\z\-1\dz\ Jrti) *J{ *J{
r r
++C\t-s\ C\t-s\
/ \z\\z\-2\dz\. Jrti) Jrti)
Clearly, the is bounded by by C and the the same Clearly, the second secondintegral integralininthis thisexpression expression is bounded C and same thethe reasoning employed in the can be be shown shown for for the thefirst firstintegral, integral,following following reasoning employed in the proof of Gj(s)|| << C\t C\t — s\. Using Using this this fact fact proof of Lemma Lemma 8.1. 8.1.Therefore Therefore||Gj(t) ||Gj(t)— Gj(s)|| for an an estimation estimation on onthe thebasis basisofof(8.57) (8.57)shows shows thethe claim. claim.
198
CHAPTER CHAPTER 8.8. VARIABLE VARIABLESTEPSIZE STEPSIZE APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
Proof of for for ti ti
iinitn) iinitn)
-Hf(*z) (t,+l) - iin, -Hf(*z)==Un,l(ti) Un,l(ti)++^(iln.g+1 ^(iln.g+1 (t,+l) - iin,q+l(tq))ilq(tq) q=l
and applying a simple calculation shows that that applying Lemmas Lemmas8.18.1and and8.5, 8.5, a simple calculation shows n- l q=l
Therefore, Therefore, by byLemma Lemma8.4, 8.4, \\iin(tn)---iXi(ti)\\
(8.59) (8.59)
Furthermore, by i9 =i9 1= and Lemma 1.1 it1.1follows that that Furthermore, byvirtue virtueofof(8.53) (8.53)with with 1 and Lemma it follows II®n|| << C. (8.59) for for an estimation on the II®n|| C. Using Usingthis thisfact facttogether togetherwith with (8.59) an estimation on the basis of basis of the the identity, identity,forfort\ t\
more leads us to desired result, with with and applying applyingnext nextLemma Lemma8.48.4once once more leads us the to the desired result, the aid aid ofof the the representation representation(8.42). (8.42). forfor practical applications. The following following result resultisisalso alsoofofinterest interest practical applications. Theorem A(t) thethe RKRK method be under the conTheorem 8.5. 8.5. Let Letthe theoperator operator A(t)andand method be under the conditions ditions of of Theorem Theorem6.13 6.13forforsome some
8.3. ERROR ESTIMATES
199 199
This result can be shown in a manner similar to that used in the proofs of Theorems 8.2, 8.3, and 8.4, with the aid of Theorem 6.7 and Lemma 8.3, using as well some reasonings employed employed in the proof of Theorem 6.13. ; | |m;t, m — 0, *0), the Also, note that if A{t) is under hypothesis \ip(A(t; assertion of Lemma 8.5 is still valid, which allows one to use the argument applied in the proof of Theorem 8.4. The reader will have no difficulty in stating an analogue to Theorem 6.14 in the case of non-uniform grids.
8.3
Error estimates
In this section we present two types of error estimates, namely, a priori and a posteriori estimates. Our reasons are that both types of estimates are of great importance for practical applications in the case of nonuniform time partitions. In particular, a posteriori error analysis is widely used as a basis for applying adaptive stepsize stepsize control. control. Starting by showing certain a priori error estimates, we remark that the analysis of convergence in Chapter 7, carried out in the case of uniform time partitions, is based on a step-by-step estimation of the local error and on subsequent summing up the contribution to the total error coming from all steps of the numerical process. Clearly, Clearly, error error estimates estimates of RK methods on non-uniform grids are derived derived in the same way provided that one one has has already already shown the necessary stability stability estimates. estimates. Below Belowwe wegive givesome someanalogues analogues of the convergence results of Chapter 7, dealing with families of non-uniform grids. Actually, we show, as an example, error estimates of the standard form, that is, in the norm || ||. Note nevertheless that weighted weighted error error estimates estimates can be derived as well by analogy with what is done in Chapter 7. We first show an analogue of Theorem 7.4 for non-uniform grids, considering, for simplicity, only the case m = 0. Theorem 8.6. Let T = oo, let the the operator A{t) and the RK method be under the conditions of Theorem 7.4, assuming that that a > 0 in addition, and let 7 be an arbitrary family of grids. Then instead of (7.21) it holds \\Yn-y{tn)\\
<
3=0
200
CHAPTER CHAPTER 8. 8. VARIABLE VARIABLE STEPSIZE STEPSIZE
APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
for all Uk € 7 and t n 6 Ufc.
The proof of this result result follows follows that that of of Theorem Theorem 7.4, 7.4, using using Lemma Lemma 8.1 8.1 as well. Next we state a convergence convergence result result in in the the non-autonomous non-autonomous case. case. Theorem 8.7. Let T < < oo, oo, let let the the operator operator A(t) A(t) and and the the RK RK method method be be under the conditions of one one of of the the above above Theorems Theorems 7.7, 7.7, 7.8, 7.8, or or 7.9, 7.9, assuming assuming that a > 0 in addition, and and let let 77 be be an an arbitrary arbitrary family family of of grids. grids. Then, Then, with with K > 0 sufficiently small, small, for for all all 13k £ 7 with max ( g kn < K and for all tn € 13k, it holds, instead instead of of (7.1^2), (7.1^2), \\Yn -
y(tn)\\
+ CJ2k9j+2 E j=Q
/
l=q+l Jti
\\A(s)y^(s)\\d S + Cj2kPj j=0 j=0
Jt
i
and, instead of (7.51), \\Yn - y(tn)\\ <
This assertion follows by by analogy analogy with with the the proofs proofs of of Theorems Theorems 7.7, 7.7, 7.8, 7.8, and 7.9, using Theorems Theorems 8.4 8.4 and and 8.5. 8.5. Further, turning to giving giving an an aa posteriori posteriori error error estimate estimate on on nonuniform nonuniform grids, we consider such estimates, estimates, for for simplicity, simplicity, only only in in the the case case where where the the backward Euler method method is is applied applied to to problem problem (5.1) (5.1) with with A{t) A{t) == AA indeindependent of t. Noting that that under under our our below below conditions conditions on on AA the the operator operator bounded with with respect respect to to kk >> 0, 0, the the extended extended solusolu(/ + kA)~ l is uniformly bounded tion by the backward Euler Euler method method applied applied to to (5.1) (5.1) isis represented represented by by the the recurrence formula, with with !!„ !!„ == (/ (/ ++ knA)~l,
iovtneijk,
Y 0 = y°.
(8.60)
The next assertion gives gives an an aa posteriori posteriori error error estimate estimate for for this this method. method. Theorem 8.8. Let T = = oo, oo, let let AA ££ S(
ERROR ESTIMATES ESTIMATES 8.3. ERROR
201 201
solution problem (5.1) in in the theconsidered consideredcase caseA(t) = = A, A, itit holds, for all all solution of problem with n > 1, 1, Uk G 7 and tn G Uk with \\Yn-y(tn)\\
C ^1 ^1++log ^ < C
j=o
Proof. accepted conditions conditionswe have, for any anyUk £ 7 and andttn £ Uk, Uk, Proof. Under the accepted y(tn+1) = e-k»Ay(tn) + kn I "
f ( ) ds.
Jtn tn
equation in (8.60), (8.60), we obtain, obtain, with with En = Subtracting this equality equalityfrom fromthe equation Subtracting this > 0, 0, Yn -y(tn), for nn > En+i - e~knAEn + i? n ,
(8.61) (8.61)
residual Rn is given by where the residual
Rn =
f(f( Jtn
=
e-fc"A) yn +fcnHn/(tn+l) e'^^-^fis) (iln -- efcnHn/(tn+l)" / ^ e'^^-^fis)
ds. ds.
Jtn
observing that that ^l" ^l"1 is bounded, bounded, by a > >0, 0,itit follows follows that that Next, observing s)A -(t -s) e(t n+1 f(s) n+1 tn
Also, since the equation equation in (8.60) can be be equivalently equivalently rewritten rewritten in the the form AiXnYn - iln/CVn), iln/CVn), dYn + AiXnYn
(8.62) (8.62)
we get, using using the thefact fact that thatall the involved involved operators operatorsare arepairwise pairwisepermutable, permutable, (iln - e~k"A) r n = ( / -- (( //++ kknA) e-k«A) (UnA-1f(tn+1)
-
A~ldYn),
whence whence - e-fc"A) Y n
= ((/ + knA) e' e'k«A - I) A-xdYn.
202
CHAPTER CHAPTER 8. VARIABLE STEPSIZE STEPSIZE
APPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
Therefore, with the aid of these reasonings, the above representation for Rn is rewritten as follows Rn = ((I + KA) e~ k"A - I) A' ldYn
+ f " + 1 e - ^ + 1 - s ^ ( / ( * n + i - /(«)) ds. Jtn (8.63) Further, since the functions UJI(Z) — z~l((l — z)e z — 1), I = 1,2, are bounded in a neighbourhood of the origin, applying Lemma Lemma 5.4 gives, for all k > 0, ||u;i(-fci4)|| + ||a;2(-fci4.)|| < C. This estimate implies, for I = 1,2, \\((I + kA) e~ kA - I) u\\ < Ckl\\Alu\\
for all k > 0 and it ee Dom Dom A*. A*.
Using the last estimate next shows shows that that kn A l \\({i + k n^A)e~ -' -1) A- dYn-t\\
and, taking as well (7.11) for r\ — 1 into account, for tj+i < tn, ||((7 + kjA) e~ kiA - I) A^e-^-^+^dYjW
< <
Ck]\\AeCk]\\Ae-{tn'^
Also, by (7.11) with 77 = 0, we find, for tj+\ < tn, e
-i 33
Therefore combining the last three estimates and taking (8.63) into account account shows that \\f'(s)\\ds -i
Ck^
- i i + 1 ) - 1 | | y i + i - y^i if o < tj < ttn-i.
Now, since EQ = 0, similarly to (7.6) it follows from (8.61) that that n-l 3=0
8.3. ERROR ERROR ESTIMATES ESTIMATES
203 203
Using this this formula formula asaswell wellasas(8.64), (8.64),a asimple simple estimation yields Using estimation yields
(
n-2
\\
/_]fcj(in — fy-i-i)fy-i-i)-1 J ^ j n aaxx 1 + /_]fcj(i
n
||^j+i — —Yj\ ||^j+i
1=0
To conclude conclude the the proof, proof, it suffices suffices to to note notethat thatsince sinceknk < Ck Ckn+i, we we have, have, 1, that that for nn >> 1, n-2
n-2 n-2
,,
1=0
1=0 1=0
^^
nn
~
D
It is also also seen seen from from the theabove aboveproof proofthat thatthethe second term rightsecond term on on thethe righthand side of of the the aaposteriori posterioriestimate estimatecan canbebe replaced expression hand side replaced by by thethe expression ;
When applying applying the the ooposteriori posterioriestimate estimate Theorem to be When of of Theorem 8.8,8.8, oneone hashas to be certain of of the the behaviour behaviourofofthe thequantity quantity\\Y\\Y Y^-iH- By By (8.62) (8.62) itit follows follows certain n — Y^-iHthat
where 2l 2ln_i = AiXn-\. AiXn-\. Therefore, Therefore,assuming assumingininaddition addition that problem (5.1) where that problem (5.1) possesses an an extended extended solution solutionofoffirst firstorder orderand and that family of grids possesses that thethe family of grids is exponentially exponentiallybalanced balancedwith withbasis basis after a slight modification used is QQ >> 1, 1, after a slight modification and ttn € Uk Uk such such that that the proof proof of ofTheorem Theorem8.1, 8.1,we weobtain, obtain,forfor 15k S T and of the allall 1, n > 1,
n-l
<
Ck Ckn.1(\\Ay°\\+ (\\Ay°\\+
which shows which shows that that the theabove abovea aposteriori posteriori estimate estimate cancan be be used used for for constructconstructing adaptive adaptive algorithms. algorithms.
204
8.4
CHAPTER CHAPTER8.8. VARIABLE VARIABLESTEPSIZE STEPSIZEAPPROXIMATIONS APPROXIMATIONS
Comments Comments and andbibliographical bibliographicalremarks remarks
Section 8.1: weighted stability estimates for variSection 8.1: Apparently, Apparently,standard standardand and weighted stability estimates for variautonomousparabolic parabolicequations equations in a Banach Banach able stepsize stepsizeapproximations approximations to autonomous space setting obtained in our our work [44], [44], dealing dealingwith with the class Sj space setting are first obtained and quasi-uniform further shows thatthat the the stability quasi-uniform partitions. partitions.Palencia Palencia[127] [127] further shows stability standard sense sense is still preserved preserved for such partitions partitions when whenemploying employing in the standard methods of the classes classes SJI SJIand and5/// 5/// as well. The The case case of arbitrary arbitrary time timepartipartimethods tions is discussed discussed in our papers papers [30, [30,31, 31,36], 36], in [30, 36] 36] for methods methods of class 5/ that thethe stability es- esand in [31] for methods methods of ofthe theclasses classes5// 5//and and5///. 5///.Note Note that stability timate in [31] contains contains an additional additional factor factor log log(max (maxt g kkn/ min ( e g fc n). timate Theorem Theorem 8.1 is is shown shown first first in our our paper paper [30], [30],12 and andit it is is repeated repeated later later by Palencia further mention Palencia [128] [128] who whouses usesdifferent differenttechniques. techniques.WeWe further mention a paper paper working with families of Yan Yan [166] [166] who whoshows showssome somestability stabilityestimates estimates working with families of increasing quasi-quasiuniform 8.1). increasing quasi-quasiuniformgrids grids(see (seeSection Section 8.1). It appears, appears, however, however, using the above families above observations observationsconcerning concerninglocally locallybalanced balanced families of grids grids using quasi-quasiuniform grids, grids,that that the stability stability results results of [166] and families families of quasi-quasiuniform can easily easily be obtained obtained as well from from our earlier earlier work work [36], [36],where whereexponenexponengrids are in in use. Also, Also, it is is worth worth noting noting that that tially balanced balanced families families of grids only the the operator operatoriX^o iX^o is under under estimation estimation in [166] while while the thepaper paper[36] [36]deals deals estimation of i i ^ , 0 < < II <
proof of this result, result, which which is given given in [30] and and also reproduced reproduced in We follow follow here here the proof [36].
8.4. COMMENTS AND BIBLIOGRAPHICAL BIBLIOGRAPHICAL REMARKS REMARKS
205 205
8.5 which then is useful and and itit isis stated stated here here for for the the first first time. time. Section 8.3: An a priori priori error error analysis analysis isis carried carried out out in in Gonzalez Gonzalez &; &;OsOstermann [71] under the hypothesis hypothesis of of quasi-uniformity quasi-uniformity and and some some additional additional restrictions on the used family family of of grids. grids. In In Section Section 8.3, 8.3, when when dealing dealing with with a priori error estimates, we we consider consider more more general general time time partitions, partitions, and and itit isis seen that these results are are simply simply compiled compiled from from those those achieved achieved inin Chapter Chapter 7 and in Sections 8.1 and and 8.2. 8.2. Also, Also, we we mention mention aa paper paper of of Saito Saito [138] [138]who who presents smooth and non-smooth non-smooth error error estimates estimates in in the the homogeneous homogeneous case, case, assuming no restrictions on on the the stepsize stepsize but but acting acting under under some some conditions conditions on the operator and method method in in question. question. Certain Certain aa posteriori posteriorierror error estiestimates for parabolic equations equations have have been been studied, studied, for for example, example, inin Akrivis, Akrivis, Makridakis, and Nochetto Nochetto [8], [8], Eriksson, Eriksson, Johnson, Johnson, and and Larsson Larsson [68], [68], JohnJohnson, Nie, and Thomee [88], [88], and and Nochetto, Nochetto, Savare, Savare, and and Verdi Verdi [120], as a rule, in Hilbert space settings. The The argument argument employed employed in in the the proof proof ofof Theorem Theorem 8.8 is close to that demonstrated demonstrated in in [8]. [8]. Note Note that that for for practical practical applications applications of Theorem 8.8 we have to to control control the the size size of of the the constant constant CC ininits its assertion. assertion. In principle, it is possible, possible, with with certain certain provisos, provisos, but but itit isis easier easier done done inin the the Hilbert case.
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
Part III III Part
OTHERDISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION OTHER METHODS METHODS
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
209
In this part of the book we we examine examine other other methods methods which which are are widely widely used in practice for discretization discretization of of abstract abstract parabolic parabolic problems. problems. As As such such we consider the 0-method, 0-method, certain certain operator operator splitting splitting schemes, schemes, and and linear linear multistep methods. The methods methods selected selected here here for for analysis analysis are are united united by by the purpose of demonstrating demonstrating wide wide possibilities possibilities of of the the approach approach presented presented in Part I. Unfortunately through our our limited limited opportunities, opportunities, many many interesting interesting disdiscretization methods are left left out out of of consideration. consideration. Nevertheless, Nevertheless, we we would would like to comment briefly on on some some of of them. them. First of all we mention the the discontinuous discontinuous Galerkin Galerkin method method which which has has been examined in the context context of of parabolic parabolic equations equations in in Jamet Jamet [87], [87],EriksEriksson, Johnson, and Larsson Larsson [68], [68], Eriksson, Eriksson, Johnson, Johnson, and and Thomee Thomee [69], [69], and and Thomee [162]. The virtue of this method method is is the the suitability suitability for for dealing dealing with with variable time stepsizes and and with with solutions solutions of of low low regularity. regularity. We Weexpect expect that that the discontinuous Galerkin Galerkin method, method, developed developed exclusively exclusively by by using using Hilbert Hilbert space techniques, can be be studied studied in in the the near near future future within within Banach Banach space space settings as well. At least, least, this this possibility possibility seems seems to to be be realistic. realistic. Also, in the context of parabolic parabolic equations equations using using variable variable stepsize stepsize mulmultistep methods is important. important. Unfortunately, Unfortunately, many many stability stability results results shown shown on those lines are not directly directly adapted adapted for for applications applications connected connected with with stiff stiff problems and, in particular, particular, with with parabolic parabolic problems problems in in themselves themselves (see, (see, e.g., Crouzeix & Lisbona [63], [63], Gear Gear & & Tu Tu [70], [70],Grigorieff Grigorieff [76], [76],and and Guglielmi Guglielmi & Zennaro [79]). At the same same time time we we point point out out the the work work ofof Becker Becker [46], [46], Calvo & Grigorieff [54], and and Grigorieff Grigorieff [77], [77], where where the the time time discretizations discretizations of parabolic problems by by the the variable variable 2-step 2-step and and 3-step 3-step BDF BDF methods methods are are examined from the viewpoint viewpoint of of stability stability and and convergence. convergence. In order to concentrate on on the the most most essential essential features features of of the the methods methods considered below, we deal deal only only with with stability stability and and carry carry out out our our investigation investigation working not with the most most general general case. case. As As above, above, we we let let flk flk be be aa uniform uniform grid in the segment [0,T] [0,T] with with stepsize stepsize kk >> 0. 0. In In what what follows follows we we keep keep the notation introduced in in Part Part II II and and which which isis connected connected with with the the use useofof uniform grids.
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
Chapter 9
The ^-Method In this chapter we discuss discuss the the 0-method 0-method which which seems seems to to be be the the simplest simplest inin realization among all discretization discretization methods. methods. In In principle, principle, the the 0-method 0-method can be thought of as a particular particular case case of of the the linear linear multistep multistep method method whose whose analysis is carried out in Chapter Chapter 11. 11. In In the the autonomous autonomous case case A(t) A(t) == A, A, the ^-method can be examined examined within within the the study study of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods expounded in Part II. However, However, in in the the case case with with aa constant constant operator operator there there are some interesting features features of of the the ^-method ^-method which which are are studied studied inin the the litliterature, as a rule, within Hilbert Hilbert space space settings settings (see, (see, e.g., e.g., Samarskii Samarskii [139] [139]1). Our main aim in the present present chapter chapter isis to to use use similar similar developments developments inin the the Banach case. Throughout the chapter the the operator operator A(t) A(t) isis assumed assumed to to be be independent independent of t. At the same time itit is is always always assumed assumed that that the the operator operator inin question question depends on a (scalar or vector) vector) parameter parameter hh €€ !H. !H. So So we we write write A^ A^ instead instead of A{t). Since we have as as an an aim aim certain certain applications, applications, we we assume assume Ah Ah toto be be a bounded operator on X X for for any any fixed fixed hh ££"K. "K. The (9-method is usually specified specified by by using using the the following following discrete discrete probprob2 lem, with 6 = 9(k, h) E R, R, dYn + Ah({l - 6)Y n + 0Y n+1) = (l-e)f{t n)+0f(tn+1)
for i n e
fife,
Y Q = Viyo.
(9.1)
The term (1 - 6)f(t n) + df{t n+x) can be replaced by /((I /((I -- 6)t 6)tn + 6tn+i) or in some other way as well. well. For For such such modifications modifications our our analysis analysis below below 1
called the the weighted weighted difference difference scheme. scheme. In [139] this method is called we introduce introduce an an operator operator 9t 9t 66 B(X) B(X) to to correct correct the the initial initial Unlike the general use, we 9^ may may depend depend on on kk and and hh as as well. well. condition. The operator 9^ 2
211
212
CHAPTER CHAPTER 9. THE 6-METHOD
changes in minor details, so subsequently we look only at problem (9.1). It is seen from (9.1) that the 0-method may be thought of as a 2-stage RK method3 whose Butcher array is 0 0 0 1 1- 9 9 1 —9 9
Clearly, in the case where 9 does not depend on k and h, this method is covered by the theory developed in Part II. At the same time it is well known (see, e.g., Samarskii [139]) that the order of accuracy for the 9method is raised at the expense of a suitable choice of 9 as a function of k and h. Therefore we must admit that 9 depends on k and h, which is in the case below.
9.1
Stability results
In the considerations below we require require that that at least Q > 9 = 9(k, h) > 0 and Ah G S(
It may be thought of as a 1-stage RK method if the term (1 — 6)f(tn) + Of(tn+\) in (9.1) is replaced by f(tn+i). 4 We recall that the operator Ah is bounded.
9.1. STABILITY RESULTS RESULTS
213
Figure 9.1: Z(ip,r) F o r a11
h G "K and A
> R,
and S2{
all /i G IK and A g IntZ(
We are now in a position position to to state state our our results results on on stability stability for for the the 0-method. 0-method. Theorem 9.1. Suppose Suppose that that 66 >> 00 -- 0(k,h) 0(k,h) >> 1/2 1/2 and and AAh £ S(
(9.3)
If cr > 0 in addition, the above above holds holds for for TT == 00 == oo oo and and one one can can then then take take K = oo. Proof. For the sake of simplicity simplicity we we show show the the claim claim in in the the particular particular case case a > 0 only. In the general general case case aa G G R, R, the the below below argument argument isis slightly slightly modified with the aid of of reasonings reasonings similar similar to to those those used used in in Part Part II. II. 5 Having therefore assumed assumed that that aa > > 0, 0, we we recall recall that that for for all all kk >> 00 and and h G "K, the operator (I + + k9Ah)~ k9Ah)~l is denned and bounded bounded on on 3£. 3£. Moreover, Moreover, it obviously holds (9.4) ^WKC. (9.4) 5
Cf., e.g., the proof of Theorem Theorem 6.1 6.1
214
CHAPTER CHAPTER 9. 9. THE THE 9-METHOD 9-METHOD
Further, using the identity identity (Xl-kVl)-1
=
(XI - kA h(I + kOAh)- 1)
e
'
X
A
x x
~
kAh
leads us to the estimate, estimate, for for all all kk > > 00 and and hh G GOi, Oi,
IKAJ-fcSl)-1!! < | A - 0 - x
A
[—2
. (9.5)
i-ex
Clearly, the mapping a(—z) a(—z) = = z(l z(l ++ 9z) 9z) l takes the sector E v to the set Therefore, since A h G S(ip,a) and A/(1 - 6X) Z(v,0~l). 6X) ££ IntS^, IntS^, for for A A ££ that for for all all kk > > 00 and and A Agg Int Int Z(y>, Z(y>,6*" 6*"1), Int Z(
fl- 1!"1
which further implies, since since 66 >> 1/2, 1/2, that that for for all all kk >> 00 and and AA^^ Int IntZ(y, Z(y,2), 2), !! < C (|A|-X + |A - 2I" 1 ).
1
(9.6)
Observe that there exists exists aa set set TT of of A2-configuration, A2-configuration, with with singular singular points points Ci = 0 and (2 = 2, such such that that Z(ip,2) Z(ip,2) CC T. T. The The desired desired result result thus thus follows follows from Theorem 2.17 applied applied with with ££ — —00 to to problem problem (1.1), (1.1), (9.2), (9.2), taking taking as as well the estimates (9-4) (9-4) and and (9.6) (9.6) into into account. account. T h e o r e m 9.2. Suppose Suppose that that 66 >> 66 — — 6(k,h) 6(k,h) >> OQ and Ah G S(ip,a) for all k > 0 and h G "K, with with some some © © >> 990 > 1/2, (p G (0,TT/2), and cr G R. Lei ako (6.48) hold. Then, ifT< oo, i/ie solution solution YYn of (9.1) satisfies the stability estimate, with some some K K > > 00 sufficiently sufficiently small, small, with with any any fixed fixed [1Q > 0 sufficiently large, and with with any any fixed fixed ££ >> 0, 0, /or /or aH aH AA;;GG (O,JFST]; h £"K, and tn G fifc, +
i=0
)
(9-7) /
If o~ > 0 in addition, the above above holds holds for for TT == G G == 00 00 provided provided that that /^o /^o== 0,0, and one can then take K K == 00. 00. The proof is similar to that that of of Theorem Theorem 9.1, 9.1, applying applying as as well well Theorem Theorem 2.17 and using the fact that that the the pair pair (|](2l (|](2l ++ //o-O^ //o-O^' ' II; II;2l) 2l) ii s Aj(£)-concordant (Ai(£)-concordant if cr >> 00 and and /uo /uo == 0). 0). Now we show that the the above above results results can can be be improved improved ifif we we suppose suppose that Ah G S\(ip,R\tl>(-)) S\(ip,R\tl>(-)) or or Ah Ah G G S2( S2(lp,R','4>(-)), instead of the the condition condition Ah G S(tp, a) previously previously used. used.
9.1. STABILITY RESULTS RESULTS 9.1. STABILITY
215 215
Theorem 9.3. Suppose Suppose that thatAh Ah €€ S2(
(k^h))-1 (k^h))-
0, >> 0,
(9.8) (9.8)
with some (p (p€€ (0,TT/2), (0,TT/2), R R > > 0, 0, and and0 0> >0 0and and with some some positive-valued positive-valued with some with function ip(h). ip(h). Also, Also,let let (6.48) (6.48) hold. hold. Then, Then, if if TT << 00, 00,the thesolution solution Y Yn function of (9.1) (9.1) satisfies satisfies the the stability stability estimate estimate(9.3) (9.3) under under the the additional additional condition condition < K, K, with with K K >> 00sufficiently sufficiently small. small.If If R R ==00ininaddition, addition, then thenthe the above above k< holds for for TT — —© © == 00 00and andone onecan can take K K ==00. 00. holds take Proof. We Weshow show the the result result for for RR ==00only, only, remarking remarkingthat thatthe the below below proof proofis is Proof. slightly modified modifiedin in the thegeneral general case caseR R> >00(cf. (cf.the theremark remark at at the thebeginning beginning slightly the proof proof of of Theorem Theorem9.1). 9.1). of the Havingtherefore thereforeassumed assumed that R == 0, 0,we weobserve observethat thatby by spectral spectral theory theory Having that R (see, e.g, e.g, Hille Hille & & Phillips Phillips [84]) [84])the thespectrum spectrumof of the theoperator operatorfc2l fc2lbelongs belongs to (see, to the set Int Int£.(?, £.(?,2) 2) U U{0} {0}UU{2}. {2}. Next Nextwe we introduce introducethe the operators operators the set l = iPih^Ah iPih^Ah == (k^(h))(k^(h))kAh Ah = kA
and and Bh = =
Ah(I-A (I-Ah)-\ )-\ A
Our further argument argumentwill will be based based on on making making use useof ofthe therepresentation representation Our further be Bh)~x (A/ - B (A/
- 11
--
(I(I- - AA (\I -- (A (A++1)A 1)A h) (\I h ^ ))
ll
(9.9) (9.9)
By the the accepted acceptedconditions, conditions, the spectrum spectrumof of the theoperator operator A^ A^ belongs belongsto to the the By the set Z Z= = Int IntZ(ip, Z(ip, {0} U {1} and, all set 1)1)UU {0} U {1} and, for for all A gA Z,g Z,
which in in particular particular implies implies which
Uh\\ Uh\\< c. It thus thus follows followsfrom from(9.9), (9.9), using using as as well well the the last last two twoestimates, estimates,that thatwhenever whenever
||(A/ ||(A/ - B Bh)-'\\ )-'\\ < < C\\ C\\ ++l\l\-l\\ (j^I (j^I
1 -- I,)" I,)" !] < <
216
CHAPTER 9. THE 6-METHOD
Since the conditions A/(A + 1) ^ lntZ(ip, 1) and A £ IntE^ are equivalent, it follows from the last estimate that for all A ^ IntE^, \\(\I-Bh)'l\\
In other words, we have Bh E S(tp, 0) and, thus, k^Bh E S(ip, 0). With this fact in mind, it remains to apply Theorem 9.1 with k~lBh in place Ah and + (^(/i))"1)^)"1 with 9 + (kipih))-1 in place of 6 since fc2l = Bh(l+(6 l and 9 + (kiP(h))~ > \. D Theorem 9.4. Let Ah E Si(?, R;ip(-)) for all h E"Kand let k > 0 and h E"Kbe subject to condition (9.8), with some (p E (0, TT/2), R > 0, and G > 0 and with some positive-valued function tp(h). Let also the operator 9\ be given by + 9kAh)-x.
Then, if T < oo and £ 6 [0,1], the solution Yn of (9.1) satisfies the stability estimate (9.7) under the additional condition k < K, with K > 0 sufficiently small. If R — 0 and HQ = 0 in addition, then the above holds forT — © = oo and one can take K = oo.
Proof. The operator / — |A;2l can be represented as follows I-l-m={I+(6-
l
-)kAh)
(I + OkAh)'1.
(9.10)
£ IntZ(
(9.11)
Note that one can take K = 0 = oo if R — 0. It now follows from (9.10) and (9.11) that 6 \\(I + 6kAh
l
\\
(9.12)
It is seen in the proof of Theorem 9.3 that the operator 21 satisfies the A|condition, in particular, the A2-condition if R = 0, with the singular points 6
By (9.10) and (9.11) the operator (/ - \k%)~1 is bounded on X for any fixed he'K since the operator Ah has this property.
9.2. COMMENTS AND AND BIBLIOGRAPHICAL BIBLIOGRAPHICAL
REMARKS REMARKS
217 217
Ci = 0 and ^2 = 2. Taking Taking then then (9.12) (9.12) into into account, account, noting noting that that the the operator operator / - ^fc2t takes the form form (1.39) (1.39) with with JJ == 2, 2, £2 £2 == 2, 2, 777== 1,1, and and 21 21inin place placeofof £ n , and using the representation representation (1.4) (1.4) with with both both sides sides multiplied multiplied from from the the left by (21 + /io-0^ (where (where fio fio — — 00 ifif RR == 0), 0), the the claim claim follows follows by by applying applying Theorem 2.3 together with with Remark Remark 2.2. 2.2.
9.2
Comments and bibliographical bibliographical remarks remarks
Section 9.1: The above above Theorem Theorem 9.3 9.3 actually actually arises arises from from our our work work [23, [23,24] 24] where a slightly different different terminology terminology isis used. used. Also, Also, itit follows follows from from [23, [23,24] 24] that the hypotheses S\(ip, S\(ip, R;ip(-)) R;ip(-)) and and S2{
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
Chapter 10
Methods with Splitting Splitting Operator Here we consider approximations to problem (5.1), which employ employ certain certain constructions with splitting splitting operator. operator. In fact, in the general case where the operator in question is time-dependent, we examine only one operator discretization, which which is acsplitting method based on the backward Euler discretization, curate to the first order. However, completing completing this this chapter, chapter, in the special case A(t) = A and f(t) = 0, 0, we we discuss splitting constructions constructions which which may may lead to second order solvers. Note Note that that our below assertions are obtained on the basis of the general theory of operator splitting methods methods developed developed in Chapter 3. This is possible only under the condition T < oo which is therefore assumed throughout. throughout. In this chapter the main distinctive feature is that the operator A(t) in (5.1) is split by A(t) = Ai(t) + A 2(t) for t € [0,T], where Aj(t), j = 1,2, are closed linear operators operators acting acting in 3£, for which DomA,-(t) 2 Domi(i) for any t £ [0,T]. So, given a uniform grid flk m the interval [0,T], we consider the following splitting version of the backward Euler method method1 i
= (/ + feA1(tn+1))-1yn,
Yn+l
kA2(tn+1))-1f(tn+l)
for t n £ nk,
Yo = y°. x
In this chapter we only deal with the situation when 9\ = I.
219
220
CHAPTER 10. 10. METHODS METHODS WITH WITH SPLITTING SPLITTING OPERATOR OPERATOR
Eliminating Yn+i, we rewrite this discrete problem problem as a single step method, that is, Yn+i_ = (I + kA2(tn+l))-1(I Yo
+ kA1(tn+1))-1Yn
+k(I + kA2(tn+1))-1f(tn+i) = y°.
for t n G Qk, (10.1) (10.1)
Now we intend to apply the theory of Chapter 3 in order to examine the question of stability of problem (10.1). One of the most important points is then to show that the conditions (3.2) and (3.3) can be verified.2 In our subsequent consideration we use the following hypotheses which which are stated for some /xi > 0 and K G [0,1). coml[/t]: For any j = 1,2 and t G G [0,T] [0,T]the the operator Aj(t) has dense domain3 and it holds
Qj(t) := (A3_j(t) + Mi/)" 1 Dom A,-(t) C Dom Aj(t). Furthermore, for all j = 1, 2, t G [0,T], u G Qj(t), and \ € Dom
(10.2) A^^t),
+ tuiyxUxWl^KMt) + fill) fill) u
HI1"". com2[«;]: For any j = 1,2 and t G G[0,T] [0,T]the the operator Aj(t) has dense domain and satisfies (10.2) as well as Q*{t) := (A^it) + iiiIT1 Dom^(t) C DomA;(t). DomA;(t).
Furthermore, for all j = 1, 2, t G [0,T], u G Qj(t), and x G Q*(t),
Lemma 10.1. Suppose Ai(t),A2(t) G S((p,a) and hypothesis coralj/t] is satisfied, for some ip G (0,7r/2), a G R, and K; G [0,1). Then condition (3.2) is fulfilled with %Ljtn = Aj(£n+i) (-f + ^^(^n+i))" 1 ; J = 1,2. // in addition hypothesis com2[ft;] is satisfied, then (3.3) holds with the same 2lj;n2
(10.1) takes takes the form (1.1), (3.1). It is obvious that problem (10.1) This fact implies in particular that each of the operators Aj(t), j = 1,2, has an adjoint. 3
221
Proof. We show the claim in the the case case where where Aj(t) Aj(t) == Aj, Aj, jj == 1,2, 1,2, are are inindependent of t for the reason reason that, that, on on the the one one hand, hand, the the arguments arguments do do not not alter4 and, on the other hand, notation notation becomes becomes shorter shorter in in the the autonomous autonomous case. In particular, we write 2lj 2lj and and Qj Qj instead instead of of 2l 2lj;n and Qj(t), respectively.5 Next observe that, by Lemma Lemma 5.3, 5.3, the the operators operators 2tj, 2tj, jj — —1,2, 1,2, are are defined defined and bounded on X for any any fixed fixed kk G G (0,K), with K > 0 sufficiently small. small. Moreover, by Theorem 6.2 6.2 they they both both satisfy satisfy the the Af-condition. Af-condition. hypothesis comljfo] comljfo] we we Denoting now Qj = (I + + kAj)~x, j = 1,2, by hypothesis have Q2U G Qi for any u G Domii. Domii. Then, Then, for for all all uu €€ DomAi DomAi and and xx GGX*, X*, (x,Com (A l\g2)u)
- Q2)U) = ((/ - Q*2)X,A1Q2U)-(Q*2X,AI(I = k(A 2Qlx, AIQ2U) - k(g*2x, A1A2Q2U),
thus, with any /ii > 0, (X, {Ai + ii\I)Q2u)
= (x, (x, Q-i {Ai + ml) u) +k{A2g*2x, AIQ2U) - k(g 2x,AiA2g2u) (10.3) ) + V.
By hypothesis c o m l ^ ] we we further further obtain, obtain, for for all all uu G GDomAi DomAi and and xx GG 3£*, 3£*,
+Ck\\(A2 + mi)*Q 2x\\*\\(M + mi) Q2u\\K\\u\\1-K + mi)Q2u\\ + ll^i ^ ll^i ++ mi) mi) Clearly since A\ G S(ip,a), S(ip,a), the the last last estimate estimate isis in in force force with with any any fifi2 > 0 sufficiently large in place of of m m while while no no constant constant CC depends dependson on fj,2. Therefore we get instead <
C
{k1-^
{{(A! +/x 2 I)- 1 || 1 - K ) \\(Al + ^I) Q2U
< c {k 1-* + vK2~l) IK^i + Mi) e*A Applying this inequality in in an an estimation estimation on on the the basis basis of of (10.3), (10.3),we wefind find that that for all k G (0, K] and u G G X, X, u\\ < C\\(Ax + Ml) u\\ 4
(10.4)
In fact, all the estimates estimates retain retain their their shapes, shapes, becoming becoming uniform uniform with with respect respect toto t tn. We recall that Q(t) is specified specified by by (10.2). (10.2).
5
222
CHAPTER 10. 10. METHODS METHODS WITH WITH SPLITTING SPLITTING
OPERATOR OPERATOR
if K > 0 is sufficiently small small and and /i/i 2 > 0 is sufficiently large. large. Next, Next, with with the the aid of the following identity, identity, for for all all uu G GXX and and xx SS X*, X*,
= fc"1 (x, Qi(I - Q2) u) = (X, 420201^) + M2<X» M2<X»
+ employing hypothesis cc oo rr aall[[44 and and taking taking (10.4) (10.4) into into account account leads, leads, as as above, to the following estimate estimate 11(42 + toiy&QiXlU < C\\(A C\\(A2 + V2l)*Q2X\U,
(10-5) (10-5)
for all all xx G G X*. X*. Furthermore, Furthermore, itit isis with any fixed fi 2 > 0 sufficiently large, for not hard to see that for for all all uu G GXX and and xxG GX X**,, (X, Com (2lx|2l 2) u) = k~2(X, Com ((/ 2
= k~ (x,Com
6l),
(I - g 2)) u)
(QI\Q2)U)
so that we find, with the the aid aid of of hypothesis hypothesis COIII1[K] and of the above arguargument, with any fixed [i [i2 > 0 sufficiently large, for for all all kk €€ (0, (0, K], K], uu G GX, X, and and
|(x,Com (2l!|2l 2 ) U )| + C\\(A 2 + /x 2/)*020iXll*ll(^i + Ml) Q2Qiu\\ Q2Qiu\\K\\u\\1-K.
(10.6)
Therefore combining (10.4), (10.4), (10.5), (10.5), and and (10.6) (10.6) gives gives
)| < C||(A2 + M 2/r^x||^||xll^ +C\\(A2 + H2iy&x\\4{Ai
+ M2/) M2/)Qiu\\ Qiu\\K
So since both 2li and 2I2 2I2 satisfy satisfy the the Af-condition, Af-condition, (3.2) (3.2) with with jj == 22 follows follows from the last estimate in in view view of of Lemma Lemma 1.5, 1.5, and and (3.2) (3.2) with with jj — —11isis estabestablished by symmetry. If in in addition addition hypothesis hypothesis com2[«;] com2[«;] isis satisfied, satisfied, itit can can be be D shown in a similar way that that (3.3) (3.3) holds holds with with 2lj 2lj substituted substituted for for 2l 2l j;n . Now we state a stability stability result result for for the the splitting splitting method method (10.1). (10.1).
223
seminorms \\ jx jx;* and \ \^t Theorem 10.1. Suppose Suppose A\(t), A2(t) G S(tp,o), seminorms form (7i|y,a)-concordant (7i|y,a)-concordant pairs pairs with with A\{t) A\{t) and and A2{t), A2{t), respectively, respectively, each eachofof Aj(t) satisfies the respective respective hypothesis hypothesis hol®[i9;| hol®[i9;| \j-t], \j-t], jj — — 1,2, 1,2, and and the the hypotheses coml[/t] and and COITI2[K] are fulfilled, for some tp tp G G (0,TT/2), a G M, Then, ifif K K > > 00 isis sufficiently sufficiently small, small, for for the the d G (0,1], and 71,« € [0,1). Then, solution Y n of problem (10.1), we we have, have, with with any any fixed fixed /xo /xo >> 00 sufficiently sufficiently large and with any fixed fixed ££ G G [0,1), [0,1), for for all all kk G G(0, (0,K] K] and and ttn G Clk, that
||(2ln + Mo/fell + J ] ||(2lj;ri + X > i l l ,
(10.7)
where the operators Wj^n, Wj^n, jj == 1,2, 1,2, are are defined defined as as above above and and 2l 2ln is specified by (3.1). In the case where A\(t) A\(t) and and A^{t) A^{t) do do not not depend depend on on t,t, the the above above holds for any fixed £ G G [0,1] [0,1] while while the the first first term term on on the the left-hand left-hand side side ofof (10.7) is estimated as stated stated for for any any fixed fixed ££ >> 0, 0, even even ifif we we do do not not assume assume hypothesis com2[«;]. Proof. We consider the general general case case where where Aj(i), j — 1,2, generally depend depend on t. Since each of the the operators operators 2l 2lJ;n, j — 1,2, satisfies the the A^-condition A^-condition because of Theorem 6.2, 6.2, using using the the fact fact that that each each of of the the operators operators Aj(t), j = 1,2, satisfies the respective respective hypothesis hypothesis hol®[i?; hol®[i?; || \j-tt] and applying Theorem 6.9, it follows that the Holder-continuity Holder-continuity type type condition condition (3.40) (3.40) holds. holds. Since Since uniformly bounded bounded with with the operator (/ + kA2(t))~ kA2(t))~1 is, by Lemma 5.3, uniformly respect to k and t, it thus thus remains remains to to apply apply Theorem Theorem 3.4 3.4 with with 55j ;n = 0, j — 1,2, taking Lemma 10.1 10.1 into into account. account. As concerns the more precise precise wording wording in in the the particular particular case case where where Aj Aj (t), (t), j = 1,2, are both independent independent of of t,t, the the claim claim follows follows by by Theorem Theorem 3.3, 3.3, by by using Lemma 10.1 again. again. Note that Theorem 10.1 10.1 remains remains valid valid for for splitting splitting constructions constructions genergenerated by arbitrary RK methods methods of of type type Vj(ip), Vj(ip), but but ifif the the operators operators -Ai(t) -Ai(t) and and A2(t) are not permutable, permutable, approximations approximations of of that that type type would would be be only only first first order and of little practical practical use. use. At At the the same same time, time, using using the the fact fact that that the the stability function of the the backward backward Euler Euler method method vanishes vanishes atat 00 00 allows allows us us easily to obtain (10.7) with with Aj{t Aj{tn+\) substituted for 2lj ;n . Now, in the particular case case where where A(t) A(t) == AA and and f(t) f(t) == 0,0, we we examine examine an operator splitting method method which which leads leads to to second second order order solvers. solvers. In In order order to construct such a method, method, let let the the operator operator AA be be decomposed decomposed as as above, above,
224 224
CHAPTER CHAPTER 10.10. METHODS METHODS WITH WITH SPLITTING SPLITTING OPERATOR OPERATOR
with Aj(t) with Aj(t) ==Aj, Aj,j j= =1, 2, 1, 2, and and let let r(z)r(z) be the bestability stability the function functionof of some someRK RK method. We method. Weconsider considerthe thefollowing followingprocedure procedure ^
^^
^^
n n
for fortnt G G
titik,
YY0 = = y°. y°. (10.8) (10.8)
The The next nextresult resultshows shows the the stability stabilityof of the thesplitting splittingmethod method(10.8). (10.8).
10.2.Let LetA\(t),A2(t) A\(t),A2(t) 66 S(
£ ee[[oo,,i i]]. . Proof. By Proof. By virtue virtue of of Theorem Theorem6.2 6.2 each each of of the theoperators operators2li,2l2 2li,2l2satisfies satisfies the the Aj-condition. Therefore Aj-condition. Therefore the the claim claim will willfollow followby by Theorem Theorem 3.3 3.3 ifif we wehave have proved provedthat thatthe thehypotheses hypothesescoml[/c] coml[/c] and andcom2[«;] com2[«;]imply implythe theconditions conditions(3.2) (3.2) and (3.3), and (3.3),respectively, respectively, with with 2lj 2lj;n = = 2lj, 2lj,j j — —1,2. 1,2. The Thelast last fact fact is is however however in aa manner manner similar similarto to that that used usedin in the theproof proof of of Lemma Lemma10.1. 10.1. established establishedin In fact, In fact, by by the thecondition conditiondeg[p] deg[p]= = —1, —1, where, where,as as above, above,p(z) p(z) — —z~ z~1a(z), a(z), we we have, with have, with some someb\ b\q € C, C, II==1 ,,......, ,lo, lo,q q= = 11,,......, ,qi, qi,
1=1 9=1 1=1 9=1
where zi, where zi, II==1 ,,......, ,lo, lo,are arethe thepoles poles of of p(—z) p(—z) and andqi qidenotes denotesthe the multiplicity multiplicity of a pole pole zi. zi. By Bythe theAj((^)-stability Aj((^)-stability it it follows followsthat thatz\ z\ ££ S^,, S^,,and and the the operators operators x —1,2, 1,2,/ /= =l,...,lj, l,...,lj, are aredefined defined and and bounded bounded on on XX for for (kAj (kAj — —z;J)~ z;J)~, j — k€ € (0, (0,K] K] and andt tGG[0, [0,T], T],with withsome some K K> >00sufficiently sufficientlysmall. small.Using Using therefore therefore to the therepresentation representation (10.9) (10.9) leads leadsto
p(-kAj) == itt p(-kAj) itt Now, with Now, withthe the aid aidofofthis this expansion expansionand andof ofpermutation permutationtechniques techniques similar similar to those those employed employedin in the theproof proof of of Lemma Lemma 10.1, 10.1,it it is is readily readily seen seenthat thatthis this the thenewly newly defined defined2lj, 2lj,jj ==1,1,2.2. lemma lemma remains remainsvalid valid with with
225
we remark remark that that some some related related results resultsare arepresented presentedininOsOsIn conclusion, we under essentially essentially stronger stronger conditions conditionson onthe thesplitting splittingcompocompotermann [122] under nents.
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
Chapter 11
Linear Multistep Methods Methods In this chapter we consider one more field for application of the theory developed in Part I. More precisely, here we examine examine linear linear multistep multistep methods methods applied to the Cauchy problem (5.1). We restrict ourselves to dealing with such methods for the sake of simplicity and for the reason that they are most important for practice. In principle, we could study even general multistep multistep methods, which would lead, lead, however, however, to a more involved analysis. It is remarkable that the investigation of linear multistep methods, methods, in comparison with the one of Runge-Kutta methods, possesses possesses its own distinctive features. Also, it is worth noting that the stability characteristics of the most popular linear multistep methods, methods, among among those those considered considered below, below, are well adapted for their application to parabolic problems.
11.1 Linear multistep multistep discretization discretization Let there be given numbers m € N and aj,bj G C, j = 0, ...,m. Let further f^ = {t n : tn = nk for n — 0 , 1 , . . . , N} be a uniform grid in the segment [0,T], with stepsize k,1 and let ft^ — {t n : tn = nk for n = 0 , 1 , . . . , N - m + 1} and fij:m) = {tn : tn = nk for n = 0,1,...
,N - m).
Now we associate to problem (5.1) the following discrete problem problem -l ~ f{tn+m-l)))
= 0 for t n G
1=0
Yo = y°, Y x = y\ ..., F m _i = ym-\ :
(11.1)
As above, k and N are connected by T = Nk, with the standard proviso in the case T = oo. 227
228
CHAPTER 11. 11. LINEAR LINEAR MULTISTEP MULTISTEP METHODS METHODS CHAPTER
assume that that the the initial initial with some y°,y 1,... ,ym~l £ X. Hereinafter we assume 1 m 1 (11.1) is is just just the the linear linear multistep multistep values y°, y ,..., y ~ are given. Problem (11.1) method applied formally to to (5.1). (5.1). However However this this form form of of writing writing isistypical typicalfor for Unfortunately, in in our our case case the the fact fact that that the the domain domain application to ODEs. Unfortunately, generally coincide coincide with with XX implies implies that that some some terms terms ofof the the of A(t) does not generally undefined. We We therefore therefore have have form A(t n+m-{) y(tn+m-i) in (11.1) may be undefined. to specify what we mean by by aa solution solution of of problem problem (11.1). (11.1). First of all note that, as above, above, our our main main assumption assumption in in this this chapter chapter isis that A(t) £ S(ip, a) with some some tp tp££ (0,7r/2) (0,7r/2) and and aa ££ M. M. IfIf inin addition addition to tothis this condition we assume as well well the the following following restriction restriction2 aobo 7^ 0 and | arg(ao/6o)| < TT - ip,
(H-2) (H-2)
kboA(t))~x is sufficiently small, small,3 the operator (aol + kboA(t))~ then, with K > 0 sufficiently bounded on X for k € (0, (0,K] K] and and tt ££ [0, [0,T] T] and, and, ifif the the entry entry inin (11.1) (11.1) makes makes sense, we proceed instead instead from from the the following following recursion recursion procedure procedure m
Yn+m = - (aol + kboA^n+m))' kboA^n+m))'1 Y](a;I + kbiA(t n+m^i)) Yn+m_i + k(aol + kbaA{tn+m))-lY,hf{tn+m-i)
for
t n £ f^m),
(11.3)
1=0
in (11.1). (11.1). Before Before taking taking further further with YQ, Y\,..., Ym-\ specified the same as in distinguish between between the the cases cases where where A(t) A(t) does does not not steps we now have to distinguish does depend depend on on t.t. depend and where it does where A{t) A{t) == AA isis independent independent of of t,t,4 observe that In the particular case where under the above assumptions assumptions the the operators operators (ail (ail ++ kbiA) kbiA)(aol (aol ++ kboA)' kboA)'1, I — 1,... ,m, are defined defined and and bounded bounded on on X. X. We We therefore therefore come come toto the the following definition. autonomous case, the discrete function Y n, tn £ Clk, Definition 11.1. In the autonomous recursion as defined by the recursion
1=1
m
+ k(aol + kboA)' 1 ^ bif(t n+m-i) 1=0 2
Which is present in all below below assertions assertions With K = oo if a > 0 4 necessarily dense dense But Dom A is not necessarily 3
for t n £
11.1. LINEAR MULTISTEP MULTISTEPDISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION 11.1. LINEAR
229 229
with YQ,Y\, ... ... ,Y ,Ym-i specified specifiedjust just the the same same as in in (11.1), (11.1), is called called the the CCwith YQ,Y\, extended solution solution of the the discrete discrete problem problem (11.1) (11.1)(or (or of of (11.3)). (11.3)). extended the general general case, case, we assume assume in addition addition that that CMJdora CMJdoraA(t)) A(t)) == XX for for In the G [0,T] [0,T] and andthat that the the operator operator (XI (XI — A(i))~ A(i))~1 A(s) A(s) extends extends to aa linear linear any t G the whole whole X for for any anyfixed fixed A fifi (Int (IntEEv U {0}) {0}) ++ aa and and bounded operatoron the bounded operator G [0,T]. [0,T].5 However, However, unlike unlikePart PartII, we we do do not not require require that that Dora DoraA(t) A(t) is is t,s G necessarily independent independentof t.t. necessarily Definition 11.2. 11.2. In In the thenon-autonomous non-autonomous case, case,under underthe the accepted accepted restricrestricDefinition the F-extended F-extended solution solutionYn, tn G fife of problem problem (11.1) (11.1) (or (or of of (11.3)) (11.3)) tions, tions, the the recursion recursion defined by the is defined -i)) Yn+m n+m-i
1=1 1=1
+ k(a k(aol + kboA(t kboA(tn+m n+m))
bif(tn+m 22 ^^ bif(t n+m-i)
for ttn G Cl Clk , for
1=0
with YQ,Y\, YQ,Y\, with
i^m-i specified specifiedjust just the the same same as as in in (11.1). (11.1). i^m-i
employ again againthe the product product space space3£(m) which which is defined defined In what what follows followswe employ same as in in Section Section 5.3, 5.3, with with m in in place place of v. v. As As above, above, the the norm norm in the same 3*(m) i s given given by | | O ii,,......,,uum ) r | | ( m ) = max max
IIUJH IIUJH
for for any any ( n j ,,...... ,um)T G G X X{m).
The symbol symbol || ||( ||(m) is is used used to denote denote as well well the the induced induced operator operatornorm normin m m Next, by X^* X^* we wedenote denote the the dual dual space space for X^ X^ \ For For our our subsequent subsequent £( ). Next, needs recall recall that that any any member member of X^* X^* is, is, inin fact, fact, a vector vector of the the form form needs T m T m Xm) with with Xj Xj ££ X*, X*,jj — —11, .,....,.m ,m Thenorm norm in in £( £( )* )* is is given given by by (Xi> ..Xm) . .The
3=1
m and the the duality duality pairing pairingbetween between3f(3f( and j£( j£(m) is expressed expressed as follows follows )* and
.
Xm)TT, (Ul,..., (Ul,..., U Umm)TT)(mm) == 55 33((XXJJ, ,««JJ) ). . Xm)
observed if, for for instance, instance, Domv4*(t) Domv4*(t)is independent independent of t.t. last fact fact is observed The last
(11.4) (11.4)
CHAPTER 11. LINEAR MULTISTEP MULTISTEP METHODS METHODS
230
Also, by I we denote the identity operator both in X^ and in X^*. Now we show that if Yn is the F-extended or C-extended solution of problem (11.3), the vector * n — \*m
(11.5)
i
solves, in fact, a discrete problem of the form (1.1) in the space that end, we put
n
\ To (11.6)
j-
= n
),
Q>m—j-L
J — 0 , . . . , 771,
and
F n = (0,..., 0, Fnf,
(n-7)
where Fn = B^)n J^ &j/(*n+m-01=0
by
Also, we introduce the operator 2ln : X^ I
I
-JO O
0
I
V Bm.nBo-n
0 0
-I
Bm.nBi-n
(11.8)
+ Bm.nBm-\-n
/
if J4(£) generally depends on i, and by 0 _/
/
2ln = 21 = A; - l
0
\ am(-kA)
0 0
a m-i(-kA)
) (11.9) with aj(z) = (aj — bjz)/{a,Q — boz), j = 1,..., m, if A(t) = A is independent of t. It is then easily seen under the accepted conditions 6 that if Yn is the ^-extended or C-extended solution of (11.3), the vector Yn solves the problem Y o = y°,
or, what is actually the same, Yo — y , 6
Which are different in the autonomous and non-autonomous cases
(11.10)
11.1. LINEAR MULTISTEP MULTISTEP DISCRETIZATION DISCRETIZATION
231 231
which takes the form (l.l). (l.l). 7 We therefore attempt attempt to to apply apply the the general general results of Part I. Throughout this chapter chapter itit is is assumed, assumed, without without explicit explicit mention mention on on each each occasion, that it holds k = 1, 1=0
(11-11) (11-11)
1=0 1=0
since this condition is satisfied satisfied by by all all methods methods being being of of practical practical value. value. For our below needs we we now now give give aa series series of of further further definitions. definitions. D e f i n i t i o n 1 1 . 3 . With With CCJ(Z), j = l,...,m, matrix /I
V am(z)
- 1
just the the same same as as above, above, the the
00
a m-i(z)
00
\\
l + ai(z) J
is called the amplification amplification matrix matrix of of the the linear linear multistep multistep method. Definition 11.4. The linear linear multistep multistep method method isis called called of of class class M/ M/ if,if, with with equation A(z) the amplification matrix matrix of of the the method, all the roots of the equation det(Ai - A(Q)) = 0,
(11.12) (11.12)
except the single simple root root Aj(O) Aj(O) == 0, 0, and and all all the the roots roots of of the the equation equation det(Ai - .A(oo)) = 0
(11.13) (11.13)
lie in the open disk I n t PP((ll;; I). I). 8 Definition 11.5. The linear linear multistep multistep method method isis called calledo/type o/type LM(ip) LM(ip)d for some if G (0, TT/2) if
(i) condition (11.2) holds; holds; and (ii) all the roots of the equation equation (solved (solved for for \)\)
det(Ai-.A(-z)) = 0
(11.14) (11.14)
belong to the closed disk disk V(l; V(l; 1) 1) whenever whenever ||argz| argz| << (p. (p. 7
In the particular case Q n = SRn = / This definition is easily modified modified in in order order to to be be applied applied to to the the general general multistep multistepmethmethods. That is why we use M in in the the abbreviation. abbreviation. 9 This abbreviation is relevant relevant when when dealing dealing with with linear linear multistep multistep methods. methods. 8
232
CHAPTER CHAPTER 11. 11. LINEAR LINEAR MULTISTEP MULTISTEP
METHODS METHODS
Definition 11.6. The linear linear multistep multistep method method isis called called of of type type LMj(ip) LMj(ip) ifif it is both of type LM((p) LM((p) and and of of class class M/. M/. 1 0
In this chapter, in the the general general case case where where the the operator operator A(t) A(t) depends depends certain Holder-continuity Holder-continuity type type conditions conditions on on A(t). A(t). In In this this on t, we employ certain modify slightly slightly the the concept concept of of testing testing functional functional ininconnection we need to modify 11 following definition definition will will be be valid valid troduced in Section 5.1. Therefore the following hereinafter. Definition 11.7. Let Cl(Dom.A(£)) Cl(Dom.A(£)) == XX and and let let V* V* and and VV be belinear linear manmanifolds (independent of t) t) such such that that T>ovaA*(t) T>ovaA*(t)CC V* V* CC X* X* and and Dom DomA(t) A(t) CC V C X fort G [0,T]. A bilinear functional A(t;-,-) A(t;-,-) with with Dom Dom A(t; A(t; == V* xV is then called aa testing testing functional functional for for A(t) A(t) if, if, for for any any tt GG [0,T], [0,T], (x,A(t)u)
— A(t;Xi u)
whenever x S "P* and u G DomA(t),
(A*(t)x,u)
= A(t\Xi u)
whenever x £ DomA*(t) DomA*(t) and and uu G G
and
Apart from everything else, else, one one more more hypothesis hypothesis of of Holder-continuity Holder-continuity isis in use below. More precisely, precisely, we we introduce, introduce, with with some some \i\ \i\ >> 00 and and i?i?GG [0,1], the following. hol/fcs [#]: The domain of A(t) A(t) is is dense dense in in XX for for any any tt G G [0, [0,T), T), the the domain domain of A*(t) is independent of of t,t, and and itit holds, holds, for for all all kk GG(0, (0,K], K], t,t, ss GG[0, [0,T] T] such such that \t - s| < k, and x G G 3t*, 3t*,
\\(A*(t) - A*(s)) X\U < Ck»\\(A*(t) + ^I)x\UAs a matter of fact we deal deal with with linear linear multistep multistep methods methods of oftype type LMj LMj (>) only and if the dependence dependence on on tt isis generally generally present, present, with with operators operators A(t) A(t) satisfying the hypotheses hypotheses holj^[#] holj^[#] and and h6l($; h6l($; A(t; A(t; ,, ;;|| || m; t,m = 0,*0) 12 when showing below the the assertions assertions on on stability stability with with the the help help ofof the the general general Part I.I. To To create create premises premises for for application application of ofthis this theory, theory, theory developed in Part give statements statements of of preparatory preparatory character. character. in the next section we give 10
complete classification classification of of the the linear linear multistep multistep methods methods owing owingtotothe the We do not give a complete fact that our consideration consideration in in the the present present chapter chapter isis of of confined confined character. character. 11 The point is that the analysis analysis in in Part Part IIII isis carried carried out out under under the the assumption assumption that that Dom A(t) is independent independent of of t,t, which which isis reasonable reasonable when when dealing dealing with with RK RK methods. methods. For For the aims of the present chapter chapter itit isis natural natural to to assume assume instead instead that that Cl(Dom Cl(Dom>!(£)) >!(£)) == XX for t 6 [0, T\. It turns out out that that we we then then have have to to modify modify the the concept concept ofof testing testing functional, functional, previously defined, in order order to to make make our our subsequent subsequent argument argument correct. correct. 12 With the newly defined concept concept of of testing testing functional functional the the latter latter hypothesis hypothesis isis stated stated just the same as in Section Section 5.1. 5.1.
11.2. AUXILIARY AUXILIARY RESULTS RESULTS
233 233
11.2 Auxiliary Auxiliary results results We begin begin by showing showing a certain certain resolvent resolvent estimate. estimate.
Theorem 11.1. multistep method method is of type LMj{ip) LMj{ip) Theorem 11.1. Suppose Supposethat that the linear multistep S(ip,a), for some ip ipG G (0, (0, TT/2) and a G R. Then there there exist exist and that that A(t) €€ S(ip,a), numbers numbers K > 0, 0, 55 >> 00 and andaaset setTT ofof Ax-configuration Ax-configuration such such that that for all all ke {0,K}, {0,K}, te [0,T], [0,T], and A <£Int <£Int (T UV(5k)), UV(5k)),
where A(z) is is the the amplification amplification matrix. matrix. If a > > 00 in in addition, addition, we then take take and 55 = = 0. 0. K — oo and Proof. First of all note that that the operator operator .A(—fc.A(i)) .A(—fc.A(i)) is defined defined and bounded bounded the accepted accepted conditions, conditions, the operators operators oij{—kA{t)), oij{—kA{t)), j — on £( m ) since, by the 1,..., 1 , . . . , m, are are defined defined and bounded bounded on X for for kk G G (0, K] and and tt G G [0, T], owing owing to Lemma Lemma 5.3. Further, Further, letting letting ipi G G (0, (0, tp) and R R > > 00 be be just the same as in the the 13 assertion assertion of Lemma Lemma A.I stated for A(t) A(t) in in place of £, we select some some d G (0, |ao|/|26o|)|ao|/|26o|)-14 Moreover, Moreover, for our our further needs needs we choose d > 00 to to be sufficiently sufficiently small small so that for z G G T>(d) all the the roots Xj(—z) Xj(—z) of equation equation (11.14), except the single simple (11.14), simple root root Xi(—z), Xi(—z), are bounded bounded away away from from 0. The The last is feasible feasible by Reed & Simon [134, Theorem Theorem XII. XII. 1] since 0 is a simple simple (11.12) and, hence, a simple root root of (11.14) (11.14) when when z = 0. 0. Also, we root of (11.12) set K < d/R d/R ifif aa < <00and andKK ==oo ooififaa>>0.0. By the assumptions assumptions it follows from from perturbation perturbationtheory theory (see [134, Section Section XII. 1]) that that there there exists exists a set T' T' of of Ai-configuration Ai-configuration such such that that all the the roots (11.14) belong belong to T' for for zz 66 EE^^.. Note also also that that there there are no no Xj(—z) of (11.14) poles of ctj(-z), j = l , . . . , m m,, lying in T, ipi since |arg(ao/fro)| |arg(ao/fro)| < TC — (p. Next, it is evident evident that that there there exists exists a set T T of of Ai-configuration Ai-configuration such such that that T ' \ { 0 }} ccllnnttTT.. We now show how to to estimate estimate the quantity quantity ||(AI ||(AI — A(—fc-^C*)))" A(—fc-^C*)))"1!!^) f° r A ^ T, |A| |A| < < Ao, Ao, with some some Ao > 00 which will will be specified specified later. later. Observe Observe that condition condition (11.11) (11.11) implies impliesthat that c\z\ < \Xi(-z)\ \Xi(-z)\ <
(11.15) (11.15)
Using this sufficiently small small to have this inequality inequality we select a fixed do > 0 sufficiently do\Xi(-z)\ < -\z\ do\Xi(-z)\ -\z\
for for all allzz G V(d),
"Observe that "Observe that if a > 0, 0, we wecan can take R = 0. 0. 14 Therefore the functions functions otj{z), j = 1,..., m, have no poles in T){d). Therefore
(11.16) (11.16)
234
CHAPTER 11. LINEAR MULTISTEP METHODS
and set Ao = d/do- Let further F\ be the contour coinciding with the boundary of the set "D(do|A|) U E^j. Applying then the operator calculus formula (A.10) componentwise, we obtain, with 6 — d$1R, for all k G (0,K] and A g Int(T U V(8k)), |A| < Ao,
(AI - A(-kA(t))yl
= (Ai - ^(oo))" 1 !
+ W~ I ((Ai - M-*))'1
- (^ - -A(oo))-1) ® (zl - kA{t))-ldz, (11.17)
where, as above, i stands for the identity (m x m)-matrix. For our needs below we further denote, given an (m x m)-matrix p = (pji), \Pji\-
In order to evaluate the integrand in (11.17), we first observe that ^ (Ai - yiC-a:))-1 - (Ai - yi(oo))-1 * < C # A(oo) - A(-z) U (Ai - yi(oo))-1 U (Ai - A{-z))~l
# . (11.18)
Since the eigenvalues of yi(oo) lie in the interior of T, it follows that tf(Ai-.A(oo)r1t
+ |A|)- 1
forA^IntT.
(11.19)
It is also readily seen that 1
SVl.
(11.20)
Furthermore since doAo = d, observing that the entries of the matrix A(—z) are bounded and that \j(—z), j — 2,... ,m, are bounded away from 0 for z G V(d) U S^j and using the formula for the entries of the inverse matrix (see, e.g., Horn & Johnson [85]), we obtain, with Aji(X;—z) the cofactors of the respective entries of Ai — A(—z), for all A ^ IntT, A G T>(XQ), and
(Ai - A(-z))-1
!/(< C max \An(\; -z)\ |det(Ai -
1-1 A(-z))\
l<jl<m
\X\r~1 J ] |A - Xji-zT1 < C\X - \!(-z)\-1. 3=1
(11.21)
11.2. AUXILIARY RESULTS RESULTS
235
Since X\(—z) G T ' for z G S ^ , it holds |A - Ai(-z)| A i ( - z ) | > c(|A| + \\i{-z)\)
for A g IntT and z G
and it follows from (11.16) that that
- ^ >B for
|A -
Using these observations, observations, instead instead of (11.21) we get, for all A ^ I n t T , A G X>(Ao), and z G TA,
| (Ai - y i ( - z ) ) " 1 # < C(|A|
(11.22)
Combining (11.18), (11.19), (11.19), (11.20), (11.20), (11.22) (11.22) and and taking taking (11.15) (11.15) into into account account therefore yields, for all A A ^ I n t T , A G £>(Ao), and z G T\, < <
(11.23)
C(|A[ +
Also, similarly to (5.7), we have, for k G {0,K], A ^ Int (T U V(6k)), and \\{zI-kA(t))-l\\
(11.24) (11.24)
Using now (11.19), (11.23), (11.23), and and (11.24) (11.24) for for estimation estimation on onthe the basis basisofof (11.17), (11.17), we find, for all Jfe G (0, K] K] and and A AG GInt Int (T (T U UV(Sk)) V(Sk)) n £>(A0),
_ A(-kA(t)))-% m)
< C If (AI - A(-
1
.
(11.25)
Finally, note that the estimate estimate % (Ai - A{-z))-'
- (Ai - .A(oo))- 1 1 < C(\z\ + IAD"1
obviously holds for A £ Int (T U V(X 0)) and z G V{d) U S V l as well. Using basis of (11.17), with r \ 0 in this fact and (11.19) for for an estimation on the basis place of TA, gives, for A £ Int (T U £>(A 0)),
Combined with (11.25), (11.25), this this inequality inequality shows shows the the claim. claim.
236
CHAPTER CHAPTER 11. 11. LINEAR LINEAR MULTISTEP MULTISTEP
METHODS METHODS
Remark 11.1. The assertion assertion of of Theorem Theorem 11.1 11.1 yields yields that, that, under under the the asassumed conditions, the operator satisfies satisfies operator 2l(t 2l(tn) = k~1A(—kA(tn)) G B(X^) the Af- condition, in particular, particular, the the A\-condition A\-condition ifif aa >> 0,0, in in the the space space 3£( 3£(m\ Theorem 11.2. Suppose Suppose that that A(t) A(t) G G S((p,a), S((p,a), Cl(Dom Cl(Dom A(t)) A(t)) == X, X, and and the the linear multistep method method is is of of type type LMi(ip), LMi(ip), for for some some tp tpEE (0,TT/2) and a G R. Let further seminorms seminorms \\ \t\t and and \\ |* |*;t form respectively (7|?, a)- and and (*;j\if, a)-concordant pairs with with A(t) A(t) for for some some 77 >> 00 and and let let aa rational rational function ui(z) be ((p)-regular ((p)-regular and and subject subject to to deg[cj] deg[cj] << — [7J — 1. Then, with K > 0 sufficiently small, small, the the seminorms seminorms
i,.. .,um)Tln
= max l<j<m
\u(-kA(t n))uj\t nn
and KXl,
,Xm) T | . ; n
are well defined for k G G (0, (0, K], K], ttn G fijj. and form respectively Aj(7)Aj(7)- and and (A^j)- and A\(*; /y)-concordant if a > 0) Ai(*;j)-concordant 0) pairs pairs with with In the case where 77 is is an an integer, integer, under under the the extra extra 2l(i n ) = k~lA{—kA{tn)). requirement that the pairs (| |t;.A(£)) and (|(| \*-t\A(t)) \*-t\A(t)) are are respectively respectively (TMV 7)'7)
~
an
d (*;7l7l (Picr) ~ concordant,
i / 7 > 1, and \u
|xl*;t
for for all all tt ee [0,T], [0,T], uu ee X, X, and and
X
e X*
ifj = 0, it is sufficient to to suppose suppose that that deg[u] deg[u] << —[7] —[7] instead instead ofof << — [7J — 1Furthermore, for any fixed fixed ££ G G (0,1] (0,1] and and n\ n\ >> 00 sufficiently sufficiently large, large, with with some K > 0 sufficiently small, small, the the seminorms seminorms
I(«i,...,u m ) r I n =A: c muc ||(^(t n) + ml) (a ol +
kboA^yWl
and m
(A*(tn) + /iiJ) (05/ +
kblA*{t kblA*{tn))-lXjh
3=1
are well defined for k G and form respectively G (0, (0, K], K], ttn G ^ respectively Aj(l Aj(l — ^)and Aj(*; 1 —C) -concordant -concordant (Ai(l (Ai(l — Q- and Ai(*; 1 —C)- concordant if a > 0) pairs with ^i(tn). Apart from everything everything else, else, in in the the case case aa >> 00 the the above above holds with K = 00.
11.2. AUXILIARYRESULTS RESULTS 11.2. AUXILIARY
237
237
Proof. Thisresult result isestablished established asin inTheorem Theorem11.1, 11.1, applying aswell wellthe the Proof. This is as applying as argument employed inthe theproof proof ofTheorem Theorem 6.1. As concerns the seminorms argument employed in of 6.1. As concerns the seminorms I ||||nn and andI I |* |*;;nn,, to toshow showthe theclaim claimwewe letK, K,8,8, Ao,T, T,and and be the same let Ao, T\T\ be the same 15 15 as in inthe the proofof ofTheorem Theorem 11.1 and,taking taking inplace placeof ofT\ T\if if |A| > >Ao, Ao, as proof 11.1 and, F^ooF^ in |A| we use usethe the operatorcalculus calculus formula, forall all G (0,K], K],tt G G[0,T], [0,T],and and operator formula, for kk G (0, we
70 70 70 70 (AI Jfc2l(i))®u(-kA(t)) u(-kA(t)) ==(XI (XI-- A;2l(oo))A;2l(oo))® uj(-kA(t)) uj(-kA(t)) (AI -- Jfc2l(i))® ®
+ 7T- II w(-z) w(-z) + 7T2-KIJ JTx 2-KI Tx
10 1 10 1 U\\-A(-z))-™-(\\-A{oo))-' )®(zI-kA(t))dz, U\\-A(-z))-™-(\\-A{oo))-' )®(zI-kA(t))dz,
with 70==L'yL yJ1. + 1. Applying thesame sameformula formula 70==1 1 and with with 70 J'+ Applying the withwith 70 and with m l m (ao— —boz)~ boz)~ placeof ofui(z) ui(z)allows allows usto toprove provethe the desired estimates forthe the (ao place us desired estimates for other two seminorms involved. other two seminorms involved. A(t) S((p,a), Cl(Dom Cl(Dom =XXfor for any Theorem11.3. 11.3. Suppose that GG S((p,a), A(t))A(t)) = any Theorem Suppose that A(t) t G G[0,T], [0,T],and andthe the linearmultistep multistep method isof oftype typeLMj((p), LMj((p), forsome some linear method is for ipGG(0,7r/2) (0,7r/2) aG GR. R.Let Letfurther further bea atesting testingfunctional functional forA(t), A(t), ip andand a A(t;A(t; ,,)) be for let seminorms t, m = 0, *0, form respectively (-y\ip,a)and (*;7*|y, o~)let seminorms || | m; t, m = 0, *0, form respectively (-y\ip,a)and (*;7*|y, o~)m; concordant pairs A(t),and and satisfyhol(i?;.4(£; hol(i?;.4(£; |m;t,tn= = concordant pairs with with A(t), let let A(t)A(t) satisfy ,, ;;|| |m;t,tn 0, *0),for forsome some7,7* 7,7* G[0,1) [0,1) and -dG G[0,1]. [0,1]. Then Thenthe theoperator operator21 21(t (tnn) = = 0, *0), G and -d k~lA(—kA(t A(—kA(t )) satisfies hypothesis H O L ^ ; m j|j = | 0, *0) in the space k~ )) satisfies hypothesis H O L ^ ; j| j | ; , m = 0, *0) in the space m nn nn m X( mm)), where where X
(11.26) (11.26)
Proof. Aneasy easycalculation calculation shows Proof. An shows that that 00
0 0
00
0 0
/i(t,s) /i(t,s)
where Vj(t,s)==aamm-j(—kA(t)) where Vj(t,s) -j(—kA(t))
-j(—kA(s)), a — a— m-j(—kA(s)), m
(t,s) VmmV (t,s)
At j j = =ll, ,. . .. ,.m, m . . At t ht eh e
same time wehave, have,denoting denoting forshort shortCjCj = aam _j6o — —bbmm-jao -jao and and g(t) same time we for = g(t) = = m_j6o
15 15
Therefore Therefore 5 5==00 and andK K==00 00 if ifaa>>0.0.
238 238
CHAPTER LINEAR MULTISTEP METHODS CHAPTER 11. 11. LINEAR MULTISTEP METHODS
With the the aid aidofofthis this representation, representation,we we find, find, for for jj == 11, .,....,.m , mand and With forfor all all ueX andxx GG X*, ueX and X*,
=
{{A*(s)Q*(s)x,Q(t)u) -kkCj Cj{{A*(s)Q*(s)x,Q(t)u)
=
(g*(s)X,A(t)g(t)u)) ,A(t)g(t)u)) (g*(s)
-kcjAA(t,s]Q*(s)x,Q(t)u), -kcjAA(t,s]Q*(s)x,Q(t)u),
u as above, above, AA(t,s;x, AA(t,s;x, —A(t\Xi A(t\Xiu) ~~ -4( -4(s ;X> ;X>u )- Using Using the the last last where, as where, ) — equality and andrecalling recallingthat thatA(t) A(t) satisfies satisfieshol(i9, hol(i9, ,m = = 0, 0,*0), *0), equality ,, ;;| | ||mm;;tt,m it follows followsthat thatfor for jj == 11,,......,,m m and andfor forall allt, t, [0,T], T], t ii ee ll, , and andxx GGX*, X*, s sG G [0,
k-'Kx,Vj(t,s)
11.3 11.3
Stability Stability
We are are now nowinina aposition position to to state state our our results results on on stability. stability. As As above, above,we we We distinguishbetween betweenthe the cases cases with withaa constant constant and andaavariable variable operator. operator. distinguish Theorem 11.4. 11.4.Suppose Suppose that thatA(t) A(t) ==AAisisindependent independent oft, oft, AA GG S(ip,a), S(ip,a), Theorem is of of type type LMj(ip), LMj(ip), and and aaseminorm seminorm ][-][t ][-][t forms forms the linear linear multistep multistepmethod method is the (£|?,a)-concordant a)-concordantpair pair A, for for some some
M-kA) YYn][tn< C C M-kA) o~ > > 00 in in addition, addition, the the above aboveholds holdsfor for TT ==KK——oo. oo. If o~ Proof. It is ispointed pointed out outin inSection Section 11.1 11.1that that if if YYn is is the theC-extended C-extendedsolution solution Proof. It (11.1),then thenthe thevector vector Y Y n specified specifiedby by (11.5) (11.5) fits fits(11.10) (11.10)with with y°, y°,FFn , and and of (11.1), 2ln = = 21 21given givenby by (11.6), (11.6), (11.7), (11.7),and and (11.9), (11.9),respectively. respectively.Also, Also, the the seminorm seminorm ]['][«—}[ ]['][«—}[u(~kA)-}[t (~kA)-}[tn forms forms a Aj(£)-concordant Aj(£)-concordantpair pair with with 21, by by 21, Theorem Theorem11.2. 11.2.
11.3. STABILITY 11.3. STABILITY
239
239
thusremains remains toapply applyTheorem Theorem 2.1to toproblem problem(11.10), (11.10),taking takinginto intoaccount account It thus to 2.1 that that m m
| | Fn || | |( m C ^ | | /n ++mm_ j || || ||F
(11.28) (11.28)
j=0 j=0
and and ||Y Y0 | | ( mm))< C C
max ||^||. ||^||. max
(11.29) (11.29)
0<j<m—l 0<j<m—l
Concerning the case case with withaa variable variableoperator, operator, wepresent present the the following. following. Concerning the we 11.5.Let LetTT< < and operatorA(t) A(t) and andthe the linear multimultiTheorem11.5. Theorem oooo and let let the the operator linear step method methodbe beunder under the theconditions conditionsof of Theorem Theorem11.3 11.3 for some some(p(pG G (0,TT/2), (0,TT/2), step for aG GR, R, 7,7* 7,7*GG [0,1), andti andtiG G(0,1] (0,1]such such that that7+7* 7+7*< < 11 + + tf. tf.Let Letfurther further Ait) Ait) [0,1), satisfy hypothesis hol^J^ for ] some some $2 $2 G G(0,1] (0,1]subject subjectto to 77 <
240
CHAPTER CHAPTER 11. 11. LINEAR LINEAR MULTISTEP MULTISTEP METHODS METHODS
with 16
- k~lam-j{-kA{tn)),
j = 0,..., m - 1. 1.
It follows from Theorem Theorem 11.3 that the operator 2l(i n ) satisfies hypothesis as in the statement of the HOL(i9; I |m;n,tn = 0, *0) with the same present theorem where where the seminorms ||| \\m-n, tn — 0, *0, are given by (11.26). By Theorem 11.2 these seminorms form respectively respectively A-j^)A-j^)- and Aj(*;7*)-concordant pairs pairs with with 2l(t 2l(t n ). Further, applying the following identity, with with Cj denned the same as in the proof of Theorem 11.3, for j — 0 , . . . , m — 1, WnJ = bm-jiaol + kboA{tn+m))~1(A(tn+j) %
^tn) ^tn)
-
A(tn+m))
-- A(tn+m))
(a0I +
kb0A{tn))'1,
t — tn+j,tn, extend where the factors (aol+kboA(t n+m))~1 (A(t)—A(t n+m)), to linear bounded operators operators on X, and using the fact that A{t) satisfies > 0, for all x £ X * and u G X, hypothesis hol? feJi?2] we have, with some that
\{x,WnJu)\ < C^ 2 ||(^*(i n ) + Mi/)(aS/ + A;6^*(in))-1xll*ll«ll- (H-30) Noting now t h a t by (11.4) it holds, for any ( x i , . . . , X m ) T 6 X^*
and
. Xm)T, ® n (ni, . . . , Um)T)(m) = (Xm, with the aid of (11.30) we obtain | ((Xl.
, Xm) T , ®n(wi,
Umm))TT)( )(mm)) \\ U
< Ck^\\(A*(t n) + /xi/) (a*0I + fc&5^(t n))-1 < C||(Xl,
,Xm)r|||*;tf2;n||(ui,
,um)T\\{m)
Umm))TT\\\\{m) ,, U {m),,
where the seminorm
*n) + ^ W 3=1
We remark that actually Wn,j 6 B(X), which follows from the above comment.
11.3. 11.3. STABILITY STABILITY
241
241
forms a A^(*; 1 1— pair with ), because of Theorem 11.2. 11.2. — i^-concordant i^-concordant pair5t(t with 5t(t nn ), because of Theorem forms a A^(*; Now weweuseuse the the aboveabove shown properties of the operators 2l(£ operators 2l(£nn ) and Now shown properties of the and 1*B n and thatthat the seminorm ]|[-][n ][(^ ++^^(*n))~ ][t nn forms *B andnote note the seminorm ]|[-][n== ][(^ ^^(*n))~1][t formsa Aj(£)a Aj(£)17 ), ininvirtue of Theorem 11.2, 11.2,17 while and and concordant pairpair with with 2l(i 2l(i nn ), concordant virtue of Theorem while(11.28) (11.28) (11.29) areare validvalid in theinconsidered case. Thuscase. the claim follows Theorem (11.29) the considered Thus thebyclaim follows by Theorem 2.17 which is applied to problem (11.10) with 2l(i with 2l(i nn ) ininplace of 2lof 2l nn , with place withthethe 2.17 which is applied to problem (11.10) statement of the of present with 71 =and 7, with 71 = 7, same 7,7*,$ same 7,7*,$ as asininthethe statement the theorem presentand theorem $1 = $0= =$00, = 7*0 0,— 17*0 - $2$1 ==$,$,70 70 — 1 - $2-
O
O
As aapossible application, we consider family ofthe m-step BDFofmethAs possible application, we the consider family m-step BDF methods, ods, mm== 1,2,..., 1,2,..., for forwhich which
and and m mm m
E E ;=o ;=o
n, n
m ——0 0
\
\ In,
;=o ;=o
In, 1
m
\ 1 13n, \
i=o
O 13n,
O <)<)
99
m m
f
f 11 11 ^9^ ^9^
i=o
Note that (11.31) and the equality (11.32) together imply together condition imply condition Note that (11.31) andfirstthe first inequality in (11.32) (11.11). by by (11.31) it is immediate that equation (11.13) has only(11.13) has only (11.11). Further, Further, (11.31) it is immediate that equation one root = 0 (of m). Also, itm). easilyAlso, followsit from the follows order from the order one rootA(oo) A(oo) = 0multiplicity (of multiplicity easily conditions (11.32) that all the roots of (11.12), the single simplethe rootsingle simple root conditions (11.32) that all the roots except of (11.12), except Ai(0) belong to thetoopen Intl?(l; It is known Hairer (see, e.g., Hairer Ai(0)= =0, 0, belong thedisk open disk1).Intl?(l; 1).(see, It e.g., is known & [81])[81]) that that for thefor m-step methods withmethods 1 < m < 6,with condition & Wanner Wanner the BDF m-step BDF 1 < m < 6, condition >mm],], with withipipmm €€ (0,TT/2) (0,TT/2) depending depending (ii) 11.5 holds (ii) ininDefinition Definition 11.5 for holds for
=d\—(1 = +—(1 20), + oi2 20),
== oi2 == 9,9, bobo == 1, 1,b\ = b\ b = b22 ==== 0,0,
where where 9 9is aisfixed a fixed parameter. parameter. (For the sake (Forofthe simplicity sake we of assume simplicity 0 to we assume 0 to be real.)AnAn elementary (but cumbersome) shows that for this be real.) elementary (but cumbersome) computation computation shows that for this method method condition condition (ii) in(ii) Definition in Definition 11.5 is fulfilled 11.5forisany fulfilled fixed (pfor £ (0,any fixed (p £ (0, TT/2) TT/2) ifif 99££ [-1/2,1/2] [-1/2,1/2] and andforfor
tpe ——arctan -— -— tpe arctan
(1 (1 ++464611 )33 /22 - I)I ) 33 / 22 '
In In tthhee case case ££==0 0wewe also also can c a n take take|[-][n= |[-][n= |||| II,II,byby Theorem Theorem11.1.11.1.
242 242
CHAPTER CHAPTER 11. LINEAR 11. LINEAR MULTISTEP MULTISTEP METHODS METHODS
equation (11.13) has Further, Further,it it is iseasily easilychecked checkedthat that equation (11.13) hasaaroot root A(oo) A(oo)= = 11 ofof multiplicity 2 and thethe other multiplicity 2 while whileone oneof ofthe theroots roots of of (11.12) (11.12)is is Ai(0) Ai(0)==0 0 and other lies in the lies in the theopen open disk diskInt IntD(l; D(l; 1) 1)ifif66>>—1/2. —1/2. Consequently, Consequently, theconsidered considered method is isof oftype type LMi(ip) LMi(ip)for forany anyfixed fixed ipipe (0,TT/2) (0,TT/2)if if 00G G (-1/2,1/2] (-1/2,1/2]and and method for any for anyfixed fixed yy €€(0, (0,tp tpg} if 00>>1/2. 1/2.
11.4 Comments andand bibliographical remarks 11.4 Comments bibliographical remarks Apparently, multistep approximation in has Apparently, multistep approximation in aaBanach Banachspace spacesetting setting hasbeen been examined for in opexamined forthe thefirst first time timein in Crouzeix Crouzeix[60], [60], in the thecase case with withconstant constant operator but erator butfor forgeneral generalCo Cosemigroups. semigroups.At Atthe thesame sametime timean anearlier earlierpaper paper of of 18 Le Roux Le Roux[102], [102],18 although althoughwritten written in in aaHilbert Hilbertspace spacesetting, setting, demonstrates demonstrates techniques techniquesthat thatare areextended extendedto tothe theBanach Banachcase, case,dealing dealing withwith sectorial sectorial opoperators. Note erators. Notethat that both both mentioned mentioned paperspapers aim aimat atshowing showingconvergence convergence onlyonly donot notallow allowus usto tosettle settlethe thequestion questionof ofstability. stability.The Theconsideraconsiderabut they but theydo tion tion of oflinear linearmultistep multistep methods methods in inthe thepresent presentchapter chapter covers covers the thecases casesboth both with aa time-independent with time-independent and andaatime-dependent time-dependent operator; operator; in infact, fact, our ouranalyanaly19 Later [129], sis sis here hereis isclose closeto tothe thelines linesfound foundin in [28]. [28].19 LaterPalencia Palencia [129],considering considering the autonomous case only, shows the approxthe autonomous case only, shows thestability stabilityof ofgeneral generalmultistep multistep approximations. For Foraaspecial specialclass classof ofsuch such approximations, approximations, some some strong strong stability stability imations. and and nonsmooth nonsmootherror error estimates estimates are arepointed pointedout outby byHansbo Hansbo[83]. [83].The Thecase case has recently in with aa variable with variableoperator operator hasalso also been beenconsidered considered recently in Gonzalez Gonzalez& & Palencia [74], if Palencia [74],but buttheir their results resultsare areapplicable applicableonly only if the theoperator operatorA(t) A(t)isis Lipschitz-continuous while Lipschitz-continuous while the thesituation situationin in which whichA(t) A(t)isisproperly properlyHolderHoldercontinuous continuousis is not notcovered coveredin in[74]. [74].
18 18
it it also also treats treatslinear linear multistep multistep ones.ones. Apart Apart from fromsingle single stepstep methods methods arenow nowbased based on onaadifferent different form formof ofHolder-continuity Holder-continuity for forA(t). A(t). We We are
19 19
Part IV
INTEGRO-DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS UNDER DISCRETIZATION
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
245
In this part of the book book we we present present some some results results concerning concerning stability stability of discretizations of abstract abstract linear linear integro-differential integro-differential equations. equations. As As the the starting object, we consider consider the the initial initial value value problem problem rt
yt + A{t)y=
Jo
P(t,s)y{s)ds P(t,s)y{s)ds + +f(t) f(t)
forte(0,T], forte(0,T],
y(0) y(0) == y°, y°, (11.33) (11.33)
where P(t, s) is a linear (generally (generally unbounded) unbounded) operator operator in inXX for for 00<< ss < > 00 sufficiently sufficiently large large and and for for any any t,s 6 [0,T] such that t > > s, s, the the operator operator (A(t) (A(t) +/iiJ)~ +/iiJ)~ 1 P(t,s) is extended to a linear bounded operator operator defined defined on on the the whole whole X. X. Further Further requirements requirements on A(t) and P(t, s) are imposed imposed in in the the subsequent subsequent statements. statements.20 Problem (11.33) is more complicated complicated in in comparison comparison with with (5.1) (5.1) since since an an extra term is involved in in (11.33), (11.33), which which isis of of nonlocal nonlocal nature nature and and brings brings about additional difficulties. difficulties. As As concerns concerns discretizations discretizations ofofproblem problem (11.33), (11.33), they are accordingly harder harder for for analysis analysis than than those those studied studied above abovefor forproblem problem (5.1). In our opinion, this topic topic deserves deserves to to be be the the main main subject subject for for aaseparate separate book; nevertheless, in what what follows, follows, just just to to reveal reveal further further the the possibilities possibilitiesofof our approach, we discuss certain certain selected selected discretization discretization schemes schemesfor for problem problem (11.33). In Section 12.1 we show the the stability stability of of these these discretizations discretizations on on finite finite time intervals while Section Section 12.2 12.2 isis devoted devoted to to discussing discussing suitable suitable sparse sparse quadrature rules for an approximation approximation of of the the memory memory term, term, which which are are ofof considerable interest in practical practical applications. applications.
20
Here we derive no error error estimates estimates so so that that no no conditions conditions that that provide provide the the unique unique solvability and high regularity regularity properties properties of of (11.33) (11.33) are are employed. employed. The Thebelow belowrequirements requirements on A(t) and P(t,s) are merely merely used used to to show show the the stability stability ofof the the discretizations discretizations that that are are considered.
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
Chapter 12
Integro-Differential Integro-Differential Equations under Discretization Discretization Stability of discretizations discretizations 12.1 Stability chapter we examine two concrete discretizations discretizations schemes schemes of In the present chapter Euler method method and the second the Crankwhich the first is the backward Euler methods, when when applied applied to purely differential differential Nicolson one. 1 Both of these methods, with the aid of certain assertions assertions equations of the form (5.1), are analysed with established in Part II. grid in the segment [0,T], [0,T], with with stepsize stepsize Let, as above, Q/. be a uniform grid let &k &k retain the same meaning meaning as before. Since Since our techniques k > 0, and let throughout are now based on making use of the results of Chapters 4 and 6, throughout that T < oo. The The memory term term in (11.33) is this chapter chapter it is assumed that approximated by applying the quadrature formula, approximated formula, with with some some weights weights KKUti, rtn rtn ™zl A"W>) = Y* nn,rtl « / il>{s) ds, with i} = tl>{ti),
(12.1) (12.1)
function. Our main where tp(t) can be thought of as a scalar or (X)-valued function. requirement below below on the quadrature formulas formulas used used is that with some some p > 0, requirement A n ( l ) = t n, KUtl > 0, and 1=0 lr
The latter method method is considered in the case A{t) = A only.
247
248
CHAPTER 12. INTEGRO-DIFFERENTIAL INTEGRO-DIFFERENTIAL CHAPTER
EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
discretization for all tn, tj G Qfc such that 0 < tj
subsequently stated stated the operator I + kA(tn+\) Since under the conditions subsequently method in the following has a bounded inverse, we take this discretization method + kA(t))-lP(t, s), form, denoting i ^ = (/ + kA^i))'1 and P(t, s) = (I + Yn+l
= n
Y^
kilnf(tn+l) for t n G kilnf(t
1=0
Yo = y°,
(12.3) (12.3)
which can be equivalently rewritten in the form (4.2) with Xn = A(t n)(I + kA(t n))-\
(12.4) (12.4)
S n = 2t n + 1 - 2l n ,
(12.5) (12.5)
Fn=iinf(tn+1),
(12.6) (12.6)
and y nj
= Kn+i,iP(t n+i,tl).
(12.7) (12.7)
theorems we show the stability of the backward In the following three theorems Euler method (12.3) in different situations. T h e o r e m 1 2 . 1 . Let the operator A(t) and a seminorm | |t satisfy the conditions of Theorem 6.12 for some ip E (0,TT/2), a G R, ~d G (0,1], 7i G [0,1), and let seminorms ][-][t and | |*;t form respectively (£\
\\P*(t, s)X\U < C\((I +
fcA(t))- 1)*xU;t-
(12-8)
(12.3) satisfies satisfies the stability Then the solution Yn of the discrete problem (12.3) estimate
kA{tn))-lYn\tn
(12.9)
for all k G (0,K) and t n G fifc. Furthermore, in the case ^ — 0 the last inequality holds with }[Yn][tn substituted for ][(/ + kA(t n))~1Yn][tn.
12.1. STABILITY STABILITY OF OFDISCRETIZATIONS DISCRETIZATIONS 12.1.
249249
Proof. Werecall recall that thatproblem problem (12.3) is equivalent equivalentto to (4.2), (4.2), (12.4) (12.4) (12.7). (12.7). Proof. We (12.3) is by Lemma Lemma 5.3, 5.3,the theoperator operatoriln iln isisuniformly uniformlybounded, bounded, for FFn given given Since, Since, by for by (12.6)we wehave have by (12.6)
\\Fn\\
foralltnGftfc. foralltnGftfc.
(12.10) (12.10)
Now, observing observingthat that the backward backwardEuler Eulermethod method is of oftype type Vi(ip) Vi(ip)for forany any the is Now, (p (0,TT/2),by by Theorem Theorem6.1 6.1ititfollows followsthat thatthe theseminorm seminorm (p £ (0,TT/2),
))^.}[tntn n))^.}[
ifif ££ >> 00, , if €€==0,0,
forms aa A^(£)-concordant A^(£)-concordantpair pair 2ln given given by by (12.4), (12.4),and, and,assuming assumingfurfurforms withwith 2l ther that that all all the theconditions conditionsof of Theorem Theorem4.1 4.1which which do do not notinvolve involvethe thesemisemither aresatisfied satisfiedfor forsome somesuitable suitable$, $, 71, 71,70, 70,73, 73,7*3, 7*3,the theclaim claim directly directly norm ]|[-]|[ ]|[-]|[ norm n are in view view of of the theabove above reasoning. reasoning. follows from fromthat thattheorem theorem follows in Belowwe wewill will show showthat thatthe theneeded neededconditions conditions ofTheorem Theorem4.1 4.1are areverified verified of Below for 70 70 == max{l max{l ——#,71}, #,71}, 73 73 == 0,0,and andforfor same ,, 71, 71,7*3 7*3asasinin for thethe same thethe statementof of the thepresent present theorem, theorem, which is sufficient sufficient to to conclude concludethe theproof. proof. statement which is In the the matter matter of of the theconditions conditionson on the theoperators operators2l 2ln and and Q5 Q5 givenby by In n given (12.4) and and (12.5), (12.5), respectively, respectively, their verification canbe bedone done by by using usingthe the (12.4) their verification can resoningemployed employed in the theproof proof of ofTheorem Theorem6.12, 6.12,choosing choosingsuitably suitably and resoning in |||||| || n and Il;n. III Il;n. Note further furtherthat that in virtue virtueof of (12.8) (12.8)the theoperator operatortyty specifiedby by (12.7) (12.7) Note in H:i specified H: fulfils condition condition(4.14) (4.14) with 7rM) = CK CKn+ | * 3; nn = = |il* |il* \*-t \*-tn+1 and 7r |||||| |*3 fulfils with M)/ = n+1, and n+iti, \h;n— —IIII II-II-Although Althoughby by Theorem Theorem6.1* 6.1*the the seminorm seminorm|||||| §*3 §*3;n;n forms forms aa III ' \h;n Aj (*;7*3)-concordant 7*3)-concordantpair pair with +i> 2l not notwith with 2l 2ln , it it is iseasy easy to tosee, see,using usingthe the Aj (*; with 2ln+i> above techniques, techniques, that Theorem 2.11remains remainsin in force force even evenif if the theseminorm seminorm above that Theorem 2.11 in its itsstatement statementis is assumed assumedto to form form aa A^(*;£*)-concordant A^(*;£*)-concordant ]|]|[-]|[* [-]|[*;n in pairpair withwith 4.1, whose proof uses Theorem 2.11, the operator operator2l2l +iHence Theorem the +iHence Theorem 4.1, whose proof uses Theorem 2.11, n still applicable applicablein in the thecase case where wherethe the pair pair (||| (||| |||*3 |||*3;n;2ln-i-i) n;2ln-i-i) is is Ai(*;j^)Ai(*;j^)is still concordant.It It is isalso also obvious obviousthat that thepair pair ((|| | 33; nn; 2l 2ln ) is is A^(0)-concordant. A^(0)-concordant. concordant. the of the theabove aboveobservations observations it remains remainsto to establish establishthat that(4.15) (4.15) and In viewof it and In view (4.16) hold holdwith with73 73 == 00and andwith with «;„+!,/ «;„+!,/substituted substituted for nnnj. To Tothat that end, end, (4.16) for since 7*3<< 1,1,by bya a simplecalculation, calculation, changing theorder order of of summation summationand and since 7*3 simple changing the
250
CHAPTER CHAPTER 12. 12. INTEGRO-DIFFERENTIAL INTEGRO-DIFFERENTIAL
EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
using (12.2) we have, for for all all titi < < ttm < ts < tn, that s-l n-1
nn--11
j=m q=j
q=m q=m n-1
min{<j,s-l} min{<j,s-l}
£ (« j=m j=m min{g,s-l}
*93
s-l s-l
£
and s—1
s—1
m—1 m—1
s—1 s—1
m—1 m—1
j=m
j=0
j=0 j=0
j=0 j=0
j=0 j=0
Combining both these estimates, estimates, itit follows follows that that condition condition (4.15) (4.15) isis satisfied satisfied established for 73 = 0, with K n+ i^ substituted for 7rnij. The same is similarly established in respect of (4.16). So the proof is complete. complete. Theorem 12.2. Let the the operator operator A(t) A(t) and and seminorms seminorms | | |® |®;< and \ | m;t , m = 0,1, *0, satisfy the the conditions conditions of of Theorem Theorem 6.13 6.13 for for some some ifif ££ (0,TT/2) ; [0,1) and and € (0,1] such that-y + ^ = a e E, 7 e ,7,7i,7*,^.,i9*. € [0,1) 1> 7i + 7* < 1, i9 > i9. i9. ++ i9*«. i9*«. iieeii ako ako seminorms seminorms << and and | | |*|*;t form respectively (£|y, c)- and and (*; (*; 7*3|y, 7*3|y, o^)-concordant o^)-concordant pairs pairs with with A(t) A(t) for for some some £ € [0,1 - 7* + min{t?,t?i}) min{t?,t?i}) and and 7 + 3 € [0,1 + min{tf - 7 , ^^ -- 77ii..--££}}))-Suppose further that the the conditions conditions (12.8) (12.8) and and (12.2) (12.2) hold hold for for the the operator operator P(t, s) and for the quadrature quadrature formula formula (12.1), (12.1), respectively. respectively. Then Then the the solution solution Yn of problem (12.3) satisfies satisfies the the stability stability estimate estimate (12.9) (12.9) in in which, which, if£ if£ == 0,0, the expression on the left-hand left-hand side side can can be be replaced replaced by by }[Yn][tn
The claim is shown by by checking checking the the conditions conditions of of Theorem Theorem 4.2 4.2 with with the aid of the argument argument employed employed in in the the proof proof of of Theorem Theorem 6.13 6.13 since since the the backward Euler method method is is both both of of type type Vi((p) Vi((p) and and of of type type Vj{
(12.11) (12.11)
12.1. STABILITY OF DISCRETIZATIONS DISCRETIZATIONS
251 251
Then, for Yn the solution of problem (12.3) (12.3) we we have, have,for for all allkk €€ (0,K\ (0,K\ and and tn £ f2/-, that
Proof. So far as the backward Euler Euler method method isis -A/(>)-stable -A/(>)-stable for for any any ip ip££ (0,7r/2), by Theorem 6.2 it follows follows that that the the operator operator 21 21 == A(I A(I ++ kA)~ kA)~l satisfies the A^-condition. A^-condition. Therefore, Therefore, using using the the estimate estimate (12.10) (12.10) which which isis obviously valid in the considered considered case, case, the the claim claim follows follows by by Theorem Theorem 4.3 4.3ifif we assume that condition condition (4.22) (4.22) holds. holds. It thus remains to verify (4.22). (4.22). Note Note that that in in view view of of the the identity identity
(21 + /zo/)~V + kA)- 1 = ((1 + it suffices to show (4.22) with with K Kn+itiP(tn+i,ti) substituted for ^p ^pn,i- By the obvious inequality \\Kq+l,lP{tq+i,ti) - K n>lP(tn,tl)\\
<
\K q+hi-Kntl\\\P(tq+i,tl)\\ +Kn,l||£(*9+l,*i)--P
taking (12.11) into account account now now gives, gives, for for all all titi
Finally, using actually the the same same reasoning reasoning as as in in the the proof proof ofof Theorem Theorem 12.1 12.1 , we when proving (4.15) with with 73 73 == 00 and and with with KKn+\j substituted for conclude that the expression expression on on the the right-hand right-hand side side of of the the last last inequality inequality isis p bounded by Ck log(T/k) + Ci s _ m . This completes the proof. Now we also discuss, for for the the sake sake of of simplicity simplicity in in the the case case A(t) A(t) == AA only, the Crank-Nicolson discretization discretization method method whose whose formal formal application application toto problem (11.33) then yields, yields, with with tn+\/2 — tn + k/2,
Y n) = A n+1(P(tn+1/2,-)Y) Y0 = y°.
+ f(
252
CHAPTER CHAPTER 12. INTEGRO-DIFFERENTIAL INTEGRO-DIFFERENTIAL
EQUATIONS EQUATIONS
Since under the below restrictions the operator I+^A has a bounded inverse, we take this method in the following form, with £2 = (J + I-A)" 1 , 2t = AQ,
Fn = Qf(tn+l/2),
and P{t,s) = QP(t,s),
n
1=0
Yo
= y°.
(12.12) (12.12)
Clearly, (12.12) can be equivalently rewritten in the form (4.1) with 2l n = 2t, and with the same Fn as here. tynl = nn+ijP(tn+i/2,ti), We present only one stability result for problem (12.12). T h e o r e m 12.4. Let A(t) = A ee S(ip, a) for some
I-I— 11-11Proof. The result follows by applying Theorem 4.2 whose conditions, in the case 2l n = 21 now considered, are checked with the aid of Theorems 2.1 and 2.2. At the same time the fact that the last two theorems are applicable can be established by using Theorems 6.5 and 6.5* since the Crank-Nicolson method method is Am(<£>)-stable for any ip G (0, TT/2) and fulfils the condition deg[a(-) — a(oo)] — —1. D D
12.2
Quadrature rules rules
Here we give examples of quadrature rules that satisfy satisfy our above assumptions. The most obvious choice is the rectangle rule for which KUII — k for */ < tn-i- A drawback of this method is that all already computed values values of the solution are involved in further calculations so that all of them have to be stored for future use. Following the philosophy of Sloan Sz Thomee [147] and Zhang [168], we now turn to describing certain sparse sparse quadrature quadrature rules rules for which the storage requirement is really reduced.
12.2. QUADRATURE RULES RULES
253 253
We begin with a quadrature quadrature formula formula based based on on the the trapezoidal trapezoidal rule ruleon oninintervals of length O (fc 1/2), with a slight modification modification near near ttn. More precisely, with v — \k~~xl2\ and k\ = vk, we put fy == lk\, lk\, and and let let lln be the largest integer with t; n < tn. For the interval [0,t n] we then apply the composite composite trapezoidal rule with stepsize trapezoidal stepsize k\ k\ on on [0,t;n], then the one-interval trapezoidal rule on [fyn,£n-i]i a n d finally the left side rectangle rectangle rule rule on on [tn-\,tn}. We therefore come to the quadrature quadrature formula formula
+ \ (tn-l - */„) (^(*n-l) ++ >(*/J) >(*/J) Since the rule is second order order in in k\ k\ over over [0,ij [0,ijn] and [fyn,£n_i], and first order on the the whole. whole. Observe Observe that that KKn>i < fc1/2 on [tn-i,tn], it is first order in k on for ti < t n-i, and it is easy to see see that that (12.2) (12.2) holds holds for for pp == 1/2. 1/2. The The number of time levels that that enter enter the the computation computation isis OO (&"" (&""1/2) for this rule, rectangle rule. rule. as compared with O (k" 1) for the standard rectangle Developing the idea of reducing reducing the the storage storage requirement, requirement, we we set set vv— — following. We We first first use use [£T1/4J and k 2 = vzk = O (k 1^) and do the following. Simpson's rule on as many many intervals intervals of of length length 2&2 2&2 that that can can be be fitted fitted into into [0,t n _i], and then, on the remaining remaining interval, interval, which which isis of of length length atat most most O(A;1//2), the composite trapezoidal trapezoidal rule rule on on as as many many intervals intervals of of length length trapek\ = u2k = O (&;1/2) as fit in, thus reaching titin, then the one-interval trapezoidal rule on the interval interval [i; n ,t n _i], and finally the left rectangle rectangle rule rule on on [tn-\, tn\. Similarly to above, this this quadrature quadrature rule rule isis first firstorder order on onthe thewhole, whole, while (12.2) holds for p — — 1/4. 1/4. Note Note that that the the number number ofof time time levels levels that that need to be stored per unit unit time time isis now now O O (k^ (k^1) + O {k^k^) + 1 — O (A;" 1/4). Also, it is not hard to construct construct quadrature quadrature rules rules which which further further reduce reduce the the storage requirement. We remark that our considerations considerations in in Section Section 12.1 12.1admitting admitting quadrature quadrature rules that reduce the storage storage requirement requirement are are related related to to Bakaev, Bakaev, Larsson, Larsson, and Thomee [40], where condition condition (12.2) (12.2) appears appears for for the the first first time. time. In conclusion, note that certain certain quadrature quadrature rules rules with with OO (fc~ (fc~1//2) time levels that are needed for for the the computation computation are are presented presented in in [147] [147]and and [168], but the techniques used in in these these works works do do not not allow allow one oneto to deal dealwith with further further reducing the storage requirement. requirement. At At the the same same time, time, for for instance, instance, for for the the Crank-Nicolson method the the results results of of [147] [147] and and [168] [168] are are applicable applicable under under weaker conditions on the kernel kernel P(t, P(t, s) s) than than in in the the preceding preceding section. section.
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
Appendix A
Functions of Linear Operators Here we collect some facts facts of operator theory which are in use in the course of our main considerations. considerations. As As therein, therein, we we let X be a complex Banach space and accept all the attendant notation introduced introduced in the book.
A.I
Analytic continuation continuation of the resolvent
In this section, given a linear operator £, we denote by p(£) the resolvent set of £. It is well known that if £ is a linear operator and if A G p(£), then p(£) contains as well some open disk centered centered at A (cf. Hille & Phillips [84, TheoTheorem 5.8.2]), which can be shown by analytic continuation. As a consequence of this fact, we obtain that that p(£) p(£) is, in fact, an open set. For our purposes in the main parts of the book, we need, however, to have at our disposal some quantative estimates accompanying accompanying the procedure of analytic continuation.
Theorem A.I. Let £ be a linear operator and let fi G p(£), with Then, for any A G C such that |A — //| = r < M, there exists an operator 6 (jit, A) G B(X) which is permutable with the resolvent of £, obeys the equality
and satisfies the estimate
255
256
APPENDIX APPENDIX A. FUNCTIONS OF LINEAR
OPERATORS OPERATORS
As a consequence, it holds
\\(\i - nr'w < 1 M -rM Proof. The claim follows when inserting inserting
into the Taylor expansion of the resolvent
with the aid of a standard argument (cf. Hille & Phillips [84, Section 5.8]).
Now the last result is used for analytic continuation of the resolvent of a sectorial operator. ^ A . 2 . Let £ e <S(M; tp, 0) for some
( ^ ^cos(ip -
v
and satisfies the estimate <
1 1 — M sin(tp —
As a consequence, it holds, for all X <
- Msm(ip —
Proof. Let A € C be arbitrary with argA = ip\. Then, for fj, = cos/ _i we have |/x - A| = |//| sin(
A.I.
ANALYTIC
CONTINUATION CONTINUATION
OF THE RESOLVENT
257
since £ G S(M\ ip, 0) and arg /J, — (p, by Theorem A.I we therefore find, with A with arg A =
where
Now, in view of the inequality |/z| > |A|, the claim follows at least for all A It is however with arg A = ip\ and, by symmetry, for all A with arg A = clear, using the above reasons, that the same assertion remains remains valid valid for all A £ Int E m as well. applications of the above results. Now we consider some applications L e m m a A . I . Suppose that £ G S(
(A.I) In the case a > 0, (A.I) holds with R = 0. Proof. By Theorem A.2 there exists a ipi G (0, ip) such that -l
if A—a ^ Int Y,
In the case a > 0 f/ie above holds with R — 0. Proof. The claim is established in a manner similar to that used in the proof of Lemma A.I. In fact, it suffices to mention that it follows from Theorem A.2 that with some tp2 tp2 G (0, ip), for arg(A — a) = (p%, arg(/x — a) — ip, and \X — a\ = \/J, — cr\ cos(tp —
(XI - £ ) ~ m - (fil - £)- m ©(A) m ,
258
APPENDIXA.A.FUNCTIONS FUNCTIONS LINEAR OPERATORS APPENDIX OFOF LINEAR OPERATORS
where where ||<5(A)||
A.2
Functionsof bounded bounded and and sectorial sectorial operators operators Functions
We now now discuss discusssome somemeans meanstotodefine define functions of linear operators; functions of linear operators; usingusing such functions functions isisananessential essentialingredient ingredient techniques in the present such of of ourour techniques in the present book. For For our our purposes purposesweweemploy employa simplified a simplified notion of contour which book. notion of contour which differs slightly slightlyfrom fromwhat whatisisusually usually accepted in the theory of functions differs accepted in the theory of functions of a of a complex variable. variable. More Moreprecisely, precisely, a contour mean a simple piecewise complex byby a contour we we mean a simple piecewise smooth curve curve inin the thecomplex complexplane, plane,which which either is finite of finite length smooth either is of length and and closed or or passes passesthrough throughoo. oo.It Itis isaccepted accepted book a contour closed in in thethe book thatthat a contour is is always oriented oriented counter-clockwise counter-clockwiseor ordownwards downwards is finite or infinite, always if itif isit finite or infinite, respectively, unless unlessititisisspecified specifieddifferently. differently.Instead Instead of contour sometimes respectively, of contour sometimes say on on equal equalterms termsintegration integrationpath. path. we say first ££ ££ B(X) B(X) and andletletE Ebebea finite a finite contour such Let first contour such thatthat the the openopen set set of which which 55 isisthe theboundary, boundary,contains contains spectrum of Let £. Let further A, of thethe spectrum of £. further /(A) /(A) 1 A. Then Then complexfunction functionthat thatis isholomorphic holomorphic a neighbourhood of A. be aa complex in in a neighbourhood operator / /((££) ) given givenbyby the operator
^L
££))d lA
~
(A2) (A
-
denned and and bounded boundedononX X(see, (see,e.g., e.g., Hille & Phillips Chapter is denned Hille & Phillips [84,[84, Chapter V]). V]). Furthermore, the thefollowing followingimplications implications hold, ai,a: C, Furthermore, hold, for for ai,a: 2 £ C, /(A) == 11=* =*/(£) / ( £ ) ==I,I, /(A)
(A.3) (A.3)
/(A) A=» =»/(£) / ( £ ) ==£,£, /(A) == A
(A.4) (A.4)
a2 / 2 (A) =* =* (£) (£)==aifx{£)
+ aa2 / 2 (£), (£), +
g(£) (£). g(£) = = /i(£)/ /i(£)/2 (£).
(A.5) (A.5) (A.6) (A.6)
Apart from from these theseproperties, properties,there there exist some other premises allowing Apart exist some other premises allowing us tous to think of of the the operator operator/(£) / ( £ )given givenbyby(A.2) (A.2) a function of £. above think as as a function of £. TheThe above representation thethe Dunford operator calculus formula. representation (A.2) (A.2)isisoften oftencalled called Dunford operator calculus formula. Next defining functions of closed unbounded Next we we consider considerpossibilities possibilitiesofof defining functions of closed unbounded operators. it it suffices to deal withwith sectorial oper-operoperators. Actually, Actually,for forour ourpurposes purposes suffices to deal sectorial ators. ators. x
neighbourhoodof aa set set Q QCCCCwe wemean mean any any open open set containing containing C\Q. C\Q. By a neighbourhood
A.2. BOUNDED AND SECTORIAL SECTORIAL OPERATORS OPERATORS
259 259
Let now £ G <$(>, c) for some some <?/?G G (0,TT/2) and
(A.7) (A.7) (A-8)
|/(A) - /(oo)| < C(l + |A|)-^
(A.9) (A.9)
for all A e E ^ + a.
By Lemma A.I there exist exist aa ipi ipi G G(0, (0,??))and and an an i? i? >> 00such such that that (A.I) (A.I) holds. holds. Then, letting, for any 6 > > 0, 0, E$ E$be be the the contour contour given given by by3$ 3$ == 9(E 9(E Vl owing to (A.I) and to the the accepted accepted conditions conditions on on /(A) /(A) the the expression expression
/(£) = /(oo)/ + ^ r j [
(/(A) (/(A) -- /(oo)) /(oo)) (A/ (A/ -- £)£)-xdA
(A.10)
makes sense and defines aa linear linear bounded bounded operator operator on on XX for for any anyfixed fixedee>>00 subject to i? + e > 0. It is is easy easy to to show, show, using using Cauchy's Cauchy's Theorem Theorem (see, (see,e.g., e.g., Hille & Phillips [84, Theorem Theorem 3.11.1]), 3.11.1]), that that the the definition definition ofof /(£) /(£) does does not not depend on e. Moreover, by by Cauchy's Cauchy's Theorem Theorem there there exist exist other other deformations deformations of the integration path in in (A. (A.10), 10), which which are are tolerable tolerable as as far far as asitit isisregulated regulated by the accepted conditions conditions on on ££ and and /(A). /(A). Further, Further, by by standard standard means means (cf. Taylor [160] or Hille & & Phillips Phillips [84, [84, Chapter Chapter V]) V]) itit isis established established that that the properties (A.3), (A.5), (A.5), and and (A.6) (A.6) are are still still in in force force while while (A.4) (A.4) isis now now absurd for the reason that that formula formula (A. (A.10) 10) involves involves bounded bounded functions functions only. only. In principle, following Taylor Taylor [160] [160] one one could could show show that that formula formula (A.10) (A.10)pospossesses all the features that that are are intrinsic intrinsic in in an an operator operator calculus, calculus, dealing dealingwith with the class of functions /(A) /(A) with with the the above above stated stated properties properties (A.7) (A.7)—(A.9). —(A.9). Fortunately, there is no necessity necessity in in showing showing this this fact fact because, because, for for the the aims aims of this book, it suffices to to treat treat the the algebra algebra of of functions functions which which isis constituted constituted by e~x and all suitable rational functions. functions. At At the the same same time, time, ifif /(A) /(A) isisaararational function, using Cauchy's Cauchy's Theorem Theorem yields yields that that formula formula (A.10) (A.10) defines defines /(£) just the same as Taylor's Taylor's operator operator calculus calculus formula formula (see (see [84, [84, Formula Formula (5.11.2)]), while in the case the operaoperacase /(A) /(A) == e~ e~x, applying (A.10) defines the £ tor e~ in conformity with semigroup semigroup theory theory (see, (see, e.g., e.g., Reed Reed &: &:Simon Simon[133, [133, Section X.8]). Nevertheless, Nevertheless, we we remark, remark, following following [160], that if /(A) satisfies (A.7) —(A.9) and if with with some some m mG GN, N, there exists a finite limit g(oo) g(oo) == lim lim (/(A) (/(A) A Am),
(A.11)
|X|-.oo,
for any fixed ip G (0, ip), it then holds, with g(X) = = /(A)A /(A)Am, for u G Dom£ m , = /(£)£ m,
(A.12) (A.12)
260
APPENDIX A.A. FUNCTIONS FUNCTIONSOF OF LINEAR OPERATORS OPERATORS APPENDIX LINEAR
where and (£) (£)are aredenned dennedbyby(A.10). (A.10). where //((££)) and The above above reasoning reasoningcan canbe beextended extendedtotothe thecase case where € S(M; ip, a), where £ £ € S(M; 1, ip ip G G (0,7r/2), (0,7r/2), crcr££ MM(see (seeRemark Remark6.4). 6.4).Since, Since,according according M > 1, to to ourour assumptions, the the constant constantMMvaries variesconsiderably considerablyafterwards, afterwards, cannot assumptions, wewe cannot nownow Lemma A.I A.I ininorder ordertotoobtain obtain(A. (A. 10).AtAtthe the same time, if we assume apply Lemma 10). same time, if we assume addition to to the the conditions conditions (A.7) (A.7) (A.9) (A.9)that that£ £G G S(M;ipi,a) with with in addition S(M;ipi,a) with the the same same < (0,TT/2) and aa G G IK IK as as above, above, ipi G G (0, (0,ip) and with ?/?GG(0, some ipi formula (A.10) (A.10) remains remainsvalid validwith withR R> >max{—a, max{—a, even if the then formula 0}0} even if the sizesize of of varies considerably; considerably; however, however,the theinfluence influenceof ofMMclearly clearly appears M varies appears in in anyany estimates involving involvingthe thenorms normsofoffunctions functionsofofthe theoperator operator Note estimates £. £.Note alsoalso thatthat the new new assumption assumptionon on££the theadditional additionalcondition condition(A.(A. implies, under the 11)11) implies, as as above, (A. (A.12). 12). above, the next next section sectionwe weconsider consideralso alsoother otherfunctions functionsof of sectorial operators. In the sectorial operators.
A.3 Fractional Fractional powers powersof operators operators Fractional powers are areusually usuallydefined definedforforsectorial sectorialoperators, operators, however, if the Fractional powers however, if the operator in in question questionisisunbounded, unbounded,one onethen thenmeets meets certain technical difficuloperator certain technical difficul(see, e.g., e.g., Komatsu Komatsu [93]). [93]).AtAtthe thesame sametime, time,forforthethe aims book, ties (see, aims of of thisthis book, suffices to to treat treat the thepositive positivefractional fractionalpowers powers bounded sectorial operait suffices of of bounded sectorial operaand certain certain negative negativefractional fractionalpowers powersofofsectorial sectorial operators possessing tors and operators possessing a bounded bounded inverse, inverse, which whichfacilitates facilitatesour ourconsideration. consideration. (0,TT/2). In principle, principle, there there first ££ G GS(tp,0) S(tp,0) flflB(X) B(X) for forsome someipipGG(0,TT/2). Let first several ways ways equivalent equivalenttotoeach eachother otherthat thatdefine definethethe fractional powers are several fractional powers 0. For For the the sake sakeofofbeing beingdefinite, definite,wewe take definition suggested £^, £ >> 0. take thethe definition suggested by by Balakrisnan [45] [45] (cf. (cf. also alsoKomatsu Komatsu[93]), [93]),avoiding avoidingthethedifficulties difficulties that Balakrisnan that areare proper for for unbounded unbounded operators. operators. More Moreprecisely, precisely,given given £ G — l,m)for for proper £G (m(m — l,m) N, the the operator operator £^ £^isisintroduced introducedbyby m G N,
=
J_ / A^ m £ m (AI -
£)-x dA, £)-
(A.13) (A.13)
where H H == dY.^, dY.^, while while£^ £^isisdefined definedininthe thestandard standardway way is an integer. where if £if is£ an integer. 2 then follows follows from from [45, [45,93] 93]that that It then £*£" == ££€+r)
0. for f,f, r/r/ >> 0.
(A. 14) (A. 14)
significant that that since since££isisbounded, bounded,bybyCauchy's Cauchy's Theorem conIt is significant Theorem thethe contour E E in in (A.13) (A.13) can canbe bereplaced replacedbybya asuitable suitableclosed closed (that finite) contour, (that is, is, finite) contour, 2
B(X). We take take into into account accountthat that£ e B(X).
A.3.
FRACTIONAL
POWERS POWERS OF OF OPERATORS OPERATORS
261 261
sufficiently for instance, E can be replaced replaced by by EL EL == <9(£ <9(£vn£>(L)) with L > 0 sufficiently large. Now let £ e S((f,0) for for some some
/ \ 2m JE
where the contour S is is defined defined the the same same as as above. above. Also, Also, itit isis proved proved inin aa 3 standard way (see, e.g., e.g., Krein Krein [96, [96, Chapter Chapter I,I, Theorem Theorem 5.1] 5.1] ) that
£-«£-*? = £-K+»7)
for for
£, 1£, T) > 0 such that £ + r? < 1-
(A.16) (A.16)
In principle, £~^ is defined defined for for any any ££ >> 00 and and the the property property (A.16) (A.16) isis then then valid for any £, r\ > 0, but but we we do do not not deal deal with with such such an an extension. extension. It is clear that the integral integral representations representations (A. (A.13) 13) and and (A.15) (A.15) are are related related to the operator calculus calculus formulas formulas (A.2) (A.2) and and (A.10). (A.10).4 Moreover, it appears that fractional powers are are included included in in the the algebra algebra of of functions functions ofof aa bounded bounded sectorial operator, as stated stated in in the the following following result. result. T h e o r e m A . 3 . Let £ G G 5(^,0) 5(^,0) nn B(X) B(X) for for
In fact, this is established established with with the the aid aid of of the the representations representations (A.2) (A.2) and and (A.13) by using a standard standard argument argument (see, (see, e.g., e.g., Krein Krein [96, [96, Chapter Chapter I,I, Section Section 5]). We state also the so-called so-called convexity convexity inequality. inequality. 3 It is assumed in [96] that the the operator operator in in question question has has dense densedomain. domain. This This assumption assumption is not really needed for showing showing (A.16). (A.16). 4 The difference is that the the integrand integrand in in (A.13) (A.13) and and (A.15) (A.15) isis unbounded unbounded (at (at 0), 0), asas a function of A. It is easily easily seen seen that that the the corresponding corresponding integrals integrals nevertheless nevertheless converge converge under the accepted conditions. conditions. 5 In principle, HL may be replaced replaced by by another another closed closed contour, contour, among among those those which which are are obtained by a deformation deformation of of EL EL within within the the bounds bounds of ofpossibility, possibility,as asregulated regulatedby byCauchy's Cauchy's Theorem.
262
APPENDIX APPENDIX A. A. FUNCTIONS FUNCTIONS OF OF LINEAR LINEAR
OPERATORS OPERATORS
Theorem A.4. Let £ <<==S(?,0) S(?,0) D DB(X) B(X) for for some some
for all u EX.
(A.18) (A.18)
If instead of £ € S(3£) i£ i£ is is assumed assumed that that £~ £~ x € 23(3£), £/ie iosf estimate estimate holds holds rf 7 with £""£ and £~ in p/ace o/£^ and fi *, respectively, where £ + 77 < 1. For a proof, see, e.g., Krein [96, Chapter Chapter I,I, Theorem Theorem 5.2]. 5.2].
A.4
Functions of ordered ordered non-commutative non-commutative operoperators
To meet our needs it suffices suffices to to discuss discuss the the subject subject for for bounded bounded operators operators only. Let therefore £ i ,,££22 €€ B(X) B(X) and and let let Si Si and and HH2 be closed contours surrounding the spectrum spectrum of of £1 £1 and and that that of of £2, £2, respectively. respectively. Let Let further further 2 /(A2, Ai) be a holomorphic function function on on aa connected connected set set in in CC containing £2 x Hi in its interior. By By the the Dunford Dunford operator operator calculus calculus formula formula (A.2), (A.2), one one can define the operator operator )= - ^ /
2TU J
/(A 2,A)(A 2/-£2)-1dA2.
It is readily ascertained ascertained that that /(£2,A) /(£2,A) isis aa (#(£))-valued (#(£))-valued holomorphic holomorphic funcfunction of A on a connected connected set set containing containing Hi Hi in in its its interior. interior. This This fact fact further further yields that the expression expression
£i)]] -
J
/(£ 2,A)(A/-£1)-1dA
(A.19)
makes sense and defines defines aa linear linear bounded bounded operator operator on on X. X. 2
1
Definition A . I . The operator operator [[/(£2,£i)]] [[/(£2,£i)]] given given by by (A.19) (A.19) isis called calledaafuncfunction of ordered operators. operators. In fact, the above notation notation arises arises from from Maslov Maslov [111]: the indices over operators show the order order in in which which they they act act while while autonomous autonomous brackets brackets ]] are employed to restrict restrict the the region region where where this this symbolism symbolism isis valid. valid. It is easily checked that that if, if, with with Vj Vj CC C, C, jj — —1,2, 1,2, some some open open disks disks cencentered at 0 and containing containing Hj, Hj, jj = = 1,2, 1,2, respectively, respectively, /(A2, /(A2,Ai) Ai) isis holomorphic holomorphic in the bidisk T>i x T>\ so that /(A2)A!)=
A.4. FUNCTIONS FUNCTIONS OF OF ORDERED ORDERED OPERATORS OPERATORS
263 263
then the expression expression oo
JlJ2=0
defines a linear linear bounded bounded operator operator on on XX which whichcoincides coincideswith withthat thatgiven givenbyby (A.19).
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
Appendix B
Linear Cauchy Problems Problems in in Banach Space Here we give a brief report of introductive facts from from the theory of linear abstract differential equations. equations. Let there be given a complex Banach space X, an interval [0, T], a linear (generally, unbounded) operator operator A(t) : D o m i ( t ) C X —> X depending on t e [0,T], a function /(£) : [0,T] —> X, and a vector y° G 36. We consider the following Cauchy problem problem yt + A(t)y = f(t)
forO
y(0) y(0) == y°. y°.
(B.I) (B.I)
By a classical solution of problem (B.I) we mean any function y(t) : [0, T] —> X that is strongly continuously differentiable differentiable in (0, T] and strongly continuand fits the ous at 0, possesses the property y(t) € Dom A(t) for t G (0,T] and differential equation and the initial condition in (B.I). For brevity, we say everywhere in the book solution instead of classical solution. In the parabolic case, which is under consideration in this book, the unique solvability of problem (B.I) is extensively examined in the literature. For the earliest results, we refer to Sobolevskii [148] and Tanabe [159], where the situation when A(t) has dense, constant 1 domain is studied. In the case of variable or nondense domains, more more or less recent results are contained in Amann [9] or Lunardi [108]. However, for showing convergence, higher regularity results results are needed, about which not much is known, particTherefore, in the general case with ularly for variable or nondense domains. Therefore, a variable operator, in order to avoid quoting isolated results results of higher reglr
That is, independent of t 265
266 266
APPENDIX B. CAUCHY CAUCHYPROBLEMS PROBLEMS INBANACH BANACH SPACE SPACE APPENDIX B. IN
toorestrictive restrictiveconditions, conditions, weassume assumethe theunique unique ularity,posed posed often under too we ularity, often under solvability ofproblem problem(B.I) (B.I) and muchregularity regularity asneeded. needed. solvability of and asas much as Howeverwe weact actdifferently differentlyin inthe thecase casewhere where theoperator operatorA(t) A(t)isisindeindeHowever the oft22t since sincein in Chapter Chapter77 we wedeal deal with witherror error estimates interms termsof of pendent estimates in pendent of the data.It It isisknown knownthat that if AAG GS((p,a) S((p,a) for forsome some
for t 0, > 0, for t>
(B.2)(B.2)
2-rn7 7H 2-rn H tA makessense sense anddefines defineson onXXaalinear linearbounded bounded operator e~tA whichpossesses possesses makes and operator e~ which all the theproperties propertiesof ofholomorphic holomorphic semigroups, continuity at00 all semigroups, exceptexcept strong strong continuity at unless A has has densedomain domain (see,e.g., e.g.,Sinestrari Sinestrari[146]). [146]). Inthe theautonomous autonomous unless A a adense (see, In weemploy employthe theconcept conceptof ofextended extendedsolution solution andits its development introcase we case and development introduced further. duced further.
Definition B. .I I. .Under Underthe theassumptions assumptionsthatthat AG GS(ip,a) S(ip,a) for forsome some ip ip GG Definition B A (0,TT/2) andaaGG and that f(t) f(t) isisstrongly stronglycontinuous continuous fort tGG [0,T] T ]; the the (0,TT/2) and NN and that for [0, function function ;
((
B B
.
. 3
3)
)
3 is calledthe theextended extendedsolution solution ofproblem problem (B.I). (B.I). is called of
Definition B..22. .Suppose Supposethat that AG GS((p,a), S((p,a), f(t) f(t) isis times strongly strongly continDefinition B A pp times continuously differentiate differentiate uously for fort tGG [0,T], [0,T], and andy?.s y?.sG GDomTl, DomTl,jj = =0 0,,... . ,p ,p . — —1, 1,for for some tpG G(0,7r/2), (0,7r/2),a aG GN, N,and andp pG GN, N,where where some tp y°0) = y° y°and and y°{j) - f^f^l\0) y° y° \0) 0) = {j) -
Ayf^, j =j 11= ,p . -- 1.1. - -Ayf^, ,,... . ,p
(B.4) (B.4)
Then Then the thefunction functiony(t) y(t)given givenby by(B.3) (B.3) isis called calledthe thep-th p-th order orderextended extended solution solution (B.I). of of problem problem (B.I).
It isnot nothard hard to tosee, see,using usingthe theproperties propertiesof ofthe theintegral integralin in (B.2) (B.2)(see, (see, It is e.g., Sinestrari [146]), thep-th p-th orderextended extended solution of(B.I) (B.I)obeys obeys e.g., Sinestrari [146]), that that the order solution of = //^^""^^( O (O Ay^_ the equality, equality, with the with y°{p) = ) )-- Ay^_ {p)y° x), x) s)A {v tA yW(t) =e' e'tA y°{p) + (( ee-{t{t-s)A \s) yW(t) = y° f{v\s) {p) + Jo o 2
ds forfor > 0. (B.5)(B.5) ds t >t 0.
wewrite writetherefore therefore Ainstead insteadof of A(t). A(t). In In this thiscase case we A If y° y°ee Cl(Dom Cl(DomA), A),the the concept conceptof ofextended extendedsolution solution coincides coincides with that withof of that mild mildsolution solution If e.g.,Sinestrari Sinestrari[146]). [146]). however the that extendedsolution solution isdefined definedunder under the (cf., (cf., e.g., NoteNote however that the extended is the acceptedconditions conditions ify° y°££Cl(Dom Cl(Dom A). accepted eveneven if A). 3
267 Observe that it is then not not necessary necessary that that y9 y9 -. G Dom A. Also, it is worth worth noting that the conditions conditions imposed imposed on on f(t) f(t) and and y9.,, y9.,, jj == 00,,.. . . ,p,p — 1, in Definition B.2 express, in in fact, fact, aa certain certain kind kind of of time time regularity regularity for for y(t). y(t). In In particular, the extended extended solution solution of of order order >> 11 isis simultaneously simultaneously aa solution solution of (B.I), as it follows from from Sinestrari Sinestrari [146, [146, Theorem Theorem 4.4]. 4.4].
This Page is Intentionally Left Blank
Bibliography [1] S. Abarbanel, D. Gottlieb, and M. H. Carpenter, On the removal of boundary errors caused by Runge-Kutta integration integration of nonlinear partial differential equations, SIAM SIAM J. Sci. Comput. 17(1996), 777-782. 777-782. [2] Sh. Agmon, On the eigenfunctions and on the eigenvalues of general elliptic boundary value problems, problems, Comm. Comm. Pure Pure Appl. Appl. Math. Math. 15(1962), 15(1962), 119-147. near the boundary [3] S. Agmon, A. Douglis, and L. Nirenberg, Estimates near for solutions of elliptic partial differential differential equations equations satisfying satisfying general general Math. 12(1959), 12(1959), 623boundary conditions. I, II, Comm. Pure Appl. Math. 727; 17(1964), 35-92.
[4] G. Akrivis and M. Crouzeix, Linearly implicit implicit methods methods for nonlinear parabolic equations, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 73(2004), 73(2004), 613-635. 613-635. Implicit-explicit [5] G. Akrivis, M. Crouzeix, and Ch. Makridakis, Implicit-explicit multstep methods for quasilinear parabolic equations, equations, Numer. Numer. Math. Math. 82(1999), 521-541.
[6] G. Akrivis, O. Karakashian, and F. Karakatsani, Linearly implicit implicit equations, Numer. Numer. Math. Math. 94(2003), 94(2003), methods for nonlinear evolution equations, 403-418. [7] G. Akrivis and Ch. Makridakis, Galerkin time-stepping time-stepping methods methods for nonlinear parabolic equations, equations, M2AN M2AN 38(2004), 38(2004), 261-289. 261-289. [8] G. Akrivis, Ch. Makridakis, and R. H. Nochetto, A posteriori error estimates for the Crank-Nicolson for parabolic equations, to appear in
Math. Comp. [9] H. Amann, Linear and Quasilinear Parabolic Problems. Problems. Vol.1. Abstract Linear Theory, Birkhauser Birkhauser Verlag, Verlag, Basel Basel - Boston - Berlin, 1995. 269
270
BIBLIOGRAPHY BIBLIOGRAPHY
[10] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability theory theory of of difference difference schemes schemes inin arbitrary arbitrary norms, Dokl. Akad. Nauk Nauk SSSR SSSR 297(1987), 297(1987), 275-279 275-279 (in (in Russian); Russian); EnEnglish transl. in Soviet Math. Math. Dokl. Dokl. 36(1988). 36(1988). [11] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability theory theory of of difference difference schemes schemes for for parabolic parabolic equations in arbitrary norms. norms. Part Part 1, 1, Vopr. Vopr. Atomn. Atomn. Nauki Nauki ii Tekhniki, Tekhniki, ser. Metodi i Progr. Chisl. Chisl. Reshen. Reshen. Zadach Zadach Matem. Matem. Fiz. Fiz. (1987), (1987), Iss. Iss. 1,1, 69-75 (in Russian). [12] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability theory theory of of difference difference schemes schemes for for parabolic parabolic equations in arbitrary norms. norms. Part Part 2, 2, Vopr. Vopr. Atomn. Atomn. Nauki Nauki ii Tekhniki, Tekhniki, ser. Metodi i Progr. Chisl. Chisl. Reshen. Reshen. Zadach Zadach Matem. Matem. Fiz. Fiz. (1987), (1987), Iss. Iss.2,2, 29-34 (in Russian). [13] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability theory theory of of additive additive difference difference schemes schemes inin BaBanach norms, Deposited in in VINITI, VINITI, No. No. 6044-88, 6044-88, 1988 1988 (in (in Russian). Russian). [14] N. Yu. Bakaev, On On the the resolvent resolvent bound bound of of the the second second order order difference difference operator with aperiodic boundary boundary conditions, conditions, Probl. Probl. Sovr. Sovr. Teor. Teor. PeriPeriodich. Dvizhen. 9(1988), 9(1988), 73-84 73-84 (in (in Russian). Russian).
[15] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability theory theory of of additive additive difference difference schemes schemes inin BaBanach spaces, Dokl. Akad. Akad. Nauk Nauk SSSR SSSR 305(1989), 305(1989), 18-21 18-21 (in (in Russian); Russian); English transl. in Soviet Soviet Math. Math. Dokl. Dokl. 39(1989). 39(1989). [16] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability estimates estimates for for aa certain certain general general discretization discretization method, Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR SSSR 309(1989), 309(1989), 11-15 11-15 (in (in Russian); Russian); EnEnglish transl. in Soviet Math. Math. Dokl. Dokl. 40(1990). 40(1990). [17] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability estimates estimates of of difference difference schemes schemes for for aa differendifferential equation with constant constant operator. operator. I,I, Partial Partial Diff. Eqs., Novosibirsk, AN SSSR, Siberian Division, Division, 1989, 1989, 3-14 3-14 (in (in Russian). Russian). [18] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability estimates estimates of of difference difference schemes schemes for for aa differendifferential equation with constant constant operator.II, operator.II, Embed. Embed. Theorems Theorems Appls Appls Probls Probls Math. Phys., Novosibirsk, Novosibirsk, SO SO AN AN SSSR, SSSR, 1989, 1989, 18-37 18-37 (in (in Russian). Russian). [19] N. Yu. Bakaev, Investigation Investigation of of aa certain certain class class of of difference difference schemes schemes for an equation with variable variable operator, operator, Deposited Deposited in in VINITI, VINITI, No. No.7324732489, Minsk, 1989 (in Russian). Russian). [20] N. Yu. Bakaev, On On the the well-posedness well-posedness of of difference difference problems problems with with gengeneralized input data, Dokl. Dokl. Akad. Akad. Nauk Nauk SSSR SSSR 314(1990), 314(1990), 1293-1297 1293-1297 (in (in Russian); English transl. transl. in in Soviet Soviet Math. Math. Dokl. Dokl. 42(1991), 42(1991), 624-629. 624-629.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
271 271
[21] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability estimates estimates for for some some splitting splitting difference difference schemes, Probl. Sovr. Teor. Teor. Periodich. Periodich. Dvizhen. Dvizhen. 10(1990), 10(1990), 56-58 56-58 (in (in Russian).
[22] N. Yu. Bakaev, On On the the stability stability of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods for for abstract abstract linear equations, Ukranian Ukranian Math. Math. J. J. 42(1990), 42(1990), 689-694 689-694 (in (in Russian). Russian). [23] N. Yu. Bakaev, Investigation Investigation of of stability stability of of some some two-layer two-layer difference difference schemes, Zhurn. Vychisl. Vychisl. Mat. Mat. ii Mat. Mat. Fiz. Fiz. 30(1990), 30(1990), 151-156 151-156 (in (in RusRussian); English transl. in Comput. Comput. Maths Maths Math. Math. Phys. Phys. [24] N. Yu. Bakaev, On On the the stability stability of of weighted weighted difference difference schemes, schemes, UkraUkranian Math. J. 42(1990), 42(1990), 1254-1258 1254-1258 (in (in Russian). Russian). [25] N. Yu. Bakaev, On On the the stability stability of of some some difference difference problems problems with with smoothing operators, Zhurn. Zhurn. Vychisl. Vychisl. Mat. Mat. ii Mat. Mat. Fiz. Fiz. 31(1991), 31(1991), 75-85 75-85 (in Russian); English transl. transl. in in Comput. Comput. Maths Maths Math. Math. Phys. Phys. [26] N. Yu. Bakaev, Stability Stability estimates estimates of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods for for differdifferential equations with variable variable operator, operator, Ukranian Ukranian Math. Math. J.J. 43(1991), 43(1991), 280-283 (in Russian). [27] N. Yu. Bakaev, Conditional Conditional stability stability estimates estimates of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methmethods for an equation with with variable variable operator, operator, Ukranian Ukranian Math. Math. J.J. 43(1991), 572-575 (in Russian). Russian).
[28] N. Yu. Bakaev, Multistep Multistep difference difference method method for for parabolic parabolic equations, equations, Zhurn. Vychisl. Mat. i Mat. Mat. Fiz. Fiz. 32(1992), 32(1992), 261-276 261-276 (in (in Russian); Russian); EnEnglish transl. in Comput. Comput. Maths Maths Math. Math. Phys. Phys. 32(1992), 32(1992), 216-228. 216-228. [29] N. Yu. Bakaev, To To the the theory theory of of difference difference operators operators in in LLvh spaces, Vopr. Atomn. Nauki ii Tekhniki, Tekhniki, ser. ser. Matem. Matem. Modelir. Modelir. Fiz. Fiz. Prots. Prots. (1992), Iss. 1, 18-20 (in Russian). Russian). [30] N. Yu. Bakaev, Some Some problems problems of of well-posedness well-posedness of of difference difference schemes schemes on non-uniform grids, Zhurn. Zhurn. Vychisl. Vychisl. Mat. Mat. ii Mat. Mat. Fiz. Fiz. 33(1993), 33(1993),561561577 (in Russian); English English transl. transl. in in Comput. Comput. Maths Maths Math. Math. Phys. Phys. 33 33 (1993), 511-524. [31] N. Yu. Bakaev, On On the the bounds bounds of of approximations approximations of of holomorphic holomorphic semisemigroups, BIT 35(1995), 605-608. 605-608. [32] N. Yu. Bakaev, A A priori priori estimates estimates for for some some classes classes ofof difference difference schemes, Canad. J. Math. Math. 48(1996), 48(1996), 244-257. 244-257.
272
BIBLIOGRAPHY BIBLIOGRAPHY
[33] N. Yu. Bakaev, The The upper upper bounds bounds for for powers powers of of linear linear operators operators and and some applications to the the stability stability analysis analysis of of difference difference problems, problems, J.J. Difference Eqs. Appl. 4(1998), 4(1998), 343-364. 343-364. [34] N. Yu. Bakaev, Analysis Analysis of of linear linear discrete discrete parabolic parabolic problems. problems. Part Part 1. Well-posedness of a Cauchy Cauchy problem problem for for the the evolution evolution equation equation inin discrete time, Departamento Departamento de de Matematica Matematica Aplicada Aplicada yy Computation, Computation, Facultad de Ciencias, Universidad Universidad de de Valladolid, Valladolid, Valladolid, Valladolid, Spain, Spain, Report 1997/1. [35] N. Yu. Bakaev, Analysis Analysis of of linear linear discrete discrete parabolic parabolic problems. problems. Part Part 2.2. Well-posedness of single single step step time-discrete time-discrete approximations approximations to to abstract abstract parabolic equations, Departamento Departamento de de Matematica Matematica Aplicada Aplicada yy ComComputation, Facultad de Ciencias, Ciencias, Universidad Universidad de de Valladolid, Valladolid, Valladolid, Valladolid, Spain, Report 1998/6. [36] N. Yu. Bakaev, On On variable variable stepsize stepsize Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta approximations approximations ofofaa Cauchy problem for the the evolution evolution equation, equation, BIT BIT 38(1998), 38(1998), 462-485. 462-485. [37] N. Yu. Bakaev, Analysis Analysis of of discretizations discretizations of of parabolic parabolic problems problems inin pairs of spaces, BIT 40(2000), 40(2000), 1-23. 1-23. [38] N. Yu. Bakaev, Maximum Maximum norm norm resolvent resolvent estimates estimates for for elliptic elliptic finite finite element operators, BIT 41(2001), 41(2001), 215-239. 215-239. [39] N. Yu. Bakaev, Resolvent Resolvent estimates estimates of of elliptic elliptic differential differential and and finitefiniteelement operators in pairs pairs of of function function spaces, spaces, Intern. Intern. J.J. Math. Math. Math. Math. Sciences 2004:5(2004), 2004:5(2004), 217-238. 217-238. [40] N. Yu. Bakaev, S. S. Larsson, Larsson, and and V. V. Thomee, Thomee, Backward Backward Euler Euler type type methods for parabolic integro-differential integro-differential equations equations in in Banach Banach space, space, RAIRO Model. Math. Anal. Anal. Numer. Numer. 32(1998), 32(1998), 85-99. 85-99.
[41] N. Yu. Bakaev, S. S. Larsson, Larsson, and and V. V. Thomee, Thomee, Long Long time time behavior behavior ojoj backward difference type type methods methods for for parabolic parabolic equations equations with with memory memory in Banach space, East-West East-West J. J. Numer. Numer. Math. Math. 6(1998), 6(1998), 185-206. 185-206. [42] N. Bakaev and A. Ostermann, Ostermann, Long-term Long-term stability stability of of variable variable stepsize stepsize approximations of semigroups, semigroups, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 71(2002), 71(2002), 1545-1567. 1545-1567.
[43] N. Yu. Bakaev, V. V. Thomee, Thomee, and and L. L. B. B. Wahlbin, Wahlbin, Maximum-norm Maximum-norm estimates for resolvents resolvents of of finite finite element element operators, operators, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 72(2003), 1597-1610.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
273 273
[44] N. Yu. Bakaev and and V. V. V. V. Vyazankin, Vyazankin, The The stability stability ofof difference difference schemes approximating parabolic parabolic differential differential equations equations on on nonuniform nonuniform grids, VANT, ser. Mat. Mat. Modelir. Modelir. Fiz. Fiz. Prots. Prots. 2(1991), 2(1991), 20-24 20-24 (in (in RusRussian) .
[45] A. V. Balakrishnan, Balakrishnan, Fractional Fractional powers powers of of closed closed operators operators and and the the semigroups generated by by them, them, Pacific Pacific J.J. Math. Math. 10(1960), 10(1960), 419-437. 419-437. [46] J. Becker, A second second order order backward backward difference difference method method with with variable variable steps for a parabolic problem, problem, BIT BIT 38(1998), 38(1998), 644-662. 644-662. [47] W.-J. Beyn and B. B. M. M. Garay, Garay, Estimates Estimates of of variable variable stepsize stepsize RungeRungeKutta methods for sectorial sectorial evolution evolution equations equations with with nonsmooth nonsmooth data, data, Appl. Numer. Math. 41(2002), 41(2002), 369-400. 369-400. [48] N. Borovykh, D. Drissi, Drissi, and and M. M. N. N. Spijker, Spijker, AA note note about about Ritt's Ritt's condicondition, related resolvent conditions conditions and and power power bounded boundedoperators, operators, Numer. Numer. Funct. Anal, and Optimiz. Optimiz. 21(2000), 21(2000), 425-438. 425-438. [49] J. H. Bramble, A. H. H. Schatz, Schatz, V. V. Thomee, Thomee, and and L. L. B. B. Wahlbin, Wahlbin, Some Some convergence estimates for for semidiscrete semidiscrete Galerkin Galerkin type type approximations approximations for parabolic equations, SIAM SIAM J. J. Numer. Numer. Anal. Anal. 14(1977), 14(1977), 218-241. [50] Ph. Brenner, M. Crouzeix, Crouzeix, and and V. V. Thomee, Thomee, Single Single step step methods methods for for inhomogeneous linear differential differential equations equations in in Banach Banach space, space, RAIRO RAIRO Anal. Numer. 16(1982), 16(1982), 5-26. 5-26. [51] Ph. Brenner and V. V. Thomee, Thomee, Stability Stability and and convergence convergence rates rates inin LLp for certain difference schemes, schemes, Math. Math. Scand. Scand. 27(1970), 27(1970), 5-23. 5-23. [52] Ph. Brenner and V. V. Thomee, Thomee, On On rational rational approximations approximations ofof semisemigroups, SIAM J. Numer. Numer. Anal. Anal. 16(1979), 16(1979), 683-694. 683-694. [53] J. C. Butcher, The The Numerical Numerical Analysis Analysis of of Ordinary Ordinary Differential Differential EquaEquations: Runge-Kutta and and General General Linear Linear Methods, Methods, J.J. Wiley Wiley &; &; Sons, Sons, Chichester, 1987.
[54] M. Calvo and R. D. D. Grigorieff, Time discretization of of parabolic parabolic probproblems with the variable 3-step 3-step BDF, BDF, BIT BIT 42(2002), 42(2002), 689-701. 689-701. [55] M. P. Calvo and C. C. Palencia, Palencia, Avoiding Avoiding the the order order reduction reduction ofof RungeRungeKutta methods for linear linear initial initial boundary boundary value value problems, problems, Math. Math. Comp. 71(2002), 1529-1543. 1529-1543.
274
BIBLIOGRAPHY BIBLIOGRAPHY
[56] S. Campanato, Generation Generation of analytic semigroups by elliptic operators of second order in Holder spaces, Ann. Sc. Norm. Sup. Pisa 8(1981), 495-512. The [57] M. H. Carpenter, D. Gottlieb, S. Abarbanel, and W. S. Don, The theoretical accuracy of Runge-Kutta time discretizations discretizations for the initial boundary value problem: problem: a study of the boundary error, SIAM J. Sci. Comput. 16(1995), 1241-1252. 1241-1252. [58] F. Colombo and V. Vespri, Generation of analytic semigroups in Wk'p(Q) and Ck(Q,), Diff. Integr. Equations 9(1996), 9(1996), 421-436. 421-436. [59] M. Crouzeix, Sur Vapproximation des equations differentielles differentielles operationnelles lineaires lineaires par des methodes de Runge-Kutta, These, Universite Paris VI, 1975. [60] M. Crouzeix, On multistep approximation approximation of semigroups in Banach 20(1987), 25-35. 25-35. spaces, J. Comput. Appl. Math. 20(1987), [61] M. Crouzeix, S. Larsson, S. Piskarev, and V. Thomee, The stability of rational approximations of analytic semigroups, BIT 33(1993), 74-84. estimates for ellip[62] M. Crouzeix, S. Larsson, and V. Thomee, Resolvent estimates tic finite element operators operators in one dimension, Math. Comp. Comp. 63(1994), 63(1994), 121-140.
[63] M. Crouzeix and F. J. Lisbona, The convergence of variable-stepsize, variable-formula, multistep multistep methods, methods, SIAM SIAM J. Numer. Anal. 21(1984), 21(1984), 512-534. Approximation des Problemes [64] M. Crouzeix and P. A. Raviart, Approximation d'Evolution, Lecture notes notes (unpublished), (unpublished), Rennes Rennes 1980.
[65] K. Dekker and J. G. Verwer, Stability of Runge-Kutta Methods for Stiff Nonlinear Differntial Differntial Equations, Equations, North North Holland, Holland, AmsterdamAmsterdamNew York-Oxford, 1984. [66] J. Douglas and J. E. Gunn, Two high-order correct difference difference analogues for the equation on multi-dimensional heat heat flow, flow, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 17(1963), 71-80.
[67] O. El-Fallah and T. Ransford, Extremal growth growth of powers of operators satisfying resolvent conditions conditions of Kreiss-Ritt type, J. Function. Anal. 196(2002), 135-154.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
275 275
[68] K. Eriksson, C. Johnson, Johnson, and and S. S. Larsson, Larsson, Adaptive Adaptive finite finite element element methmethods for parabolic problems. problems. VI. VI. Analytic Analytic semigroups, semigroups, Dep. Dep. of of Math., Math., Chalmers University of Technology Technology and and Goteborg Goteborg University, University, Preprint Preprint No. 1996-32, 1996. [69] K. Eriksson, C. Johnson, Johnson, and and V. V. Thomee, Thomee, Time Time discretization discretization ofof parabolic problems by the the discontinuous discontinuous Galerkin Galerkin method, RAIRO Model. Math. Anal. Numer. Numer. 19(1985), 19(1985), 611-643. 611-643. [70] C. W. Gear and K. K. W. W. Tu, Tu, The The effect effect of of variable variable mesh mesh size size on on the the stability of multistep methods, methods, SIAM SIAM J.J. Numer. Numer. Anal. Anal. 11(1974), 11(1974), 102510251043. [71] C. Gonzalez and A. A. Ostermann, Ostermann, Optimal Optimal convergence convergence results results for for Runge-Kutta discretizations discretizations of of linear linear nonautonomous nonautonomous parabolic parabolic probproblems, BIT 39(1999), 79-95. 79-95. [72] C. Gonzalez, A. Ostermann, Ostermann, C. C. Palencia, Palencia, and and M. M. Thalhammer, Thalhammer, BackBackward Euler discretization discretization of of fully fully nonlinear nonlinear parabolic parabolicproblems, problems, Math. Math. Comp. 71(2002), 125-145. 125-145. [73] C. Gonzalez and C. C. Palencia, Palencia, Stability Stability of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods for for abstract time-dependent parabolic parabolic problems: problems: the the Holder Holder case, case, Math. Math. Comp. 68(1999), 73-89. 73-89. [74] C. Gonzalez and C. C. Palencia, Palencia, Stability Stability of of time-stepping time-stepping methods methods for for abstract time-dependent parabolic parabolic problems, problems, SIAM SIAM J.J. Numer. Numer. Anal. Anal. 35(1998), 979-989. [75] C. Gonzalez and C. C. Palencia, Palencia, Stability Stability of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods for for quasilinear parabolic problems, problems, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 69(2000), 69(2000), 609-628. 609-628. [76] R. D. Grigorieff, Stability of multistep-methods multistep-methods on on variable variable grids, grids, NuNumer. Math. 42(1983), 359-377. 359-377. [77] R. D. Grigorieff, Time discretization of semigroups semigroups by by the the variable variable twotwoTreatment of of Differential Differential Equations, Equations, step BDF method, in: Numerical Treatment K. Strehmel, ed., (NUMDIFF-5, (NUMDIFF-5, Halle Halle 1989), 1989), Teubner, Teubner, Leipzig, Leipzig, 1991, 1991, 204-216. [78] N. N. Gudovich and and A. A. A. A. Terteryan, Terteryan, On On the the stability stability ofof block block difdifference schemes for parabolic parabolic equations, equations, Dokl. Dokl. Akad. Akad. Nauk Nauk SSSR SSSR 297(1987), 531-534 (in Russian); Russian); English English transl. transl. in in Soviet Soviet Math. Math. Dokl. Dokl.
276
BIBLIOGRAPHY BIBLIOGRAPHY
[79] N. Guglielmi and M. M. Zennaro, Zennaro, On On the the zero-stability zero-stability of of variable variable stepstepsize multistep methods: the the spectral spectral radius radius approach, approach, Numer. Numer. Math. Math. 88(2001), 445-458. [80] E. Hairer, S. P. N0rsett, N0rsett, and and G. G. Wanner, Wanner, Solving Solving Ordinary Ordinary Differential Differential Equations I. Nonstiff Problems, Problems, Springer-Verlag, Springer-Verlag, Berlin, Berlin, 2nd 2nd ed., ed., 1993. 1993. [81] E. Hairer and G. Wanner, Wanner, Solving Solving Ordinary Ordinary Differential Differential Equations Equations II. Stiff and Differential-Algebraic Differential-Algebraic Problems, Problems, Springer-Verlag, Springer-Verlag, Berlin, Berlin, 1991.
[82] A. Hansbo, Nonsmooth Nonsmooth data data error error estimates estimates for for damped damped single single step step methods for parabolic equations equations in in Banach Banach space, space, Calcolo Calcolo 36(1999), 36(1999), 75-101. [83] A. Hansbo, Strong Strong stability stability and and nonsmooth nonsmooth data data error error estimates estimates for for discretizations of linear linear parabolic parabolic problems, problems, BIT BIT 42(2002), 42(2002), 351-379. 351-379. [84] E. Hille and R. S. Phillips, Phillips, Functional Functional analysis analysis and and semi-groups, semi-groups, ProvProvidence, AMS, Colloquium Colloquium Publs, Publs, vol. vol. XXXI, XXXI, 1957. 1957. [85] R. A. Horn and C. R. R. Johnson, Johnson, Matrix Matrix Analysis, Analysis, Cambridge Cambridge University University Press, Cambridge, 1985. [86] W. Hundsdorfer and and J. J. G. G. Verwer, Verwer, Numerical Numerical Solution Solution ofof TimeTimeDependent Advection-Diffusion-Reacrion Advection-Diffusion-Reacrion Equations, Equations, Springer-Verlag, Springer-Verlag, Berlin, 2003. [87] P. Jamet, Galerkin-type Galerkin-type approximations approximations which which are are discontinuous discontinuous inin time for parabolic equations equations in in aa variable variable domain, domain, SIAM SIAM J.J. Numer. Numer. Anal. 15(1978), 912-928. 912-928. [88] C. Johnson, Y.-Y. Nie, Nie, and and V. V. Thomee, Thomee, An An aaposteriori posteriori error error estimate estimate and adaptive timestep control control for for aa backward backwardEuler Euler discretization discretization ofofaa parabolic problem, SIAM SIAM J. J. Numer. Numer. Anal. Anal. 27(1990), 27(1990), 277-291. [89] N. Kalton, S. Montgomery-Smith, Montgomery-Smith, K. K. Oleszkiewicz, Oleszkiewicz, and and Yu. Yu. Tomilov, Tomilov, Power-bounded operators operators and and related related norm norm estimates, estimates, J.J. London London Math. Math. Soc. 70(2004), 463-478. [90] O. A. Karakashian, Karakashian, On On Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods for for parabolic parabolic equations equations with time-dependent coefficients, coefficients, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 47(1986), 47(1986), 77-101.
[91] T. Kato, Perturbation Perturbation Theory Theory for for Linear Linear Operators, Operators, 2nd 2nd ed., ed., Berlin, Berlin, Springer-Verlag, 1976.
BIBLIOGRAPHY BIBLIOGRAPHY
277277
[92] S. S. L. L. Keeling, Keeling, Galerkin/Runge-Kutta Galerkin/Runge-Kutta discretizations discretizationsforforparabolic parabolic equations with equations with time-dependent time-dependent coefficients, coefficients,Math. Math.Comp. Comp.52(1989), 52(1989), 561-586. 561-586. [93] H. H. Komatsu, Komatsu, Fractional Fractional powers powers ofofoperators, operators,Pacific PacificJ. J.Math. Math. 19(1966), 285-346. 19(1966), 285-346.
Interpolation of non[94] H. H. Komatsu, Komatsu, Fractional Fractionalpowers powersofofoperators, operators,VI.VI. Interpolation of nonnegative operators Sci. Univ. Tokyo, negative operators and andimbedding imbeddingtheorems, theorems,J. J.Fac. Fac. Sci. Univ. Tokyo, Sec. I A, Math. Math. 19(1972), 19(1972), 1-63. 1-63. powers of op[95] M. M. A. A. Krasnosel'skii Krasnosel'skii and andP.P.E.E.Sobolevskii, Sobolevskii,Fractional Fractional powers of operators acting 129(1959), erators acting inin Banach Banach spaces, spaces,Dokl. Dokl.Akad. Akad.Nauk NaukSSSR SSSR 129(1959), 499-502 (in 499-502 (in Russian). Russian). Nauka, [96] S. S. G. G. Krein, Krein, Linear Linear Differential DifferentialEquations Equationsin inBanach BanachSpace, Space, Nauka, Moscow, 1973 Moscow, 1973 (in (in Russian). Russian). [97] H. H. O. O. Kreiss, Kreiss, Uber Uberdie diestabilitdtsdefinition stabilitdtsdefinitionfurfurdifferenzengleichungen differenzengleichungen 2(1962), 153die partielle partielle differentialgleichungen differentialgleichungen approximieren, approximieren,BIT BIT 2(1962), 153181.
thethe dissipative typetype for for [98] H. H. O. O. Kreiss, Kreiss, On On difference differenceapproximations approximationsof of dissipative hyperbolic differential Math. 17(1964), hyperbolic differential equations, equations,Comm. Comm.Pure PureAppl. Appl. Math. 17(1964), 335-353. 335-353. [99] S. with S. Larsson, Larsson, Preservation Preservation ofofstrong strongstability stabilityassociated associated withanalytic analytic semigroups, in: Stability under semigroups, in: Collected CollectedLectures LecturesononPreservation Preservationof of Stability under Discretization, D.Estep 11-24. Discretization, D.Estepand andS.Tavener, S.Tavener,eds., eds.,SIAM, SIAM,2002, 2002, 11-24. [100] S. S. Larsson, Larsson, V. V. Thomee, Thomee,and andL.L.B.B.Wahlbin, Wahlbin,Finite Finiteelement elementmethods methods Anal. 11(1991), for a strongly strongly damped dampedwave waveequation, equation,IMA IMAJ. J.Numer. Numer. Anal. 11(1991), 115-142. 115-142. Wendroff, Difference Difference schemes schemesfor forhyperbolic hyperbolicequations equations [101] P. P. D. D. Lax Laxand andB. B. Wendroff, with high 381high order order ofof accuracy, accuracy,Comm. Comm.Pure PureAppl. Appl.Math. Math.17(1964), 17(1964), 381398. [102] M. M. N. N. Le Le Roux, Roux, Semidiscretization Semidiscretization inintime timeforforparabolic parabolic problems, problems, Math. Comp. Math. Comp. 33(1979), 33(1979), 919-931. 919-931.
[103] R. R. J.J. Le Le Veque Vequeand andL.L.N.N.Trefethen, Trefethen,OnOnthetheresolvent resolvent condition condition in the in the Kreiss Kreiss matrix matrix theorem, theorem, BIT BIT24(1984), 24(1984), 584-591. 584-591.
278
BIBLIOGRAPHY BIBLIOGRAPHY
[104] C. Lubich and O. O. Nevanlinna, Nevanlinna, On On resolvent resolvent conditions conditions and and stability stability estimates, BIT 31(1991), 31(1991), 293-313. 293-313. [105] Ch. Lubich and A. A. Ostermann, Ostermann, Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods for for parabolic parabolic equations and convolution convolution quadrature, quadrature, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 60(1993), 60(1993), 105105131.
[106] Ch. Lubich and A. A. Ostermann, Ostermann, Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta approximation approximation ofof quasiquasilinear parabolic equations, equations, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 64(1995), 64(1995), 601-627. 601-627. [107] Ch. Lubich and A. A. Ostermann, Ostermann, Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta time time discretization discretization ofof reaction-diffusion and Navier Navier Stokes Stokes equations: equations: nonsmooth-data nonsmooth-data ererror estimates and applications applications to to long-time long-time behaviour, behaviour, Appl. Appl. Numer. Numer. Math. 22(1996), 279-292. 279-292. [108] A. Lunardi, Analytic Analytic Semigroups Semigroups and and Optimal Optimal Regularity Regularity inin Parabolic Parabolic Problems, Birkhauser, Basel Basel -- Boston Boston -- Berlin, Berlin, 1995. 1995. [109] M. Luskin and R. Rannacher, Rannacher, On On the the smoothing smoothing property property ofof the the CrankCrankNicolson scheme, Appl. Appl. Anal. Anal. 14(1982), 14(1982), 117-135. 117-135. [110] Yu. Lyubich, Spectral Spectral localization, localization, power power boundedness boundedness and and invariant invariant subspaces under Ritt's type type condition, condition, Studia Studia Math. Math. 134(1999), 134(1999), 153153167. [Ill] V. P. Maslov, Operator Operator Methods, Methods, Moscow, Moscow, Nauka, Nauka, 1973 1973 (in (in Russian). Russian). [112] J. Miller and G. Strang, Strang, Matrix Matrix theorems theorems for for partial partial differential differential and and difference equations, Math. Math. Scand. Scand. 18(1966), 18(1966), 113-123. 113-123. [113] K. W. Morton, On On aa matrix matrix theorem theorem due due to to H.-O. H.-O. Kreiss, Kreiss, Comm. Comm. Pure Pure Appl. Math. 17(1964), 375-379. 375-379.
[114] B. Nagy and J. Zemanek, Zemanek, AA resolvent resolvent condition condition implying implying power power boundedness, Studia Math. 134(2)(1999), 134(2)(1999), 143-151. [115] E. Nakaguchi and and A. A. Yagi, Yagi, Error Error estimates estimates of of implicit implicit Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods for quasilinear abstract abstract equations equations of of parabolic parabolic type, type, Japan Japan J.J. Math. (N.S.) 25(1999), 181-226. 181-226. [116] O. Nevanlinna, Converegence Converegence of of Iterations Iterations of of Linear Linear Equations, Equations, Birkhauser Verlag, Basel Basel -- Boston Boston -- Berlin, Berlin, 1993. 1993.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
279 279
[117] O. Nevanlinna, On On the the growth growth of of the the resolvent resolvent operators operators for for power power bounded operators, in: Banach Banach Center Center Publ. Publ. 38, 38, Inst. Inst. Math., Math., Polish Polish Acad. Sci., 1997, 247-264. 247-264. [118] 0 . Nevanlinna, Resolvent Resolvent conditions conditions and and powers powers of of operators, operators, Studia Studia Math. 145(2)(2001), 113-134. 113-134. [119] J. A. Nitsche and and M. M. F. F. Wheeler, Wheeler, L^-boundedness L^-boundedness of of the the finite finite eleelement Galerkin operator operator for for parabolic parabolic problems, problems, Numer. Numer. Funct. Funct. Anal. Anal. Optimiz. 4(4)(1981-1982), 4(4)(1981-1982), 325-353. 325-353. [120] R. H. Nochetto, G. G. Savare, Savare, and and C. C. Verdi, Verdi, A A posteriori posteriori error error estimates estimates for variable time-step discretizations of nonlinear evolution equations, discretizations of nonlinear evolution equations, Comm. Pure Appl. Math. Math. 53(2000), 53(2000), 525-589. 525-589. [121] J. T. Oden and J. J. N. N. Reddy, Reddy, An An Introduction Introduction to to the the Mathematical Mathematical Theory of Finite Elements, Elements, New New York, York, John John Wiley, Wiley, 1976. 1976. [122] A. Ostermann, Stability Stability of of W W -methods -methods with with applications applications toto operator operator splitting and to geometric geometric theory, theory, Appl. Appl. Numer. Numer. Math. Math. 42(2002), 42(2002), 353353366. [123] A. Ostermann and and M. M. Roche, Roche, Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods methods for for partial partial differdifferential equations and fractional fractional orders orders of of convergence, convergence, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 59(1992), 403-420. [124] A. Ostermann and and M. M. Roche, Roche, Rosenbrock Rosenbrock methods methods for for partial partial differendifferential equations and fractional fractional orders orders of of convergence, convergence, SIAM SIAM J.J. Numer. Numer. Math. 30(1992), 1084-1098. 1084-1098.
[125] A. Ostermann and and M. M. Thalhammer, Thalhammer, Convergence Convergence of of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta methods for nonlinear parabolic parabolic equations, equations, Appl. Appl. Numer. Numer. Math. Math. 42(2002), 367-380. [126] A. Ostermann, M. M. Thalhammer, Thalhammer, and and G. G. Kirlinger, Kirlinger, Stability Stability ofof linear linear multistep methods and applications applications to to nonlinear nonlinear parabolic parabolic problems, problems, Appl. Numer. Math. 48(2004), 48(2004), 389-407. 389-407. [127] C. Palencia, A stability stability result result for for sectorial sectorial operators operators in in Banach Banach spaces, spaces, SIAM J. Numer. Anal. 30(1993), 30(1993), 1373-1384. 1373-1384. [128] C. Palencia, On the the stability stability of of variable variable stepsize stepsize rational rational approximaapproximations of holomorphic semigroups, semigroups, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 62(1994), 62(1994), 93-103. 93-103.
280
BIBLIOGRAPHY BIBLIOGRAPHY
[129] C. Palencia, Stability Stability of of rational rational multstep multstep approximations approximations ofof holomorholomorphic semigroups, Math. Math. Comp. Comp. 64(1995), 64(1995), 591-599. 591-599. [130] D. Pathria, The correct correct formulation formulation of of intermediate intermediate boundary boundary condiconditions for Runge-Kutta time time integration integration of of initial initial boundary boundary value valueprobproblems, SIAM J. Sci. Comput. Comput. 18(1997), 18(1997), 1255-1266. 1255-1266. [131] A. Pazy, Semigroups Semigroups of of Linear Linear Operators Operators and and Applications Applications toto Partial Partial Differential Equations, Springer Springer Verlag, Verlag, New New York, York, 1983. 1983. [132] R. Rannacher, Finite Finite element element solution solution of of diffusion diffusion problems problems with with irirregular data, Numer. Math. Math. 43(1984), 43(1984), 309-327. 309-327. [133] M. Reed and B. Simon, Simon, Methods Methods of of Modern Modern Mathematical Mathematical Physics. Physics. II: II: Fourier Analysis, Self-Adjointness, Self-Adjointness, Academic Academic Press, Press, New New York York -- San San Francisco - London, 1975. 1975. [134] M. Reed and B. Simon, Simon, Methods Methods of of Modern Modern Mathematical Mathematical Physics. Physics. IV: IV: Analysis of Operators, Academic Academic Press, Press, New New York York -- San San Francisco Francisco -London, 1978. [135] R. D. Richtmyer and and K. K. W. W. Morton, Morton, Difference Difference Methods Methods for for InitialInitialValue Problems, 2nd ed., ed., New New York, York, John John Wiley, Wiley, 1967. 1967. [136] R. K. Ritt, A condition condition that that lliinniinngg rTlTn Soc. 4(1953), 898-899.
= 0, Proc. Amer. Math. Math.
[137] E. B. Saff and R. R. S. S. Varga, Varga, On On the the zeros zeros and and poles poles of of Fade Fade approxiapproximants to expz, Numer. Numer. Math. Math. 25(1975), 25(1975), 1-14. 1-14. [138] N. Saito, Remarks on on the the rational rational approximation approximation of of holomorphic holomorphic semisemigroups with nonuniform nonuniform partitions, partitions, Japan Japan J.J. Indust. Indust. Appl. Appl. Math. Math. 21(2004), 323-337. [139] A. A. Samarskii, Theory Theory of of Difference Difference Schemes, Schemes, 2nd 2nd ed., ed., Moscow, Moscow, Nauka, 1983 (in Russian). Russian). [140] J. M. Sanz-Serna, J. J. G. G. Verwer, Verwer, and and W. W. H. H. Hundsdorfer, Hundsdorfer, Convergence Convergence and order reduction of Runge-Kutta Runge-Kutta schemes schemes applied applied to to evolutionary evolutionary problems in partial differential differential equations, equations, Numer. Numer. Math. Math. 50(1986), 50(1986), 405-418.
[141] A. H. Schatz, V. Thomee, Thomee, and and L. L. B. B. Wahlbin, Wahlbin, Maximum Maximum norm norm stability stability and error estimates in parabolic parabolic finite finite element element equations, equations, Comm. Comm. Pure Pure Appl. Math. 33(1980), 265-304. 265-304.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
281 281
[142] S. I. Serdyukova, The The uniform uniform stability stability with with respect respect to to initial initial data data of a sixpoint symmetrical symmetrical scheme scheme for for the the heat heat conduction conduction equation, equation, in: Numerical Methods Methods for for the the Solution Solution of of Differential Differential and and Integral Integral Equations and Quadrature Quadrature Formulae, Formulae, Nauka, Nauka, Moscow, Moscow, 1964, 1964, 212-216 212-216 (in Russian).
[143] S. I. Serdyukova, On On the the C-stability C-stability of of linear linear difference difference schemes schemes with with constant real-valued coefficients, coefficients, Zhurn. Zhurn. Vychisl. Vychisl. Mat. Mat. ii Mat. Mat. Fiz. Fiz. 6(1966), 477-486 (in Russian). Russian). [144] S. I. Serdyukova, The The uniform uniform stability stability of of aa sixpoint sixpoint scheme scheme ofof inincreased order of accuracy accuracy for for the the heat heat equation, equation, Zhurn. Zhurn. Vychisl. Vychisl. Mat. Mat. i Mat. Fiz. 7(1967), 214-218 214-218 (in (in Russian). Russian).
[145] S. I. Serdyukova, On On the the maximum maximum norm norm stability stability of of systems systems ofof difdifference equations, Zhurn. Zhurn. Vychisl. Vychisl. Mat. Mat. ii Mat. Mat. Fiz. Fiz. 7(1967), 7(1967), 497-509 497-509 (in Russian). [146] E. Sinestrari, On On the the abstract abstract Cauchy Cauchy problem problem of of parabolic parabolic type type inin spaces of continuous functions, functions, J. J. Math. Math. Anal. Anal. Appl. Appl. 107(1985), 107(1985), 161666. [147] I. H. Sloan and V. V. Thomee, Thomee, Time Time discretization discretization of of an an integrointegrodifferential equation of of parabolic parabolic type, type, SIAM SIAM J.J. Numer. Numer. Anal. Anal. 23(1986), 1052-1061. [148] P. E. Sobolevskii, On On the the equations equations of of parabolic parabolic type type in in Banach Banach space, space, Annals Moscow Math. Soc. Soc. 10(1961), 10(1961), 297-350 297-350 (in (in Russian). Russian).
[149] P. E. Sobolevskii, Sobolevskii, On On the the stability stability and and convergence convergence ofof the the CrankCrankNicolson difference scheme, scheme, Variat.-Difference Variat.-Difference Meths Meths in in Math. Math. Phys., Phys., Novosibirsk, AN SSSR, SSSR, Siber. Siber. Division, Division, 1973, 1973, 146-151 146-151 (in (in Russian). Russian). [150] P. E. Sobolevskii, Sobolevskii, Fractional Fractional powers powers of of coercive-positive coercive-positive sums sums ofof opoperators, Sibirsk. Mat. Zhurn. Zhurn. 18(1977), 18(1977), 637-657 637-657 (in (in Russian); Russian); Transl. Transl. into English. [151] P. E. Sobolevskii, Semigroup Semigroup theory theory and and stability stability of of difference difference schemes, schemes, in: Operator Theory in Function Function Spaces, Spaces, G.P.Akilov, G.P.Akilov, ed., ed., Novosibirsk, Novosibirsk, SO Nauka, 1977, 304-337 304-337 (in (in Russian). Russian). [152] P. E. Sobolevskii, Sobolevskii, On On the the difference difference scheme scheme of of Crank-Nicolson Crank-Nicolson for for parabolic equations, Nonlin. Nonlin. Oscil. Oscil. Control Control Theory, Theory, Izhevsk, Izhevsk, UdGU, UdGU, 1978, 98-106 (in Russian).
282
BIBLIOGRAPHY BIBLIOGRAPHY
[153] M. N. Spijker, On On aa conjucture conjucture by by Le Le Veque Veque and and Trefethen Trefethen related related toto the Kreiss matrix theorem, theorem, BIT BIT 31(1991), 31(1991), 551-555. 551-555.
[154] M. N. Spijker and and F. F. A. A. J. J. Straetemans, Straetemans, Stability Stability estimates estimates for for famifamilies of matrices of nonuniformly nonuniformly bounded bounded order, order, Linear Linear Algebra Algebra Appl. Appl. 239(1996), 77-102. [155] H. J. Stetter, Analysis Analysis of of Discretization Discretization Methods Methods for for Ordinary Ordinary DifDifferential Equations, Springer-Verlag, Springer-Verlag, Berlin Berlin -- Heidelberg Heidelberg -- New New York, York, 1973. [156] H. B. Stewart, Generation Generation of of analytic analytic semigroups semigroups by by strongly strongly elliptic elliptic operators, Trans. Amer. Amer. Math. Math. Soc. Soc. 199(1974), 199(1974), 141-162. 141-162. [157] E. Tadmor, The equivalence equivalence of of ^-stability, ^-stability, the the resolvent resolvent condition, condition, and strict H-stability, Linear Linear Algebra Algebra Appl. Appl. 41(1981), 41(1981), 151-159. 151-159.
[158] E. Tadmor, The resolvent resolvent condition condition and and uniform uniform power power boundedness, boundedness, Linear Algebra Appl. 80(1986), 80(1986), 250-252. 250-252. [159] H. Tanabe, On the the equations equations of of evolution evolution in in aa Banach Banach space, space, Osaka Osaka Math. J. 12(1960), 363-376. 363-376. [160] A. E. Taylor, Spectral Spectral theory theory of of closed closed distributive distributive operators, operators, Acta Acta Math. 84(1950), 189-224. 189-224. [161] V. Thomee, Finite Finite difference difference methods methods for for linear linear parabolic parabolic equations, equations, in: Handbook of Numerical Numerical Analysis!, Analysis!, P.G.Ciarlet P.G.Ciarlet and and J.L.Lions, J.L.Lions, eds., eds., North Holland, Amsterdam, Amsterdam, 1990, 1990, 5-196. 5-196. [162] V. Thomee, Galerkin Galerkin Finite Finite Element Element Methods Methods for for Parabolic Parabolic Problems, Problems, Springer Series in Computational Computational Mathematics, Mathematics, Springer Springer -- Verlag, Verlag, Berlin, 1997. [163] V. Thomee and L. L. B. B. Wahlbin, Wahlbin, Maximum-norm Maximum-norm stability stability and and error error estimates in Galerkin methods methods for for parabolic parabolic equations equations in in one one space space variable, Numer. Math. Math. 41(1983), 41(1983), 345-371. [164] H. Triebel, Interpolation Interpolation Theory. Theory. Function Function Spaces. Spaces. Differential Differential OperOperators, VEB Deutscher Verlag, Verlag, Berlin, Berlin, 1978. 1978. [165] P. Vitse, Functional Functional calculus calculus under under the the Tadmor-Ritt Tadmor-Ritt condition, condition, and and free interpolation by polynomials polynomials of of aa given given degree, degree, J.J. Funct. Funct. Anal. Anal. 210(2004), 43-72.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
283 283
[166] Y. Yan, Smoothing Smoothing properties properties and and approximation approximation of of time time derivatives derivatives for parabolic equations: variable variable time time steps, steps, BIT BIT 43(2003), 43(2003), 647-669. 647-669. [167] Zh. Yuan, On the the Resolvent Resolvent and and Tauberian Tauberian Conditions Conditions for for Bounded Bounded Linear Operators, Licentiate's Licentiate's Thesis, Thesis, Helsinki Helsinki University University of of TechnolTechnology, January 2002. [168] N.-Y. Zhang, On On fully fully discrete discrete Galerkin Galerkin approximations approximations for for partial partial integro-differential equations 60(1993), equations of of parabolic type, Math. Comp. 60(1993), 133-166.
Index I, xii LK{TUT2-X),
£*, xiii Hn, 4
147
CIV, 5 IntV, 5 Aj-condition, 6, 19 Aj(M)-condition, 25 Aj-condition, 5, 19 ftfc, 3 T,v, xiii
2n nJ -, 72 £*, xii , xii
L-J,29 , 262 Uit, 179
II-II. xii II ' II*, x i i a{z), 96 fife, 3 U fc , 179
B{X), xii V{r), 5 P(2;r), 5 ;V.,<7), 124 ) , xiii , 213
2ln, 67 %;n, 67 iin, 67 deg[w], 89 Dom£, xiii Dom | |, xiii Yn, 72 D(t), 104
r(z), 95 a, 95 i, 95 b, 95 c, 95 e, 95
T>n, 104
a (in Part II), 103 »(*), 104 284
INDEX
285
v(z), 95 w{z), 95 231 Amplification matrix, 231 Backward Euler method, 100, 100, 248 248 BDF method, 241 Commutator, 54 Contour, 258 Convexity inequality, 261 261 Crank-Nicolson method, 100, 100, 251 251 Discrete evolution operator, operator, 44 Discrete semigroup, 4, 19 19 Equation integro-differential, 245 with memory, 71 Evolution equation in discrete time, 4, 19 Family of grids, exponentially balanced, 185 185 locally balanced, 186 quasi-quasiuniform grids, grids, 186 186 quasi-uniform grids, 187 Fractional power, 260 Function of linear operator, 258 ordered operators, 262 Functional Qn(-), 148 QniO, 148
Gauss-Legendre method, 99 99 Hypothesis ...), 33 ( . . . ) , 33
H
, 33
hol(...), 86 hol[...], 84 hoi®[...], 84 ( ^ ( . . . ) , 85 >(...), 85 hol^[...], 232 holf f c ) [...], 85 lip, 86 lip(...), 86 COM1[...], 54 COM2[...], 54 coml[...], 220 com2[...], 220 Integration path, 258 228 Linear multistep method, 228 of class Mi, 231 of type LM{ip), 231 of type LMj (?), 232 Lobatto method, 100 Methods with splitting operator, operator, 219 219
Non-uniform grid (partition), (partition), 179 179 Operator (M; ip, cr)-sectorial, 124 (
286
INDEX INDEX
(.. .)-concordant, 6, 19 strictly (.. .)-concordant, 86 86 strictly Aj(.. .)-concordant, .)-concordant, 77 strictly A^(.. .)-concordant, .)-concordant, 77 Parabolic case, xiii differential equations, xiii xiii Parameters of set of Aj-configuration, Aj-configuration, 55 Radau method, 100 RK method, 95 Tl-stable, 96 i4(v?)-stable, 96 .Aj-stable, 97 Aj((p)-stab\e, 97 of class Sj, 97 of typeC(yj), 96 of type Cj(¥>), 97 of type V(
7M, 97 Sectorial estimate, xiii Set Aj-proper, 6, 25 Aj(...)-proper, 7 Aj-proper, 6 A5(...)-Proper, 7 of Aj-configuration, 5 Simplifying assumptions, 98 98 Singular points of operator, 6 set of Aj-configuration, 55 Solution classical, 265 extended, of Cauchy problem, 266 of order p, 266
of ofRunge-Kutta Runge-Kutta procedure, procedure,104, 104, 148, 148, 180 180 of of Cauchy Cauchy problem, problem, 265 265 of of multistep multistep procedure, procedure, C-extended, C-extended, 229 229 ^-extended, ^-extended, 229 229 Sparse Sparse quadrature quadrature rule, rule, 252 252 Stability Stability function, function, 95 95 Testing functional, 85, 232 232 Triplet Triplet M M -- O-concordant, O-concordant, 77 A$(.. A$(.. .)-concordant, .)-concordant, 77